Merge from gnus--rel--5.10
[bpt/emacs.git] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 @quotation
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
21
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
25
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
30 @end quotation
31 @end copying
32
33 @iftex
34 @iflatex
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
38 \usepackage{epsfig}
39 \usepackage{pixidx}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
41
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
43 \else
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
45 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
46 \pdfcompresslevel=9
47 \fi
48
49 \makeindex
50 \begin{document}
51
52 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.11}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
363 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.11.
364
365 @end ifinfo
366
367 @iftex
368
369 @iflatex
370 \tableofcontents
371 \gnuscleardoublepage
372 @end iflatex
373
374 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
375 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
376
377 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
378 being accused of plagiarism:
379
380 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
381 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
382 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
383 can even read news with it!
384
385 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
386 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
387 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
388 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
389 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
390 the program.
391
392 @end iftex
393
394 @menu
395 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
396 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
397 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
398 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
399 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
400 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
401 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
402 * Various:: General purpose settings.
403 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
404 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
405 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
406 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
407 * Key Index:: Key Index.
408
409 Other related manuals
410
411 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
412 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
413 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
414 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
415
416 @detailmenu
417 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
418
419 Starting Gnus
420
421 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
422 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
423 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
424 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
425 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
426 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
427 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
428 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
429 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
430 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
431 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
432
433 New Groups
434
435 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
436 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
437 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
438
439 Group Buffer
440
441 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
442 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
443 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
444 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
445 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
446 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
447 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
448 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
449 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
450 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
451 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
452 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
453 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
454 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
455 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
456 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
457 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
458
459 Group Buffer Format
460
461 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
462 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
463 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
464
465 Group Topics
466
467 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
468 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
469 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
470 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
471 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
472
473 Misc Group Stuff
474
475 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
476 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
477 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
478 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
479 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
480
481 Summary Buffer
482
483 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
484 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
485 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
486 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
487 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
488 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
489 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
490 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
491 * Threading:: How threads are made.
492 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
493 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
494 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
495 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
496 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
497 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
498 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
499 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
500 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
501 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
502 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
503 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
504 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
505 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
506 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
507 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
508 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
509 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
510 or reselecting the current group.
511 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
512 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
513 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
514 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
515
516 Summary Buffer Format
517
518 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
519 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
520 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
521 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
522
523 Choosing Articles
524
525 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
526 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
527
528 Reply, Followup and Post
529
530 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
531 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
532 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
533 * Canceling and Superseding::
534
535 Marking Articles
536
537 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
538 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
539 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
540 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
541 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
542 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
543
544 Threading
545
546 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
547 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
548
549 Customizing Threading
550
551 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
552 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
553 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
554 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
555
556 Decoding Articles
557
558 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
559 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
560 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
561 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
562 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
563 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
564
565 Decoding Variables
566
567 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
568 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
569 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
570
571 Article Treatment
572
573 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
574 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
575 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
576 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
577 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
578 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
579 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
580 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
581 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
582 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
583 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
584
585 Alternative Approaches
586
587 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
588 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
589
590 Various Summary Stuff
591
592 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
593 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
594 * Summary Generation Commands::
595 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
596
597 Article Buffer
598
599 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
600 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
601 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
602 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
603 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
604
605 Composing Messages
606
607 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
608 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
609 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
610 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
611 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
612 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
613 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
614 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
615 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
616
617 Select Methods
618
619 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
620 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
621 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
622 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
623 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
624 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
625 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
626 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
627 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
628
629 Server Buffer
630
631 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
632 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
633 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
634 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
635 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
636 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
637 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
638
639 Getting News
640
641 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
642 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
643
644 @acronym{NNTP}
645
646 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
647 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
648 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
649
650 Getting Mail
651
652 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
653 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
654 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
655 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
656 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
657 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
658 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
659 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
660 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
661 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
662 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
663 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
664 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
665
666 Mail Sources
667
668 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
669 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
670 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
671
672 Choosing a Mail Back End
673
674 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
675 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
676 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
677 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
678 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
679 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
680 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
681
682 Browsing the Web
683
684 * Archiving Mail::
685 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
686 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
687 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
688 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
689 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
690 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
691
692 @acronym{IMAP}
693
694 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
695 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
696 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
697 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
698 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
699 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
700
701 Other Sources
702
703 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
704 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
705 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
706 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
707 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
708
709 Document Groups
710
711 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
712
713 SOUP
714
715 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
716 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
717 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
718
719 Combined Groups
720
721 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
722 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
723
724 Email Based Diary
725
726 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
727 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
728 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
729
730 The NNDiary Back End
731
732 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
733 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
734 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
735
736 The Gnus Diary Library
737
738 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
739 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
740 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
741 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
742
743 Gnus Unplugged
744
745 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
746 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
747 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
748 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
749 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
750 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
751 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
752 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
753 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
754 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
755 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
756 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
757 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
758
759 Agent Categories
760
761 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
762 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
763 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
764
765 Agent Commands
766
767 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
768 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
769 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
770
771 Scoring
772
773 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
774 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
775 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
776 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
777 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
778 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
779 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
780 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
781 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
782 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
783 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
784 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
785 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
786 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
787 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
788 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
789 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
790
791 GroupLens
792
793 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
794 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
795 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
796 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
797
798 Advanced Scoring
799
800 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
801 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
802 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
803
804 Various
805
806 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
807 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
808 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
809 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
810 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
811 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
812 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
813 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
814 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
815 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
816 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
817 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
818 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
819 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
820 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
821 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
822 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
823 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
824 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
825 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
826 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
827
828 Formatting Variables
829
830 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
831 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
832 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
833 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
834 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
835 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
836 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
837 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
838
839 Image Enhancements
840
841 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
842 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
843 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
844 meant to be shown.
845 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
846 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
847
848 Thwarting Email Spam
849
850 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
851 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
852 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
853 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
854
855 Spam Package
856
857 * Spam Package Introduction::
858 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
859 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
860 * Spam and Ham Processors::
861 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
862 * Spam Back Ends::
863 * Extending the Spam package::
864 * Spam Statistics Package::
865
866 Spam Statistics Package
867
868 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
869 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
870 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
871
872 Appendices
873
874 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
875 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
876 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
877 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
878 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
879 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
880 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
881 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
882 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
883
884 History
885
886 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
887 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
888 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
889 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
890 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
891 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
892 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
893 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
894 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
895
896 New Features
897
898 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
899 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
900 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
901 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
902 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
903 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
904
905 Customization
906
907 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
908 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
909 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
910 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
911
912 Gnus Reference Guide
913
914 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
915 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
916 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
917 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
918 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
919 * Group Info:: The group info format.
920 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
921 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
922 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
923
924 Back End Interface
925
926 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
927 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
928 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
929 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
930 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
931 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
932
933 Various File Formats
934
935 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
936 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
937
938 Emacs for Heathens
939
940 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
941 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
942
943 @end detailmenu
944 @end menu
945
946 @node Starting Up
947 @chapter Starting Gnus
948 @cindex starting up
949
950 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
951 Heathens} first.
952
953 @kindex M-x gnus
954 @findex gnus
955 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
956 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
957 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
958 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
959 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
960 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
961
962 @findex gnus-other-frame
963 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
964 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
965 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
966
967 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
968 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
969 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
970
971 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
972 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
973
974 @menu
975 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
976 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
977 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
978 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
979 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
980 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
981 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
982 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
983 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
984 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
985 @end menu
986
987
988 @node Finding the News
989 @section Finding the News
990 @cindex finding news
991
992 @vindex gnus-select-method
993 @c @head
994 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
995 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
996 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
997 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
998 foreign groups.
999
1000 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1001 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1002
1003 @lisp
1004 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1005 @end lisp
1006
1007 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1008
1009 @lisp
1010 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1011 @end lisp
1012
1013 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1014 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1015 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1016 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1017
1018 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1019 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1020 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1021 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1022 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1023 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1024 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1025 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1026 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1027
1028 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1029 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1030 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1031 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1032
1033 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1034 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1035 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1036 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1037 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1038 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1039 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1040 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1041 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1042 server.)
1043
1044 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1045 @kindex B (Group)
1046 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1047 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1048 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1049 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1050 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1051 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1052
1053 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1054 @c @head
1055 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1056 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1057 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1058 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1059 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1060 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1061 groups are.
1062
1063 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1064 you would typically set this variable to
1065
1066 @lisp
1067 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1068 @end lisp
1069
1070
1071 @node The First Time
1072 @section The First Time
1073 @cindex first time usage
1074
1075 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1076 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1077
1078 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1079 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1080 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1081 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1082 something useful.
1083
1084 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1085 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1086 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1087
1088 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1089 help you with most common problems.
1090
1091 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1092 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1093 special.
1094
1095
1096 @node The Server is Down
1097 @section The Server is Down
1098 @cindex server errors
1099
1100 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1101 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1102 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1103
1104 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1105 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1106 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1107 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1108 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1109 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1110 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1111
1112 @findex gnus-no-server
1113 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1114 @c @head
1115 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1116 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1117 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1118 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1119 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1120 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1121 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1122
1123
1124 @node Slave Gnusae
1125 @section Slave Gnusae
1126 @cindex slave
1127
1128 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1129 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1130 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1131 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1132
1133 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1134 @file{.newsrc} file.
1135
1136 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1137 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1138 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1139 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1140 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1141 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1142 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1143
1144 @findex gnus-slave
1145 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1146 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1147 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1148 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1149 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1150 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1151 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1152 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1153
1154 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1155 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1156
1157 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1158 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1159 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1160 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1161 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1162
1163
1164
1165 @node New Groups
1166 @section New Groups
1167 @cindex new groups
1168 @cindex subscription
1169
1170 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1171 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1172 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1173 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1174 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1175 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1176 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1177 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1178 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1179
1180 @menu
1181 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1182 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1183 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1184 @end menu
1185
1186
1187 @node Checking New Groups
1188 @subsection Checking New Groups
1189
1190 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1191 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1192 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1193 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1194 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1195 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1196 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1197 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1198 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1199 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1200
1201 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1202 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1203 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1204 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1205 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1206 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1207 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1208 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1209 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1210 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1211 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1212
1213 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1214 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1215 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1216 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1217 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1218 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1219
1220
1221 @node Subscription Methods
1222 @subsection Subscription Methods
1223
1224 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1225 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1226 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1227
1228 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1229 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1230
1231 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1232
1233 @table @code
1234
1235 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1236 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1237 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1238 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1239 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1240
1241 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1242 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1243 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1244 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1245
1246 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1247 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1248 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1249
1250 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1251 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1252 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1253 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1254 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1255 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1256 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1257 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1258 up. Or something like that.
1259
1260 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1261 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1262 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1263 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1264 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1265
1266 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1267 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1268 Kill all new groups.
1269
1270 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1271 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1272 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1273 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1274 topic parameter that looks like
1275
1276 @example
1277 "nnslashdot"
1278 @end example
1279
1280 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1281 that topic.
1282
1283 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1284 top-level topic.
1285
1286 @end table
1287
1288 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1289 A closely related variable is
1290 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1291 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1292 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1293 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1294 hierarchy or not.
1295
1296 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1297 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1298 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1299 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1300
1301
1302 @node Filtering New Groups
1303 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1304
1305 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1306 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1307 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1308
1309 @example
1310 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1311 @end example
1312
1313 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1314 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1315 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1316 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1317 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1318 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1319 subscribing these groups.
1320 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1321 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1322
1323 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1324 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1325 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1326 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1327 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1328 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1329 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1330 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1331
1332 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1333 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1334 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1335 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1336 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1337 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1338 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1339 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1340 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1341 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1342 @code{nil}.
1343
1344 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1345 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1346
1347
1348 @node Changing Servers
1349 @section Changing Servers
1350 @cindex changing servers
1351
1352 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1353 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1354 very flaky and you want to use another.
1355
1356 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1357 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1358
1359 @emph{Wrong!}
1360
1361 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1362 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1363 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1364 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1365 worthless.
1366
1367 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1368 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1369 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1370 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1371
1372 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1373 @findex gnus-change-server
1374 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1375 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1376 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1377 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1378 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1379
1380 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1381 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1382 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1383 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1384 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1385
1386 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1387 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1388 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1389 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1390 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1391 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1392
1393 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1394 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1395 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1396 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1397
1398 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1399 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1400 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1401 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1402 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1403 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1404 cache for all groups).
1405
1406
1407 @node Startup Files
1408 @section Startup Files
1409 @cindex startup files
1410 @cindex .newsrc
1411 @cindex .newsrc.el
1412 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1413
1414 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1415 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1416 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1417 read.
1418
1419 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1420 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1421 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1422 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1423 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1424 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1425 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1426
1427 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1428 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1429 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1430 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1431 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1432 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1433
1434 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1435 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1436 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1437 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1438 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1439 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1440 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1441 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1442 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1443 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1444 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1445 news reader.
1446
1447 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1448 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1449 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1450 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1451 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1452 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1453 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1454 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1455 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1456 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1457 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1458 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1459
1460 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1461 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1462 @vindex version-control
1463 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1464 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1465 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1466 If you want version control for this file, set
1467 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1468 @code{version-control} variable.
1469
1470 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1471 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1472 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1473 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1474 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1475 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1476 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1477 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1478 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1479 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1480
1481 @lisp
1482 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1483 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1484
1485 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1486 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1487 @end lisp
1488
1489 @vindex gnus-init-file
1490 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1491 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1492 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1493 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1494 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1495 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1496 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1497 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1498 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1499 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1500 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1501 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1502 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1503
1504
1505 @node Auto Save
1506 @section Auto Save
1507 @cindex dribble file
1508 @cindex auto-save
1509
1510 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1511 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1512 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1513 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1514 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1515 this file.
1516
1517 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1518 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1519 saved.
1520
1521 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1522 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1523 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1524
1525 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1526 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1527 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1528 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1529 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1530 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1531
1532 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1533 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1534 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1535
1536
1537 @node The Active File
1538 @section The Active File
1539 @cindex active file
1540 @cindex ignored groups
1541
1542 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1543 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1544 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1545
1546 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1547 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1548 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1549 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1550 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1551 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1552 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1553
1554 @c This variable is
1555 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1556 @c if you set it to anything else.
1557
1558 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1559 @c @head
1560 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1561 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1562 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1563
1564 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1565 you actually subscribe to.
1566
1567 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1568 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1569 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1570 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1571
1572 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1573 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1574 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1575 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1576 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1577 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1578
1579 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1580 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1581 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1582 variable.
1583
1584 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1585 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1586 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1587 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1588 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1589 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1590
1591 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1592 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1593
1594 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1595 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1596
1597 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1598 secondary select methods.
1599
1600
1601 @node Startup Variables
1602 @section Startup Variables
1603
1604 @table @code
1605
1606 @item gnus-load-hook
1607 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1608 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1609 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1610 times you start Gnus.
1611
1612 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1613 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1614 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1615
1616 @item gnus-startup-hook
1617 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1618 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1619
1620 @item gnus-started-hook
1621 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1622 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1623 successfully.
1624
1625 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1626 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1627 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1628 generating the group buffer.
1629
1630 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1631 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1632 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1633 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1634 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1635 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1636 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1637 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1638
1639 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1640 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1641 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1642 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1643 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1644 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1645
1646 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1647 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1648 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1649
1650 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1651 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1652 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1653
1654 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1655 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1656 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1657 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1658
1659 @end table
1660
1661
1662 @node Group Buffer
1663 @chapter Group Buffer
1664 @cindex group buffer
1665
1666 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1667 @c
1668 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1669 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1670 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1671 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1672 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1673 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1674 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1675 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1676 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1677 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1678 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1679 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1680 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1681 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1682 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1683 @c human rights at 9...
1684
1685
1686 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1687 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1688 long as Gnus is active.
1689
1690 @iftex
1691 @iflatex
1692 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1693 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1694 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1695 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1696 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1697 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1698 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1699 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1700 }
1701 @end iflatex
1702 @end iftex
1703
1704 @menu
1705 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1706 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1707 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1708 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1709 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1710 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1711 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1712 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1713 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1714 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1715 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1716 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1717 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1718 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1719 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1720 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1721 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1722 @end menu
1723
1724
1725 @node Group Buffer Format
1726 @section Group Buffer Format
1727
1728 @menu
1729 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1730 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1731 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1732 @end menu
1733
1734 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1735 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1736 available in Emacs.
1737
1738 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1739 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1740 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1741 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1742 Emacs version.
1743
1744 @node Group Line Specification
1745 @subsection Group Line Specification
1746 @cindex group buffer format
1747
1748 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1749 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1750
1751 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1752
1753 @example
1754 25: news.announce.newusers
1755 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1756 @end example
1757
1758 Quite simple, huh?
1759
1760 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1761 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1762 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1763 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1764
1765 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1766 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1767 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1768 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1769 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1770 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1771
1772 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1773
1774 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1775 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1776 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1777 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1778 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1779
1780 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1781 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1782 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1783
1784 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1785
1786 @table @samp
1787
1788 @item M
1789 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1790
1791 @item S
1792 Whether the group is subscribed.
1793
1794 @item L
1795 Level of subscribedness.
1796
1797 @item N
1798 Number of unread articles.
1799
1800 @item I
1801 Number of dormant articles.
1802
1803 @item T
1804 Number of ticked articles.
1805
1806 @item R
1807 Number of read articles.
1808
1809 @item U
1810 Number of unseen articles.
1811
1812 @item t
1813 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1814 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1815
1816 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1817 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1818 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1819 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1820 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1821 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1822 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1823 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1824
1825 @item y
1826 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1827
1828 @item i
1829 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1830
1831 @item g
1832 Full group name.
1833
1834 @item G
1835 Group name.
1836
1837 @item C
1838 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1839 comment element in the group parameters.
1840
1841 @item D
1842 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1843 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1844 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1845 command.
1846
1847 @item o
1848 @samp{m} if moderated.
1849
1850 @item O
1851 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1852
1853 @item s
1854 Select method.
1855
1856 @item B
1857 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1858
1859 @item n
1860 Select from where.
1861
1862 @item z
1863 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1864 used.
1865
1866 @item P
1867 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1868
1869 @item c
1870 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1871 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1872 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1873 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1874 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1875
1876 @item m
1877 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1878 @cindex %
1879 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1880 the group lately.
1881
1882 @item p
1883 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1884
1885 @item d
1886 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1887 Timestamp}).
1888
1889 @item u
1890 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1891 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1892 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1893 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1894 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1895 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1896 specifier.
1897 @end table
1898
1899 @cindex *
1900 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1901 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1902 group, or a bogus native group.
1903
1904
1905 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1906 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1907 @cindex group mode line
1908
1909 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1910 The mode line can be changed by setting
1911 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1912 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1913
1914 @table @samp
1915 @item S
1916 The native news server.
1917 @item M
1918 The native select method.
1919 @end table
1920
1921
1922 @node Group Highlighting
1923 @subsection Group Highlighting
1924 @cindex highlighting
1925 @cindex group highlighting
1926
1927 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1928 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1929 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1930 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1931 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1932
1933 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1934 background is dark:
1935
1936 @lisp
1937 (cond (window-system
1938 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1939 (defface my-group-face-1
1940 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1941 (defface my-group-face-2
1942 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1943 "Second group face")
1944 (defface my-group-face-3
1945 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1946 (defface my-group-face-4
1947 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1948 (defface my-group-face-5
1949 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1950
1951 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1952 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1953 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1954 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1955 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1956 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1957 @end lisp
1958
1959 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1960
1961 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1962 include:
1963
1964 @table @code
1965 @item group
1966 The group name.
1967 @item unread
1968 The number of unread articles in the group.
1969 @item method
1970 The select method.
1971 @item mailp
1972 Whether the group is a mail group.
1973 @item level
1974 The level of the group.
1975 @item score
1976 The score of the group.
1977 @item ticked
1978 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1979 @item total
1980 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1981 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1982 @item topic
1983 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1984 topic being inserted.
1985 @end table
1986
1987 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1988 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1989 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1990
1991 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1992 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1993 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1994 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
1995 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
1996
1997
1998 @node Group Maneuvering
1999 @section Group Maneuvering
2000 @cindex group movement
2001
2002 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
2003 expected, hopefully.
2004
2005 @table @kbd
2006
2007 @item n
2008 @kindex n (Group)
2009 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
2010 Go to the next group that has unread articles
2011 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
2012
2013 @item p
2014 @itemx DEL
2015 @kindex DEL (Group)
2016 @kindex p (Group)
2017 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2018 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2019 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2020
2021 @item N
2022 @kindex N (Group)
2023 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2024 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2025
2026 @item P
2027 @kindex P (Group)
2028 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2029 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2030
2031 @item M-n
2032 @kindex M-n (Group)
2033 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2034 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2035 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2036
2037 @item M-p
2038 @kindex M-p (Group)
2039 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2040 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2041 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2042 @end table
2043
2044 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2045
2046 @table @kbd
2047
2048 @item j
2049 @kindex j (Group)
2050 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2051 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2052 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2053 like living groups.
2054
2055 @item ,
2056 @kindex , (Group)
2057 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2058 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2059 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2060
2061 @item .
2062 @kindex . (Group)
2063 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2064 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2065 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2066 @end table
2067
2068 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2069 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2070 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2071 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2072 is @code{t}.
2073
2074
2075 @node Selecting a Group
2076 @section Selecting a Group
2077 @cindex group selection
2078
2079 @table @kbd
2080
2081 @item SPACE
2082 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2083 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2084 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2085 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2086 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2087 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2088 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2089 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2090 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2091 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2092
2093 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2094 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2095 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2096
2097 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2098 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2099 ones.
2100
2101 @item RET
2102 @kindex RET (Group)
2103 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2104 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2105 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2106 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2107 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2108 entry.
2109
2110 @item M-RET
2111 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2112 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2113 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2114 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2115 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2116 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2117 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2118 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2119 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2120 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2121
2122 @item M-SPACE
2123 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2124 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2125 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2126 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2127 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2128
2129 @item C-M-RET
2130 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2131 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2132 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2133 doing any processing of its contents
2134 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2135 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2136 manner will have no permanent effects.
2137
2138 @end table
2139
2140 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2141 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2142 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2143 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2144 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2145 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2146 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2147 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2148 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2149 most recently will be fetched.
2150
2151 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2152 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2153 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2154 newsgroups.
2155
2156 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2157 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2158 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2159 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2160 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2161 Which article this is is controlled by the
2162 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2163 variable are:
2164
2165 @table @code
2166
2167 @item unread
2168 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2169
2170 @item first
2171 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2172
2173 @item unseen
2174 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2175
2176 @item unseen-or-unread
2177 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2178 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2179 unread article.
2180
2181 @item best
2182 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2183
2184 @end table
2185
2186 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2187 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2188
2189 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2190 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2191 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2192 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2193 selected.
2194
2195
2196 @node Subscription Commands
2197 @section Subscription Commands
2198 @cindex subscription
2199
2200 @table @kbd
2201
2202 @item S t
2203 @itemx u
2204 @kindex S t (Group)
2205 @kindex u (Group)
2206 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2207 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2208 Toggle subscription to the current group
2209 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2210
2211 @item S s
2212 @itemx U
2213 @kindex S s (Group)
2214 @kindex U (Group)
2215 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2216 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2217 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2218 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2219
2220 @item S k
2221 @itemx C-k
2222 @kindex S k (Group)
2223 @kindex C-k (Group)
2224 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2225 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2226 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2227
2228 @item S y
2229 @itemx C-y
2230 @kindex S y (Group)
2231 @kindex C-y (Group)
2232 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2233 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2234
2235 @item C-x C-t
2236 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2237 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2238 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2239 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2240 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2241
2242 @item S w
2243 @itemx C-w
2244 @kindex S w (Group)
2245 @kindex C-w (Group)
2246 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2247 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2248
2249 @item S z
2250 @kindex S z (Group)
2251 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2252 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2253
2254 @item S C-k
2255 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2256 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2257 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2258 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2259 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2260 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2261 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2262 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2263 @file{.newsrc} file.
2264
2265 @end table
2266
2267 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2268
2269
2270 @node Group Data
2271 @section Group Data
2272
2273 @table @kbd
2274
2275 @item c
2276 @kindex c (Group)
2277 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2278 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2279 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2280 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2281 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2282 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2283 the group buffer.
2284
2285 @item C
2286 @kindex C (Group)
2287 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2288 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2289 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2290
2291 @item M-c
2292 @kindex M-c (Group)
2293 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2294 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2295 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2296
2297 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2298 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2299 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2300 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2301 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2302 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2303 caution.
2304
2305 @end table
2306
2307
2308 @node Group Levels
2309 @section Group Levels
2310 @cindex group level
2311 @cindex level
2312
2313 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2314 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2315 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2316 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2317 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2318
2319 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2320
2321 @table @kbd
2322
2323 @item S l
2324 @kindex S l (Group)
2325 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2326 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2327 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2328 prompted for a level.
2329 @end table
2330
2331 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2332 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2333 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2334 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2335 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2336 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2337 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2338 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2339 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2340 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2341 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2342 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2343 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2344 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2345 reasons of efficiency.
2346
2347 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2348 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2349
2350 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2351 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2352 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2353 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2354 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2355 groups are hidden, in a way.
2356
2357 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2358 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2359 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2360 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2361 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2362 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2363
2364 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2365 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2366 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2367 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2368 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2369 list of killed groups.)
2370
2371 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2372 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2373 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2374
2375 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2376 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2377 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2378 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2379 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2380 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2381 relevant valid ranges.
2382
2383 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2384 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2385 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2386 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2387 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2388 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2389 rest.
2390
2391 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2392 one with the best level.
2393
2394 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2395 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2396 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2397 by default.
2398
2399 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2400 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2401 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2402 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2403 listed.
2404
2405 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2406 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2407 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2408 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2409
2410 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2411 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2412 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2413 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2414 to 5. The default is 6.
2415
2416
2417 @node Group Score
2418 @section Group Score
2419 @cindex group score
2420 @cindex group rank
2421 @cindex rank
2422
2423 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2424 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2425 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2426 reason?
2427
2428 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2429 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2430 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2431 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2432 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2433 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2434 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2435 least significant part.))
2436
2437 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2438 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2439 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2440 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2441 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2442 action after each summary exit, you can add
2443 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2444 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2445 slow things down somewhat.
2446
2447
2448 @node Marking Groups
2449 @section Marking Groups
2450 @cindex marking groups
2451
2452 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2453 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2454 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2455 bidding on those groups.
2456
2457 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2458 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2459 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2460
2461 @table @kbd
2462
2463 @item #
2464 @kindex # (Group)
2465 @itemx M m
2466 @kindex M m (Group)
2467 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2468 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2469
2470 @item M-#
2471 @kindex M-# (Group)
2472 @itemx M u
2473 @kindex M u (Group)
2474 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2475 Remove the mark from the current group
2476 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2477
2478 @item M U
2479 @kindex M U (Group)
2480 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2481 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2482
2483 @item M w
2484 @kindex M w (Group)
2485 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2486 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2487
2488 @item M b
2489 @kindex M b (Group)
2490 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2491 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2492
2493 @item M r
2494 @kindex M r (Group)
2495 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2496 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2497 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2498 @end table
2499
2500 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2501
2502 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2503 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2504 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2505 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2506 the command to be executed.
2507
2508
2509 @node Foreign Groups
2510 @section Foreign Groups
2511 @cindex foreign groups
2512
2513 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2514 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2515 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2516 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2517 consulted.
2518
2519 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2520 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2521 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2522
2523 @table @kbd
2524
2525 @item G m
2526 @kindex G m (Group)
2527 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2528 @cindex making groups
2529 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2530 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2531 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2532
2533 @item G M
2534 @kindex G M (Group)
2535 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2536 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2537 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2538
2539 @item G r
2540 @kindex G r (Group)
2541 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2542 @cindex renaming groups
2543 Rename the current group to something else
2544 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2545 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2546 on some back ends.
2547
2548 @item G c
2549 @kindex G c (Group)
2550 @cindex customizing
2551 @findex gnus-group-customize
2552 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2553
2554 @item G e
2555 @kindex G e (Group)
2556 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2557 @cindex renaming groups
2558 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2559 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2560
2561 @item G p
2562 @kindex G p (Group)
2563 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2564 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2565 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2566
2567 @item G E
2568 @kindex G E (Group)
2569 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2570 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2571 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2572
2573 @item G d
2574 @kindex G d (Group)
2575 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2576 @cindex nndir
2577 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2578 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2579
2580 @item G h
2581 @kindex G h (Group)
2582 @cindex help group
2583 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2584 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2585
2586 @item G a
2587 @kindex G a (Group)
2588 @cindex (ding) archive
2589 @cindex archive group
2590 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2591 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2592 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2593 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2594 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2595 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2596 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2597
2598 @item G k
2599 @kindex G k (Group)
2600 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2601 @cindex nnkiboze
2602 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2603 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2604 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2605 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2606
2607 @item G D
2608 @kindex G D (Group)
2609 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2610 @cindex nneething
2611 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2612 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2613 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2614
2615 @item G f
2616 @kindex G f (Group)
2617 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2618 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2619 @cindex nndoc
2620 Make a group based on some file or other
2621 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2622 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2623 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2624 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2625 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2626 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2627 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2628 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2629 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2630
2631 @item G u
2632 @kindex G u (Group)
2633 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2634 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2635 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2636 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2637
2638 @item G w
2639 @kindex G w (Group)
2640 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2641 @cindex Google
2642 @cindex nnweb
2643 @cindex gmane
2644 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2645 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2646 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2647 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2648 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2649 @xref{Web Searches}.
2650
2651 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2652 to a particular group by using a match string like
2653 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2654
2655 @item G R
2656 @kindex G R (Group)
2657 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2658 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2659 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2660 @xref{RSS}.
2661
2662 @item G DEL
2663 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2664 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2665 This function will delete the current group
2666 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2667 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2668 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2669 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2670 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2671
2672 @item G V
2673 @kindex G V (Group)
2674 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2675 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2676 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2677
2678 @item G v
2679 @kindex G v (Group)
2680 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2681 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2682 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2683 @end table
2684
2685 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2686 methods.
2687
2688 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2689 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2690 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2691 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2692 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2693 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2694 newsgroups.
2695
2696
2697 @node Group Parameters
2698 @section Group Parameters
2699 @cindex group parameters
2700
2701 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2702 Here's an example group parameter list:
2703
2704 @example
2705 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2706 (auto-expire . t))
2707 @end example
2708
2709 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2710 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2711 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2712 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2713
2714 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2715 is an alist of regexps and values.
2716
2717 The following group parameters can be used:
2718
2719 @table @code
2720 @item to-address
2721 @cindex to-address
2722 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2723
2724 @example
2725 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2726 @end example
2727
2728 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2729 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2730 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2731 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2732 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2733
2734 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2735 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2736 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2737 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2738 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2739 list address instead.
2740
2741 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2742
2743 @item to-list
2744 @cindex to-list
2745 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2746
2747 @example
2748 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2749 @end example
2750
2751 It is totally ignored
2752 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2753 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2754
2755 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2756 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2757 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2758 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2759 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2760
2761 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2762 @cindex mail list groups
2763 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2764 entering summary buffer.
2765
2766 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2767
2768 @anchor{subscribed}
2769 @item subscribed
2770 @cindex subscribed
2771 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2772 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2773 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2774 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2775 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2776 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2777 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2778 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2779
2780 @lisp
2781 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2782 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2783 @end lisp
2784
2785 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2786 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2787
2788 @item visible
2789 @cindex visible
2790 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2791 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2792 of whether it has any unread articles.
2793
2794 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2795 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2796
2797 @item broken-reply-to
2798 @cindex broken-reply-to
2799 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2800 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2801 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2802 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2803 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2804 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2805
2806 @item to-group
2807 @cindex to-group
2808 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2809 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2810
2811 @item newsgroup
2812 @cindex newsgroup
2813 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2814 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2815 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2816 news group.
2817
2818 @item gcc-self
2819 @cindex gcc-self
2820 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2821 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2822 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2823 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2824 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2825 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2826 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2827
2828 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2829 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2830 doesn't accept articles.
2831
2832 @item auto-expire
2833 @cindex auto-expire
2834 @cindex expiring mail
2835 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2836 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2837 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2838
2839 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2840
2841 @item total-expire
2842 @cindex total-expire
2843 @cindex expiring mail
2844 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2845 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2846 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2847 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2848 expiry.
2849
2850 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2851
2852 @item expiry-wait
2853 @cindex expiry-wait
2854 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2855 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2856 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2857 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2858 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2859 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2860 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2861
2862 @item expiry-target
2863 @cindex expiry-target
2864 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2865 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2866
2867 @item score-file
2868 @cindex score file group parameter
2869 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2870 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2871 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2872
2873 @item adapt-file
2874 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2875 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2876 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2877 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2878
2879 @item admin-address
2880 @cindex admin-address
2881 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2882 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2883 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2884 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2885
2886 @item display
2887 @cindex display
2888 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2889 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2890
2891 @table @code
2892 @item all
2893 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2894
2895 @item an integer
2896 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2897 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2898
2899 @item default
2900 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2901 ticked articles.
2902
2903 @item an array
2904 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2905
2906 Here are some examples:
2907
2908 @table @code
2909 @item [unread]
2910 Display only unread articles.
2911
2912 @item [not expire]
2913 Display everything except expirable articles.
2914
2915 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2916 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2917 responded to.
2918 @end table
2919
2920 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2921 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2922 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2923 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2924 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2925
2926 @end table
2927
2928 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2929 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2930 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2931
2932 @item comment
2933 @cindex comment
2934 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2935 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2936 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2937
2938 @item charset
2939 @cindex charset
2940 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2941 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2942 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2943
2944 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2945
2946 @item ignored-charsets
2947 @cindex ignored-charset
2948 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2949 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2950 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2951
2952 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2953
2954 @item posting-style
2955 @cindex posting-style
2956 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2957 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2958 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2959 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2960 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
2961
2962 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
2963 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
2964 like this in the group parameters:
2965
2966 @example
2967 (posting-style
2968 (name "Funky Name")
2969 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
2970 (signature "Funky Signature"))
2971 @end example
2972
2973 @item post-method
2974 @cindex post-method
2975 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
2976 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
2977
2978 @item banner
2979 @cindex banner
2980 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
2981 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
2982 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
2983 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
2984 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
2985
2986 @item sieve
2987 @cindex sieve
2988 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
2989 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
2990 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
2991 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
2992
2993 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
2994 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
2995 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
2996 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
2997
2998 @example
2999 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
3000 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
3001 @}
3002 @end example
3003
3004 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3005 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3006
3007 @item (agent parameters)
3008 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
3009 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3010 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3011 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3012 minimize the configuration effort.
3013
3014 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3015 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3016 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3017 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3018 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3019 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3020 @code{eval}ed there.
3021
3022 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
3023 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3024 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3025 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3026 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3027 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3028 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3029 @file{~/.gnus} file:
3030
3031 @lisp
3032 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3033 @end lisp
3034
3035 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3036 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3037 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3038
3039 @example
3040 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3041 @end example
3042
3043 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3044 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3045 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3046 into the group parameters for the group.
3047
3048 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3049 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3050 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3051 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3052 @code{(ding)} form.
3053
3054 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3055 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3056 following is added to a group parameter
3057
3058 @lisp
3059 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3060 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3061 @end lisp
3062
3063 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3064 expired.
3065
3066 @end table
3067
3068 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
3069 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
3070 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
3071 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
3072 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
3073
3074 @vindex gnus-parameters
3075 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3076 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3077 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3078 For example:
3079
3080 @lisp
3081 (setq gnus-parameters
3082 '(("mail\\..*"
3083 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3084 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3085 (gnus-summary-line-format
3086 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3087 (gcc-self . t)
3088 (display . all))
3089
3090 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3091 (to-group . "\\1"))
3092
3093 ("mail\\.me"
3094 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3095
3096 ("list\\..*"
3097 (total-expire . t)
3098 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3099 @end lisp
3100
3101 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3102 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3103
3104 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3105 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3106 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3107 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3108 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3109 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3110 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3111 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3112 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3113 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3114 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3115 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3116
3117
3118 @node Listing Groups
3119 @section Listing Groups
3120 @cindex group listing
3121
3122 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3123
3124 @table @kbd
3125
3126 @item l
3127 @itemx A s
3128 @kindex A s (Group)
3129 @kindex l (Group)
3130 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3131 List all groups that have unread articles
3132 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3133 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3134 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3135 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3136 groups).
3137
3138 @item L
3139 @itemx A u
3140 @kindex A u (Group)
3141 @kindex L (Group)
3142 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3143 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3144 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3145 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3146 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3147 unsubscribed groups).
3148
3149 @item A l
3150 @kindex A l (Group)
3151 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3152 List all unread groups on a specific level
3153 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3154 with no unread articles.
3155
3156 @item A k
3157 @kindex A k (Group)
3158 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3159 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3160 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3161 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3162 from the server.
3163
3164 @item A z
3165 @kindex A z (Group)
3166 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3167 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3168
3169 @item A m
3170 @kindex A m (Group)
3171 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3172 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3173 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3174
3175 @item A M
3176 @kindex A M (Group)
3177 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3178 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3179
3180 @item A A
3181 @kindex A A (Group)
3182 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3183 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3184 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3185 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3186 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3187 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3188 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3189 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3190
3191 @item A a
3192 @kindex A a (Group)
3193 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3194 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3195 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3196
3197 @item A d
3198 @kindex A d (Group)
3199 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3200 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3201 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3202
3203 @item A c
3204 @kindex A c (Group)
3205 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3206 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3207
3208 @item A ?
3209 @kindex A ? (Group)
3210 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3211 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3212
3213 @item A /
3214 @kindex A / (Group)
3215 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3216 List groups limited within the current selection
3217 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3218
3219 @item A f
3220 @kindex A f (Group)
3221 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3222 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3223
3224 @item A p
3225 @kindex A p (Group)
3226 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3227 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3228
3229 @end table
3230
3231 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3232 @cindex visible group parameter
3233 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3234 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3235 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3236 get the same effect.
3237
3238 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3239 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3240 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3241 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3242 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3243
3244
3245 @node Sorting Groups
3246 @section Sorting Groups
3247 @cindex sorting groups
3248
3249 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3250 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3251 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3252 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3253 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3254 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3255 include:
3256
3257 @table @code
3258
3259 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3260 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3261 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3262
3263 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3264 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3265 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3266
3267 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3268 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3269 Sort by group level.
3270
3271 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3272 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3273 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3274
3275 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3276 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3277 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3278 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3279
3280 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3281 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3282 Sort by number of unread articles.
3283
3284 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3285 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3286 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3287
3288 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3289 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3290 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3291
3292
3293 @end table
3294
3295 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3296 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3297 the last one.
3298
3299
3300 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3301 some sorting criteria:
3302
3303 @table @kbd
3304 @item G S a
3305 @kindex G S a (Group)
3306 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3307 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3308 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3309
3310 @item G S u
3311 @kindex G S u (Group)
3312 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3313 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3314 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3315
3316 @item G S l
3317 @kindex G S l (Group)
3318 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3319 Sort the group buffer by group level
3320 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3321
3322 @item G S v
3323 @kindex G S v (Group)
3324 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3325 Sort the group buffer by group score
3326 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3327
3328 @item G S r
3329 @kindex G S r (Group)
3330 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3331 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3332 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3333
3334 @item G S m
3335 @kindex G S m (Group)
3336 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3337 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3338 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3339
3340 @item G S n
3341 @kindex G S n (Group)
3342 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3343 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3344 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3345
3346 @end table
3347
3348 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3349 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3350
3351 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3352 commands will sort in reverse order.
3353
3354 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3355
3356 @table @kbd
3357 @item G P a
3358 @kindex G P a (Group)
3359 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3360 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3361 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3362
3363 @item G P u
3364 @kindex G P u (Group)
3365 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3366 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3367 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3368
3369 @item G P l
3370 @kindex G P l (Group)
3371 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3372 Sort the groups by group level
3373 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3374
3375 @item G P v
3376 @kindex G P v (Group)
3377 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3378 Sort the groups by group score
3379 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3380
3381 @item G P r
3382 @kindex G P r (Group)
3383 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3384 Sort the groups by group rank
3385 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3386
3387 @item G P m
3388 @kindex G P m (Group)
3389 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3390 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3391 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3392
3393 @item G P n
3394 @kindex G P n (Group)
3395 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3396 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3397 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3398
3399 @item G P s
3400 @kindex G P s (Group)
3401 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3402 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3403
3404 @end table
3405
3406 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3407 move groups around.
3408
3409
3410 @node Group Maintenance
3411 @section Group Maintenance
3412 @cindex bogus groups
3413
3414 @table @kbd
3415 @item b
3416 @kindex b (Group)
3417 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3418 Find bogus groups and delete them
3419 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3420
3421 @item F
3422 @kindex F (Group)
3423 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3424 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3425 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3426 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3427 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3428 zombies.
3429
3430 @item C-c C-x
3431 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3432 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3433 @cindex expiring mail
3434 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3435 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3436 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3437 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3438
3439 @item C-c C-M-x
3440 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3441 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3442 @cindex expiring mail
3443 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3444 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3445
3446 @end table
3447
3448
3449 @node Browse Foreign Server
3450 @section Browse Foreign Server
3451 @cindex foreign servers
3452 @cindex browsing servers
3453
3454 @table @kbd
3455 @item B
3456 @kindex B (Group)
3457 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3458 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3459 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3460 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3461 @end table
3462
3463 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3464 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3465 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3466 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3467
3468 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3469
3470 @table @kbd
3471 @item n
3472 @kindex n (Browse)
3473 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3474 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3475
3476 @item p
3477 @kindex p (Browse)
3478 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3479 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3480
3481 @item SPACE
3482 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3483 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3484 Enter the current group and display the first article
3485 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3486
3487 @item RET
3488 @kindex RET (Browse)
3489 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3490 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3491
3492 @item u
3493 @kindex u (Browse)
3494 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3495 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3496 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3497
3498 @item l
3499 @itemx q
3500 @kindex q (Browse)
3501 @kindex l (Browse)
3502 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3503 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3504
3505 @item d
3506 @kindex d (Browse)
3507 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3508 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3509
3510 @item ?
3511 @kindex ? (Browse)
3512 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3513 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3514 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3515 @end table
3516
3517
3518 @node Exiting Gnus
3519 @section Exiting Gnus
3520 @cindex exiting Gnus
3521
3522 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3523
3524 @table @kbd
3525 @item z
3526 @kindex z (Group)
3527 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3528 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3529 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3530 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3531
3532 @item q
3533 @kindex q (Group)
3534 @findex gnus-group-exit
3535 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3536 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3537
3538 @item Q
3539 @kindex Q (Group)
3540 @findex gnus-group-quit
3541 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3542 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3543 @end table
3544
3545 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3546 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3547 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3548 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3549 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3550 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3551 exiting Gnus.
3552
3553 Note:
3554
3555 @quotation
3556 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3557 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3558 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3559 plastic chair.
3560 @end quotation
3561
3562
3563 @node Group Topics
3564 @section Group Topics
3565 @cindex topics
3566
3567 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3568 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3569 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3570 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3571 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3572 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3573
3574 @iftex
3575 @iflatex
3576 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3577 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3578 }
3579 @end iflatex
3580 @end iftex
3581
3582 Here's an example:
3583
3584 @example
3585 Gnus
3586 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3587 3: comp.emacs
3588 2: alt.religion.emacs
3589 Naughty Emacs
3590 452: alt.sex.emacs
3591 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3592 Misc
3593 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3594 13: comp.sources.unix
3595 @end example
3596
3597 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3598 @kindex t (Group)
3599 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3600 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3601 is a toggling command.)
3602
3603 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3604 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3605 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3606 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3607 Hot and bothered?
3608
3609 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3610 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3611 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3612
3613 @lisp
3614 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3615 @end lisp
3616
3617 @menu
3618 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3619 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3620 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3621 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3622 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3623 @end menu
3624
3625
3626 @node Topic Commands
3627 @subsection Topic Commands
3628 @cindex topic commands
3629
3630 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3631 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3632 definitions slightly.
3633
3634 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3635 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3636 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3637 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3638 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3639 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3640
3641 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3642 the way you like.
3643
3644 @table @kbd
3645
3646 @item T n
3647 @kindex T n (Topic)
3648 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3649 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3650 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3651
3652 @item T TAB
3653 @itemx TAB
3654 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3655 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3656 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3657 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3658 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3659 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3660
3661 @item M-TAB
3662 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3663 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3664 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3665 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3666
3667 @end table
3668
3669 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3670 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3671 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3672 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3673
3674 @table @kbd
3675
3676 @item C-k
3677 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3678 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3679 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3680 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3681
3682 @item C-y
3683 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3684 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3685 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3686 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3687 before all groups.
3688
3689 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3690 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3691 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3692 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3693 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3694
3695 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3696 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3697
3698 @end table
3699
3700 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3701 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3702 key.
3703
3704 @table @kbd
3705
3706 @item RET
3707 @kindex RET (Topic)
3708 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3709 @itemx SPACE
3710 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3711 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3712 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3713 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3714 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3715 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3716
3717 @end table
3718
3719 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3720
3721 @table @kbd
3722
3723 @item T m
3724 @kindex T m (Topic)
3725 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3726 Move the current group to some other topic
3727 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3728 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3729
3730 @item T j
3731 @kindex T j (Topic)
3732 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3733 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3734
3735 @item T c
3736 @kindex T c (Topic)
3737 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3738 Copy the current group to some other topic
3739 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3740 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3741
3742 @item T h
3743 @kindex T h (Topic)
3744 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3745 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3746 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3747
3748 @item T s
3749 @kindex T s (Topic)
3750 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3751 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3752 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3753
3754 @item T D
3755 @kindex T D (Topic)
3756 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3757 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3758 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3759 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3760 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3761 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3762 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3763 topic.
3764
3765 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3766 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3767
3768 @item T M
3769 @kindex T M (Topic)
3770 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3771 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3772 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3773
3774 @item T C
3775 @kindex T C (Topic)
3776 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3777 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3778 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3779
3780 @item T H
3781 @kindex T H (Topic)
3782 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3783 Toggle hiding empty topics
3784 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3785
3786 @item T #
3787 @kindex T # (Topic)
3788 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3789 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3790 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3791 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3792
3793 @item T M-#
3794 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3795 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3796 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3797 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3798 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3799
3800 @item C-c C-x
3801 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3802 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3803 @cindex expiring mail
3804 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3805 expiry process (if any)
3806 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3807
3808 @item T r
3809 @kindex T r (Topic)
3810 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3811 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3812
3813 @item T DEL
3814 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3815 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3816 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3817
3818 @item A T
3819 @kindex A T (Topic)
3820 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3821 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3822 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3823
3824 @item T M-n
3825 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3826 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3827 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3828
3829 @item T M-p
3830 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3831 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3832 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3833
3834 @item G p
3835 @kindex G p (Topic)
3836 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3837 @cindex group parameters
3838 @cindex topic parameters
3839 @cindex parameters
3840 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3841 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3842
3843 @end table
3844
3845
3846 @node Topic Variables
3847 @subsection Topic Variables
3848 @cindex topic variables
3849
3850 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3851 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3852
3853 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3854 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3855 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3856 Valid elements are:
3857
3858 @table @samp
3859 @item i
3860 Indentation.
3861 @item n
3862 Topic name.
3863 @item v
3864 Visibility.
3865 @item l
3866 Level.
3867 @item g
3868 Number of groups in the topic.
3869 @item a
3870 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3871 @item A
3872 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3873 @end table
3874
3875 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3876 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3877 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3878 The default is 2.
3879
3880 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3881 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3882
3883 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3884 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3885 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3886
3887
3888 @node Topic Sorting
3889 @subsection Topic Sorting
3890 @cindex topic sorting
3891
3892 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3893 commands:
3894
3895
3896 @table @kbd
3897 @item T S a
3898 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3899 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3900 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3901 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3902
3903 @item T S u
3904 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3905 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3906 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3907 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3908
3909 @item T S l
3910 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3911 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3912 Sort the current topic by group level
3913 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3914
3915 @item T S v
3916 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3917 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3918 Sort the current topic by group score
3919 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3920
3921 @item T S r
3922 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3923 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3924 Sort the current topic by group rank
3925 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3926
3927 @item T S m
3928 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3929 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3930 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3931 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3932
3933 @item T S e
3934 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3935 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3936 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3937 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3938
3939 @item T S s
3940 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3941 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3942 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3943 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3944 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3945
3946 @end table
3947
3948 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3949 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3950 sorting.
3951
3952
3953 @node Topic Topology
3954 @subsection Topic Topology
3955 @cindex topic topology
3956 @cindex topology
3957
3958 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3959
3960 @example
3961 @group
3962 Gnus
3963 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3964 3: comp.emacs
3965 2: alt.religion.emacs
3966 Naughty Emacs
3967 452: alt.sex.emacs
3968 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3969 Misc
3970 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3971 13: comp.sources.unix
3972 @end group
3973 @end example
3974
3975 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
3976 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
3977 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
3978 follows:
3979
3980 @lisp
3981 (("Gnus" visible)
3982 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
3983 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
3984 (("Misc" visible)))
3985 @end lisp
3986
3987 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
3988 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
3989 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
3990 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
3991 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
3992 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
3993
3994 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
3995 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
3996 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
3997
3998
3999 @node Topic Parameters
4000 @subsection Topic Parameters
4001 @cindex topic parameters
4002
4003 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4004 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4005 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4006 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4007 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4008
4009 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4010 parameters:
4011
4012 @table @code
4013 @item subscribe
4014 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4015 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4016 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4017 topic.
4018
4019 @item subscribe-level
4020 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4021 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4022 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4023
4024 @end table
4025
4026 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4027 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4028 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4029 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4030
4031 @example
4032 @group
4033 Gnus
4034 Emacs
4035 3: comp.emacs
4036 2: alt.religion.emacs
4037 452: alt.sex.emacs
4038 Relief
4039 452: alt.sex.emacs
4040 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4041 Misc
4042 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4043 13: comp.sources.unix
4044 452: alt.sex.emacs
4045 @end group
4046 @end example
4047
4048 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4049 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4050 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4051 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4052 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4053 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4054
4055 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4056 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4057 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4058 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4059 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4060
4061 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4062 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4063 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4064 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4065 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4066 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4067 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4068 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4069
4070
4071 @node Misc Group Stuff
4072 @section Misc Group Stuff
4073
4074 @menu
4075 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4076 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4077 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4078 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4079 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4080 @end menu
4081
4082 @table @kbd
4083
4084 @item v
4085 @kindex v (Group)
4086 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4087 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4088 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4089
4090 @lisp
4091 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4092 (lambda ()
4093 (interactive)
4094 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4095 @end lisp
4096
4097 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4098 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4099
4100 @item ^
4101 @kindex ^ (Group)
4102 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4103 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4104 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4105
4106 @item a
4107 @kindex a (Group)
4108 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4109 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4110 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4111 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4112 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4113 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4114 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4115
4116 @item m
4117 @kindex m (Group)
4118 @findex gnus-group-mail
4119 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4120 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4121 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4122 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4123
4124 @item i
4125 @kindex i (Group)
4126 @findex gnus-group-news
4127 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4128 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4129 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4130
4131 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4132 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4133 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4134 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4135 for this to work though.
4136
4137 @end table
4138
4139 Variables for the group buffer:
4140
4141 @table @code
4142
4143 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4144 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4145 is called after the group buffer has been
4146 created.
4147
4148 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4149 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4150 is called after the group buffer is
4151 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4152 unnatural way.
4153
4154 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4155 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4156 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4157 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4158
4159 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4160 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4161 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4162 whether they are empty or not.
4163
4164 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4165 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4166 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4167 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4168
4169 For example:
4170 @lisp
4171 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4172 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4173 @end lisp
4174
4175 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4176 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4177 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4178 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4179 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4180 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4181 default is @code{nil}.
4182
4183 For example:
4184 @lisp
4185 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4186 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4187 @end lisp
4188
4189 @end table
4190
4191 @node Scanning New Messages
4192 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4193 @cindex new messages
4194 @cindex scanning new news
4195
4196 @table @kbd
4197
4198 @item g
4199 @kindex g (Group)
4200 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4201 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4202 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4203 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4204 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4205 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4206 back end(s).
4207
4208 @item M-g
4209 @kindex M-g (Group)
4210 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4211 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4212 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4213 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4214 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4215 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4216 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4217
4218 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4219 @cindex activating groups
4220 @item C-c M-g
4221 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4222 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4223
4224 @item R
4225 @kindex R (Group)
4226 @cindex restarting
4227 @findex gnus-group-restart
4228 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4229 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4230 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4231
4232 @end table
4233
4234 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4235 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4236
4237 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4238 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4239 news.
4240
4241
4242 @node Group Information
4243 @subsection Group Information
4244 @cindex group information
4245 @cindex information on groups
4246
4247 @table @kbd
4248
4249
4250 @item H f
4251 @kindex H f (Group)
4252 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4253 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4254 @cindex FAQ
4255 @cindex ange-ftp
4256 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4257 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4258 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4259 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4260 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4261 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4262 used for fetching the file.
4263
4264 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4265 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4266
4267 @item H c
4268 @kindex H c (Group)
4269 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4270 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4271 @cindex charter
4272 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4273 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4274 prefix argument.
4275
4276 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4277 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4278 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4279
4280 @item H C
4281 @kindex H C (Group)
4282 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4283 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4284 @cindex control message
4285 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4286 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4287 group if given a prefix argument.
4288
4289 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4290 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4291 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4292 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4293
4294 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4295 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4296 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4297
4298 @item H d
4299 @itemx C-c C-d
4300 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4301 @kindex H d (Group)
4302 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4303 @cindex describing groups
4304 @cindex group description
4305 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4306 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4307 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4308
4309 @item M-d
4310 @kindex M-d (Group)
4311 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4312 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4313 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4314
4315 @item H v
4316 @itemx V
4317 @kindex V (Group)
4318 @kindex H v (Group)
4319 @cindex version
4320 @findex gnus-version
4321 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4322
4323 @item ?
4324 @kindex ? (Group)
4325 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4326 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4327
4328 @item C-c C-i
4329 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4330 @cindex info
4331 @cindex manual
4332 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4333 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4334 @end table
4335
4336
4337 @node Group Timestamp
4338 @subsection Group Timestamp
4339 @cindex timestamps
4340 @cindex group timestamps
4341
4342 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4343 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4344 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4345
4346 @lisp
4347 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4348 @end lisp
4349
4350 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4351
4352 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4353 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4354
4355 @lisp
4356 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4357 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4358 @end lisp
4359
4360 This will result in lines looking like:
4361
4362 @example
4363 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4364 0: custom 19961002T012713
4365 @end example
4366
4367 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4368 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4369 something like:
4370
4371 @lisp
4372 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4373 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4374 @end lisp
4375
4376 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4377 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4378 trick:
4379
4380 @lisp
4381 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4382 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4383 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4384 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4385 (if time
4386 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4387 "")))
4388 @end lisp
4389
4390
4391 @node File Commands
4392 @subsection File Commands
4393 @cindex file commands
4394
4395 @table @kbd
4396
4397 @item r
4398 @kindex r (Group)
4399 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4400 @vindex gnus-init-file
4401 @cindex reading init file
4402 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4403 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4404
4405 @item s
4406 @kindex s (Group)
4407 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4408 @cindex saving .newsrc
4409 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4410 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4411 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4412
4413 @c @item Z
4414 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4415 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4416 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4417
4418 @end table
4419
4420
4421 @node Sieve Commands
4422 @subsection Sieve Commands
4423 @cindex group sieve commands
4424
4425 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4426 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4427 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4428 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4429 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4430
4431 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4432 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4433 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4434 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4435 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4436 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4437 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4438 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4439 regenerate the Sieve script.
4440
4441 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4442 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4443 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4444 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4445 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4446 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4447 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4448 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4449 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4450 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4451
4452 @example
4453 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4454 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4455 stop;
4456 @}
4457 @end example
4458
4459 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4460
4461 @table @kbd
4462
4463 @item D g
4464 @kindex D g (Group)
4465 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4466 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4467 @cindex generating sieve script
4468 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4469 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4470
4471 @item D u
4472 @kindex D u (Group)
4473 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4474 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4475 @cindex updating sieve script
4476 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4477 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4478 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4479
4480 @end table
4481
4482
4483 @node Summary Buffer
4484 @chapter Summary Buffer
4485 @cindex summary buffer
4486
4487 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4488 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4489
4490 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4491 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4492
4493 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4494
4495 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4496 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4497 available in Emacs.
4498
4499 @kindex v (Summary)
4500 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4501 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4502 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4503 @lisp
4504 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4505 @end lisp
4506
4507 @menu
4508 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4509 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4510 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4511 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4512 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4513 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4514 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4515 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4516 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4517 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4518 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4519 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4520 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4521 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4522 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4523 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4524 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4525 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4526 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4527 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4528 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4529 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4530 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4531 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4532 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4533 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4534 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4535 or reselecting the current group.
4536 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4537 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4538 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4539 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4540 @end menu
4541
4542
4543 @node Summary Buffer Format
4544 @section Summary Buffer Format
4545 @cindex summary buffer format
4546
4547 @iftex
4548 @iflatex
4549 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4550 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4551 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4552 }
4553 @end iflatex
4554 @end iftex
4555
4556 @menu
4557 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4558 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4559 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4560 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4561 @end menu
4562
4563 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4564 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4565 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4566 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4567 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4568 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4569 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4570 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4571 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4572 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4573 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4574
4575 @lisp
4576 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4577 'mail-extract-address-components)
4578 @end lisp
4579
4580 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4581 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4582 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4583 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4584
4585
4586 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4587 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4588
4589 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4590 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4591 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4592 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4593 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4594
4595 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4596 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4597 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4598 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4599 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4600 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4601
4602 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4603
4604 The following format specification characters and extended format
4605 specification(s) are understood:
4606
4607 @table @samp
4608 @item N
4609 Article number.
4610 @item S
4611 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4612 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4613 @item s
4614 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4615 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4616 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4617 @item F
4618 Full @code{From} header.
4619 @item n
4620 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4621 @item f
4622 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4623 From Newsgroups}).
4624 @item a
4625 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4626 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4627 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4628 may be more thorough.
4629 @item A
4630 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4631 the @code{a} spec.
4632 @item L
4633 Number of lines in the article.
4634 @item c
4635 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4636 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4637 @item k
4638 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4639 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4640 @item I
4641 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4642 @item B
4643 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4644 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4645
4646 @example
4647 >
4648 +->
4649 | +->
4650 | | \->
4651 | | \->
4652 | \->
4653 +->
4654 \->
4655 @end example
4656
4657 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4658 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4659 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4660 line-drawing glyphs.
4661 @table @code
4662 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4663 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4664 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4665 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4666
4667 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4668 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4669 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4670 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4671
4672 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4673 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4674 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4675 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4676
4677 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4678 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4679 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4680
4681 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4682 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4683 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4684
4685 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4686 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4687 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4688
4689 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4690 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4691 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4692
4693 @end table
4694
4695 @item T
4696 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4697 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4698 @item [
4699 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4700 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4701 @item ]
4702 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4703 for adopted articles.
4704 @item >
4705 One space for each thread level.
4706 @item <
4707 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4708 @item U
4709 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4710
4711 @item R
4712 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4713 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4714 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4715
4716 @item i
4717 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4718 @item z
4719 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4720 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4721 default level. If the difference between
4722 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4723 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4724 @item V
4725 Total thread score.
4726 @item x
4727 @code{Xref}.
4728 @item D
4729 @code{Date}.
4730 @item d
4731 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4732 @item o
4733 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4734 @item M
4735 @code{Message-ID}.
4736 @item r
4737 @code{References}.
4738 @item t
4739 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4740 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4741 @item e
4742 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4743 article has any children.
4744 @item P
4745 The line number.
4746 @item O
4747 Download mark.
4748 @item *
4749 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4750 @item &user-date;
4751 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4752 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4753 @item u
4754 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4755 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4756 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4757 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4758 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4759 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4760 @end table
4761
4762 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4763 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4764 There can only be one such area.
4765
4766 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4767 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4768 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4769 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4770 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4771 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4772
4773 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4774 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4775
4776 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4777
4778
4779 @node To From Newsgroups
4780 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4781 @cindex To
4782 @cindex Newsgroups
4783
4784 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4785 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4786 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4787 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4788 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4789
4790 @enumerate
4791 @item
4792 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4793 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4794 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4795 instance:
4796
4797 @lisp
4798 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4799 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4800 @end lisp
4801
4802 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4803 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4804
4805 @item
4806 @findex gnus-extra-header
4807 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4808 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4809 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4810
4811 @example
4812 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4813 @end example
4814
4815 @item
4816 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4817 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4818 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4819 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4820 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4821 headers are used instead.
4822
4823 @end enumerate
4824
4825 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4826 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4827 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4828 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4829 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4830 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4831 regeneration.
4832
4833 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4834 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4835 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4836 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4837
4838 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4839 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4840
4841 @lisp
4842 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4843 '(To Newsgroups))
4844 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4845 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4846 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4847 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4848 "Your Name Here")
4849 @end lisp
4850
4851 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4852 to fit your needs.)
4853
4854 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4855 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4856 support:
4857
4858 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4859 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4860 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4861
4862 @example
4863 Newsgroups:full
4864 @end example
4865
4866 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4867 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4868
4869
4870 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4871 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4872
4873 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4874 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4875 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4876 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4877
4878 Here are the elements you can play with:
4879
4880 @table @samp
4881 @item G
4882 Group name.
4883 @item p
4884 Unprefixed group name.
4885 @item A
4886 Current article number.
4887 @item z
4888 Current article score.
4889 @item V
4890 Gnus version.
4891 @item U
4892 Number of unread articles in this group.
4893 @item e
4894 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4895 summary buffer.
4896 @item Z
4897 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4898 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4899 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4900 and no unselected ones.
4901 @item g
4902 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4903 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4904 @item S
4905 Subject of the current article.
4906 @item u
4907 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4908 @item s
4909 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4910 @item d
4911 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4912 @item t
4913 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4914 @item r
4915 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4916 @item E
4917 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4918 @end table
4919
4920
4921 @node Summary Highlighting
4922 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4923
4924 @table @code
4925
4926 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4927 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4928 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4929 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4930 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4931
4932 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4933 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4934 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4935 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4936
4937 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4938 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4939 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4940 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4941
4942 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4943 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4944 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4945 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4946 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4947 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4948 to something like
4949 @lisp
4950 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4951 ((> score default) . bold))
4952 @end lisp
4953 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4954 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4955 @end table
4956
4957
4958 @node Summary Maneuvering
4959 @section Summary Maneuvering
4960 @cindex summary movement
4961
4962 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4963 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4964
4965 None of these commands select articles.
4966
4967 @table @kbd
4968 @item G M-n
4969 @itemx M-n
4970 @kindex M-n (Summary)
4971 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
4972 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
4973 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
4974 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
4975
4976 @item G M-p
4977 @itemx M-p
4978 @kindex M-p (Summary)
4979 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
4980 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
4981 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
4982 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
4983
4984 @item G g
4985 @kindex G g (Summary)
4986 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
4987 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
4988 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
4989 @end table
4990
4991 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
4992 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
4993 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
4994 to the group buffer.
4995
4996 Variables related to summary movement:
4997
4998 @table @code
4999
5000 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5001 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5002 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5003 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5004 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5005 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5006 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5007 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5008 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5009 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5010 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5011 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5012 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5013 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5014
5015 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5016 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5017 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5018 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5019 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5020 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5021 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5022
5023 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5024
5025 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5026 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5027 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5028 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5029 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5030
5031 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5032 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5033 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5034 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5035 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5036 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5037 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5038 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5039 threads.
5040
5041 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5042 the given number of lines from the top.
5043
5044 @end table
5045
5046
5047 @node Choosing Articles
5048 @section Choosing Articles
5049 @cindex selecting articles
5050
5051 @menu
5052 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5053 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5054 @end menu
5055
5056
5057 @node Choosing Commands
5058 @subsection Choosing Commands
5059
5060 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5061 and they all select and display an article.
5062
5063 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5064 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5065
5066 @table @kbd
5067 @item SPACE
5068 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5069 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5070 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5071 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5072
5073 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5074 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5075 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5076
5077 @item G n
5078 @itemx n
5079 @kindex n (Summary)
5080 @kindex G n (Summary)
5081 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5082 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5083 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5084
5085 @item G p
5086 @itemx p
5087 @kindex p (Summary)
5088 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5089 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5090 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5091
5092 @item G N
5093 @itemx N
5094 @kindex N (Summary)
5095 @kindex G N (Summary)
5096 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5097 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5098
5099 @item G P
5100 @itemx P
5101 @kindex P (Summary)
5102 @kindex G P (Summary)
5103 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5104 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5105
5106 @item G C-n
5107 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5108 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5109 Go to the next article with the same subject
5110 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5111
5112 @item G C-p
5113 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5114 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5115 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5116 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5117
5118 @item G f
5119 @itemx .
5120 @kindex G f (Summary)
5121 @kindex . (Summary)
5122 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5123 Go to the first unread article
5124 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5125
5126 @item G b
5127 @itemx ,
5128 @kindex G b (Summary)
5129 @kindex , (Summary)
5130 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5131 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5132 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5133 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5134
5135 @item G l
5136 @itemx l
5137 @kindex l (Summary)
5138 @kindex G l (Summary)
5139 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5140 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5141
5142 @item G o
5143 @kindex G o (Summary)
5144 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5145 @cindex history
5146 @cindex article history
5147 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5148 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5149 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5150 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5151 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5152 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5153
5154 @item G j
5155 @itemx j
5156 @kindex j (Summary)
5157 @kindex G j (Summary)
5158 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5159 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5160 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5161
5162 @end table
5163
5164
5165 @node Choosing Variables
5166 @subsection Choosing Variables
5167
5168 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5169
5170 @table @code
5171 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5172 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5173 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5174 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5175 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5176 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5177
5178 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5179 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5180 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5181 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5182 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5183 hook will do so.
5184
5185 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5186 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5187 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5188 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5189 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5190 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5191 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5192 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5193 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5194 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5195 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5196 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5197 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5198 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5199
5200 @end table
5201
5202
5203 @node Paging the Article
5204 @section Scrolling the Article
5205 @cindex article scrolling
5206
5207 @table @kbd
5208
5209 @item SPACE
5210 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5211 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5212 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5213 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5214 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5215
5216 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5217 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5218 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5219 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5220 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5221 what is considered uninteresting with
5222 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5223 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5224
5225 @item DEL
5226 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5227 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5228 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5229
5230 @item RET
5231 @kindex RET (Summary)
5232 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5233 Scroll the current article one line forward
5234 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5235
5236 @item M-RET
5237 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5238 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5239 Scroll the current article one line backward
5240 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5241
5242 @item A g
5243 @itemx g
5244 @kindex A g (Summary)
5245 @kindex g (Summary)
5246 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5247 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5248 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5249 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5250 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5251 the way it came from the server.
5252
5253 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5254 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5255 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5256
5257 @lisp
5258 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5259 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5260 (2 . big5)))
5261 @end lisp
5262
5263 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5264
5265 @item A <
5266 @itemx <
5267 @kindex < (Summary)
5268 @kindex A < (Summary)
5269 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5270 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5271 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5272
5273 @item A >
5274 @itemx >
5275 @kindex > (Summary)
5276 @kindex A > (Summary)
5277 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5278 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5279
5280 @item A s
5281 @itemx s
5282 @kindex A s (Summary)
5283 @kindex s (Summary)
5284 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5285 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5286 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5287
5288 @item h
5289 @kindex h (Summary)
5290 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5291 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5292
5293 @end table
5294
5295
5296 @node Reply Followup and Post
5297 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5298
5299 @menu
5300 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5301 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5302 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5303 * Canceling and Superseding::
5304 @end menu
5305
5306
5307 @node Summary Mail Commands
5308 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5309 @cindex mail
5310 @cindex composing mail
5311
5312 Commands for composing a mail message:
5313
5314 @table @kbd
5315
5316 @item S r
5317 @itemx r
5318 @kindex S r (Summary)
5319 @kindex r (Summary)
5320 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5321 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5322 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5323 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5324 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5325
5326 @item S R
5327 @itemx R
5328 @kindex R (Summary)
5329 @kindex S R (Summary)
5330 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5331 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5332 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5333 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5334 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5335
5336 @item S w
5337 @kindex S w (Summary)
5338 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5339 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5340 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5341 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5342 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5343 present, that's used instead.
5344
5345 @item S W
5346 @kindex S W (Summary)
5347 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5348 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5349 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5350 the process/prefix convention.
5351
5352 @item S v
5353 @kindex S v (Summary)
5354 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5355 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5356 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5357 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5358 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5359 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5360
5361 @item S V
5362 @kindex S V (Summary)
5363 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5364 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5365 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5366 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5367
5368 @item S B r
5369 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5370 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5371 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5372 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5373 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5374 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5375 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5376 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5377
5378 @item S B R
5379 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5380 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5381 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5382 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5383 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5384
5385 @item S o m
5386 @itemx C-c C-f
5387 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5388 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5389 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5390 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5391 Forward the current article to some other person
5392 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5393 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5394 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5395 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5396 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5397 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5398 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5399 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5400 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5401 section.
5402
5403 @item S m
5404 @itemx m
5405 @kindex m (Summary)
5406 @kindex S m (Summary)
5407 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5408 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5409 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5410 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5411 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5412
5413 @item S i
5414 @itemx i
5415 @kindex i (Summary)
5416 @kindex S i (Summary)
5417 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5418 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5419 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5420 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5421
5422 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5423 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5424 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5425 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5426 for this to work though.
5427
5428 @item S D b
5429 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5430 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5431 @cindex bouncing mail
5432 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5433 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5434 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5435 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5436 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5437 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5438 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5439 very well fail, though.
5440
5441 @item S D r
5442 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5443 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5444 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5445 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5446 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5447 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5448 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5449 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5450 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5451 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5452
5453 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5454 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5455 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5456 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5457 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5458
5459 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5460 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5461
5462 @item S D e
5463 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5464 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5465
5466 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5467 if it were a new message before resending.
5468
5469 @item S O m
5470 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5471 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5472 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5473 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5474 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5475
5476 @item S M-c
5477 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5478 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5479 @cindex crossposting
5480 @cindex excessive crossposting
5481 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5482 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5483
5484 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5485 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5486 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5487 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5488 command understands the process/prefix convention
5489 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5490
5491 @end table
5492
5493 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5494 Manual}, for more information.
5495
5496
5497 @node Summary Post Commands
5498 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5499 @cindex post
5500 @cindex composing news
5501
5502 Commands for posting a news article:
5503
5504 @table @kbd
5505 @item S p
5506 @itemx a
5507 @kindex a (Summary)
5508 @kindex S p (Summary)
5509 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5510 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5511 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5512 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5513 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5514
5515 @item S f
5516 @itemx f
5517 @kindex f (Summary)
5518 @kindex S f (Summary)
5519 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5520 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5521 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5522
5523 @item S F
5524 @itemx F
5525 @kindex S F (Summary)
5526 @kindex F (Summary)
5527 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5528 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5529 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5530 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5531 process/prefix convention.
5532
5533 @item S n
5534 @kindex S n (Summary)
5535 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5536 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5537 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5538
5539 @item S N
5540 @kindex S N (Summary)
5541 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5542 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5543 message through mail and include the original message
5544 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5545 the process/prefix convention.
5546
5547 @item S o p
5548 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5549 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5550 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5551 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5552 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5553 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5554 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5555 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5556 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5557 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5558 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5559 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5560 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5561
5562 @item S O p
5563 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5564 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5565 @cindex digests
5566 @cindex making digests
5567 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5568 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5569 process/prefix convention.
5570
5571 @item S u
5572 @kindex S u (Summary)
5573 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5574 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5575 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5576 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5577 @end table
5578
5579 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5580 Manual}, for more information.
5581
5582
5583 @node Summary Message Commands
5584 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5585
5586 @table @kbd
5587 @item S y
5588 @kindex S y (Summary)
5589 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5590 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5591 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5592 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5593 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5594
5595 @end table
5596
5597
5598 @node Canceling and Superseding
5599 @subsection Canceling Articles
5600 @cindex canceling articles
5601 @cindex superseding articles
5602
5603 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5604 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5605
5606 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5607
5608 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5609 @kindex C (Summary)
5610 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5611 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5612 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5613 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5614 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5615 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5616
5617 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5618 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5619 question.
5620
5621 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5622 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5623 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5624
5625 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5626 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5627 message, Message Manual}).
5628
5629 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5630 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5631 your original article.
5632
5633 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5634 @kindex S (Summary)
5635 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5636 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5637 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5638 usual way.
5639
5640 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5641 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5642 have posted almost the same article twice.
5643
5644 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5645 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5646 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5647 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5648 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5649 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5650 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5651 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5652 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5653 canceled/superseded.
5654
5655 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5656
5657 @node Delayed Articles
5658 @section Delayed Articles
5659 @cindex delayed sending
5660 @cindex send delayed
5661
5662 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5663 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5664 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5665 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5666
5667 @lisp
5668 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5669 @end lisp
5670
5671 @findex gnus-delay-article
5672 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5673 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5674 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5675 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5676
5677 @itemize @bullet
5678 @item
5679 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5680 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5681 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5682 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5683
5684 @item
5685 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5686 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5687 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5688
5689 @item
5690 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5691 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5692 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5693 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5694 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5695 that means a time tomorrow.
5696 @end itemize
5697
5698 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5699 couple of variables:
5700
5701 @table @code
5702 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5703 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5704 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5705 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5706
5707 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5708 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5709 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5710 formats described above.
5711
5712 @item gnus-delay-group
5713 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5714 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5715 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5716 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5717
5718 @item gnus-delay-header
5719 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5720 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5721 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5722 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5723 @end table
5724
5725 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5726 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5727 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5728 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5729 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5730
5731 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5732 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5733 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5734 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5735 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5736 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5737 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5738
5739 @table @code
5740 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5741 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5742 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5743 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5744 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5745 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5746 argument is ignored.
5747
5748 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5749 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5750 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5751 @end table
5752
5753
5754 @node Marking Articles
5755 @section Marking Articles
5756 @cindex article marking
5757 @cindex article ticking
5758 @cindex marks
5759
5760 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5761
5762 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5763 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5764 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5765
5766 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5767
5768 @ifinfo
5769 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5770 @end ifinfo
5771
5772 @menu
5773 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5774 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5775 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5776 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5777 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5778 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5779 @end menu
5780
5781
5782 @node Unread Articles
5783 @subsection Unread Articles
5784
5785 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5786 other.
5787
5788 @table @samp
5789 @item !
5790 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5791 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5792
5793 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5794 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5795 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5796 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5797 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5798 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5799 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5800
5801 @item ?
5802 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5803 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5804
5805 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5806 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5807 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5808 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5809 messages.
5810
5811 @item SPACE
5812 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5813 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5814
5815 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5816 @end table
5817
5818
5819 @node Read Articles
5820 @subsection Read Articles
5821 @cindex expirable mark
5822
5823 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5824
5825 @table @samp
5826
5827 @item r
5828 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5829 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5830 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5831
5832 @item R
5833 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5834 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5835
5836 @item O
5837 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5838 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5839 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5840
5841 @item K
5842 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5843 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5844
5845 @item X
5846 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5847 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5848
5849 @item Y
5850 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5851 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5852
5853 @item C
5854 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5855 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5856
5857 @item G
5858 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5859 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5860
5861 @item F
5862 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5863 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5864
5865 @item Q
5866 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5867 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5868 Threading}.
5869
5870 @item M
5871 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5872 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5873 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5874
5875 @end table
5876
5877 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5878 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5879
5880 One more special mark, though:
5881
5882 @table @samp
5883 @item E
5884 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5885 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5886
5887 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5888 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5889 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5890 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5891 any time.
5892 @end table
5893
5894
5895 @node Other Marks
5896 @subsection Other Marks
5897 @cindex process mark
5898 @cindex bookmarks
5899
5900 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5901 read or not.
5902
5903 @itemize @bullet
5904
5905 @item
5906 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5907 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5908 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5909 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5910 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5911
5912 @item
5913 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5914 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5915 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5916 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5917
5918 @item
5919 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5920 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5921 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5922
5923 @item
5924 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5925 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5926 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5927
5928 @item
5929 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5930 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5931 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5932 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5933
5934 @item
5935 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5936 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5937 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5938 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5939 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5940 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5941
5942 @item
5943 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5944 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5945 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5946 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5947
5948 @item
5949 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5950 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5951 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5952 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5953 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5954 use.)
5955
5956 @item
5957 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5958 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5959 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5960 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5961 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5962 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5963
5964 @item
5965 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5966 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
5967 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
5968 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
5969 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
5970 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
5971 use.)
5972
5973 @item
5974 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
5975 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
5976 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
5977 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
5978 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
5979
5980 @item
5981 @vindex gnus-process-mark
5982 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
5983 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
5984 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
5985 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
5986 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
5987
5988 @end itemize
5989
5990 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
5991 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
5992 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
5993
5994 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
5995 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
5996 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
5997
5998
5999 @node Setting Marks
6000 @subsection Setting Marks
6001 @cindex setting marks
6002
6003 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6004
6005 @table @kbd
6006 @item M c
6007 @itemx M-u
6008 @kindex M c (Summary)
6009 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6010 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6011 @cindex mark as unread
6012 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6013 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6014 article as unread.
6015
6016 @item M t
6017 @itemx !
6018 @kindex ! (Summary)
6019 @kindex M t (Summary)
6020 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6021 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6022 @xref{Article Caching}.
6023
6024 @item M ?
6025 @itemx ?
6026 @kindex ? (Summary)
6027 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6028 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6029 Mark the current article as dormant
6030 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6031
6032 @item M d
6033 @itemx d
6034 @kindex M d (Summary)
6035 @kindex d (Summary)
6036 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6037 Mark the current article as read
6038 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6039
6040 @item D
6041 @kindex D (Summary)
6042 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6043 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6044 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6045
6046 @item M k
6047 @itemx k
6048 @kindex k (Summary)
6049 @kindex M k (Summary)
6050 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6051 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6052 and then select the next unread article
6053 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6054
6055 @item M K
6056 @itemx C-k
6057 @kindex M K (Summary)
6058 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6059 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6060 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6061 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6062
6063 @item M C
6064 @kindex M C (Summary)
6065 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6066 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6067 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6068
6069 @item M C-c
6070 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6071 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6072 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6073 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6074
6075 @item M H
6076 @kindex M H (Summary)
6077 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6078 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6079 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6080
6081 @item M h
6082 @kindex M h (Summary)
6083 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6084 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6085 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6086
6087 @item C-w
6088 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6089 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6090 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6091 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6092
6093 @item M V k
6094 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6095 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6096 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6097 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6098
6099 @item M e
6100 @itemx E
6101 @kindex M e (Summary)
6102 @kindex E (Summary)
6103 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6104 Mark the current article as expirable
6105 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6106
6107 @item M b
6108 @kindex M b (Summary)
6109 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6110 Set a bookmark in the current article
6111 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6112
6113 @item M B
6114 @kindex M B (Summary)
6115 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6116 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6117 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6118
6119 @item M V c
6120 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6121 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6122 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6123 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6124
6125 @item M V u
6126 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6127 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6128 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6129 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6130
6131 @item M V m
6132 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6133 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6134 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6135 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6136 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6137 @end table
6138
6139 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6140 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6141 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6142 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6143 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6144 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6145 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6146 The default is @code{t}.
6147
6148
6149 @node Generic Marking Commands
6150 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6151
6152 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6153 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6154 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6155 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6156 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6157 well.
6158
6159 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6160 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6161 command should do.
6162
6163 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6164 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6165 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6166 to list in this manual.
6167
6168 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6169 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6170 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6171 article, you could say something like:
6172
6173 @lisp
6174 @group
6175 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6176 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6177 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6178 @end group
6179 @end lisp
6180
6181 @noindent
6182 or
6183
6184 @lisp
6185 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6186 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6187 @end lisp
6188
6189
6190 @node Setting Process Marks
6191 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6192 @cindex setting process marks
6193
6194 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6195 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6196 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6197 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6198 articles into the cache. For more information,
6199 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6200
6201 @table @kbd
6202
6203 @item M P p
6204 @itemx #
6205 @kindex # (Summary)
6206 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6207 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6208 Mark the current article with the process mark
6209 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6210 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6211
6212 @item M P u
6213 @itemx M-#
6214 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6215 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6216 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6217 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6218
6219 @item M P U
6220 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6221 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6222 Remove the process mark from all articles
6223 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6224
6225 @item M P i
6226 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6227 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6228 Invert the list of process marked articles
6229 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6230
6231 @item M P R
6232 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6233 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6234 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6235 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6236
6237 @item M P G
6238 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6239 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6240 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6241 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6242
6243 @item M P r
6244 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6245 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6246 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6247
6248 @item M P g
6249 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6250 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6251 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6252
6253 @item M P t
6254 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6255 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6256 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6257 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6258
6259 @item M P T
6260 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6261 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6262 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6263 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6264
6265 @item M P v
6266 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6267 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6268 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6269 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6270
6271 @item M P s
6272 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6273 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6274 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6275
6276 @item M P S
6277 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6278 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6279 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6280 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6281
6282 @item M P a
6283 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6284 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6285 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6286
6287 @item M P b
6288 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6289 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6290 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6291 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6292
6293 @item M P k
6294 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6295 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6296 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6297 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6298
6299 @item M P y
6300 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6302 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6303 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6304
6305 @item M P w
6306 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6308 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6309 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6310
6311 @end table
6312
6313 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6314 set process marks based on article body contents.
6315
6316
6317 @node Limiting
6318 @section Limiting
6319 @cindex limiting
6320
6321 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6322 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6323 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6324 buffer.
6325
6326 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6327 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6328 additional articles.
6329
6330 @table @kbd
6331
6332 @item / /
6333 @itemx / s
6334 @kindex / / (Summary)
6335 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6336 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6337 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6338 matching articles.
6339
6340 @item / a
6341 @kindex / a (Summary)
6342 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6343 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6344 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6345 matching articles.
6346
6347 @item / x
6348 @kindex / x (Summary)
6349 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6350 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6351 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6352 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6353 matching articles.
6354
6355 @item / u
6356 @itemx x
6357 @kindex / u (Summary)
6358 @kindex x (Summary)
6359 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6360 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6361 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6362 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6363 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6364
6365 @item / m
6366 @kindex / m (Summary)
6367 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6368 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6369 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6370
6371 @item / t
6372 @kindex / t (Summary)
6373 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6374 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6375 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6376 articles younger than that number of days.
6377
6378 @item / n
6379 @kindex / n (Summary)
6380 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6381 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6382 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6383 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6384
6385 @item / w
6386 @kindex / w (Summary)
6387 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6388 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6389 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6390 the stack.
6391
6392 @item / .
6393 @kindex / . (Summary)
6394 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6395 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6396 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6397
6398 @item / v
6399 @kindex / v (Summary)
6400 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6401 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6402 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6403
6404 @item / p
6405 @kindex / p (Summary)
6406 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6407 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6408 group parameter predicate
6409 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6410 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6411
6412 @item / E
6413 @itemx M S
6414 @kindex M S (Summary)
6415 @kindex / E (Summary)
6416 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6417 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6418 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6419
6420 @item / D
6421 @kindex / D (Summary)
6422 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6423 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6424 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6425
6426 @item / *
6427 @kindex / * (Summary)
6428 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6429 Include all cached articles in the limit
6430 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6431
6432 @item / d
6433 @kindex / d (Summary)
6434 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6435 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6436 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6437
6438 @item / M
6439 @kindex / M (Summary)
6440 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6441 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6442
6443 @item / T
6444 @kindex / T (Summary)
6445 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6446 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6447
6448 @item / c
6449 @kindex / c (Summary)
6450 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6451 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6452 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6453
6454 @item / C
6455 @kindex / C (Summary)
6456 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6457 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6458 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6459 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6460
6461 @item / N
6462 @kindex / N (Summary)
6463 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6464 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6465 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6466
6467 @item / o
6468 @kindex / o (Summary)
6469 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6470 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6471 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6472
6473 @end table
6474
6475
6476 @node Threading
6477 @section Threading
6478 @cindex threading
6479 @cindex article threading
6480
6481 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6482 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6483 hierarchical fashion.
6484
6485 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6486 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6487 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6488 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6489 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6490 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6491 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6492
6493 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6494
6495 @table @dfn
6496 @item root
6497 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6498
6499 @item thread
6500 A tree-like article structure.
6501
6502 @item sub-thread
6503 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6504
6505 @item loose threads
6506 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6507 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6508 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6509 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6510 called loose threads.
6511
6512 @item thread gathering
6513 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6514
6515 @item sparse threads
6516 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6517 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6518
6519 @end table
6520
6521
6522 @menu
6523 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6524 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6525 @end menu
6526
6527
6528 @node Customizing Threading
6529 @subsection Customizing Threading
6530 @cindex customizing threading
6531
6532 @menu
6533 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6534 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6535 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6536 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6537 @end menu
6538
6539
6540 @node Loose Threads
6541 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6542 @cindex <
6543 @cindex >
6544 @cindex loose threads
6545
6546 @table @code
6547 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6548 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6549 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6550 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6551 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6552 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6553
6554 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6555 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6556 There are four possible values:
6557
6558 @iftex
6559 @iflatex
6560 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6561 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6562 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6563 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6564 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6565 }
6566 @end iflatex
6567 @end iftex
6568
6569 @cindex adopting articles
6570
6571 @table @code
6572
6573 @item adopt
6574 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6575 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6576 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6577 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6578
6579 @item dummy
6580 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6581 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6582 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6583 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6584 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6585 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6586 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6587 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6588 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6589 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6590
6591 @item empty
6592 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6593 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6594 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6595 Buffer Format}).)
6596
6597 @item none
6598 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6599 display them after one another.
6600
6601 @item nil
6602 Don't gather loose threads.
6603 @end table
6604
6605 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6606 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6607 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6608 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6609 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6610 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6611 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6612 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6613 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6614 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6615 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6616
6617 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6618 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6619 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6620 Matching}).
6621
6622 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6623 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6624 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6625 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6626 simplification is used.
6627
6628 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6629 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6630 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6631 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6632
6633 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6634 @lisp
6635 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6636 (concat
6637 "\\`\\[?\\("
6638 (mapconcat
6639 'identity
6640 '("looking"
6641 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6642 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6643 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6644 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6645 ;; ...
6646 )
6647 "\\|")
6648 "\\)\\s *\\("
6649 (mapconcat 'identity
6650 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6651 "\\|")
6652 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6653 @end lisp
6654
6655 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6656 subjects.
6657
6658 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6659 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6660 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6661 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6662 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6663 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6664
6665 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6666
6667 @table @code
6668 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6669 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6670 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6671
6672 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6673 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6674 Simplify fuzzily.
6675
6676 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6677 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6678 Remove excessive whitespace.
6679
6680 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6681 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6682 Remove all whitespace.
6683 @end table
6684
6685 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6686
6687
6688 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6689 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6690 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6691 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6692 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6693 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6694 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6695 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6696
6697 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6698 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6699 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6700 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6701 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6702 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6703 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6704 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6705 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6706 cholera:
6707
6708 @table @code
6709 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6710 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6711 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6712 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6713
6714 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6715 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6716 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6717 @end table
6718
6719 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6720 something like:
6721
6722 @lisp
6723 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6724 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6725 @end lisp
6726
6727 @end table
6728
6729
6730 @node Filling In Threads
6731 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6732
6733 @table @code
6734 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6735 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6736 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6737 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6738 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6739 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6740 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6741 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6742 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6743 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6744 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6745 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6746 do about that.
6747
6748 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6749 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6750 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6751
6752 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6753 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6754 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6755 newsgroups.
6756
6757 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6758 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6759 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6760 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6761 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6762 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6763 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6764 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6765 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6766 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6767 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6768 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6769 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6770 @code{nil} by default.
6771
6772 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6773 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6774 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6775 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6776 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6777 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6778 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6779
6780 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6781 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6782 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6783
6784 @end table
6785
6786
6787 @node More Threading
6788 @subsubsection More Threading
6789
6790 @table @code
6791 @item gnus-show-threads
6792 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6793 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6794 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6795 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6796 slower and more awkward.
6797
6798 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6799 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6800 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6801 generated.
6802
6803 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6804 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6805 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6806
6807 Here's an example:
6808
6809 @lisp
6810 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6811 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6812 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6813 @end lisp
6814
6815 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6816 unread, but you get my drift.)
6817
6818
6819 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6820 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6821 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6822 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6823 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6824 threads are expunged.
6825
6826 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6827 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6828 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6829 will be hidden.
6830
6831 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6832 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6833 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6834 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6835 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6836 result in a new thread.
6837
6838 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6839 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6840 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6841 The default is 4.
6842
6843 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6844 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6845 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6846 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6847 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6848 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6849 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6850 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6851 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6852 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6853 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6854
6855 @end table
6856
6857
6858 @node Low-Level Threading
6859 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6860
6861 @table @code
6862
6863 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6864 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6865 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6866
6867 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6868 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6869 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6870 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6871 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6872 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6873 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6874 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6875 meaningful. Here's one example:
6876
6877 @lisp
6878 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6879
6880 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6881 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6882 (when (string-match
6883 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6884 (mail-header-set-id
6885 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6886 header))))
6887 @end lisp
6888
6889 @end table
6890
6891
6892 @node Thread Commands
6893 @subsection Thread Commands
6894 @cindex thread commands
6895
6896 @table @kbd
6897
6898 @item T k
6899 @itemx C-M-k
6900 @kindex T k (Summary)
6901 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6902 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6903 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6904 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6905 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6906 articles instead.
6907
6908 @item T l
6909 @itemx C-M-l
6910 @kindex T l (Summary)
6911 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6912 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6913 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6914 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6915
6916 @item T i
6917 @kindex T i (Summary)
6918 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6919 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6920 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6921
6922 @item T #
6923 @kindex T # (Summary)
6924 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6925 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6926 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6927
6928 @item T M-#
6929 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6930 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6931 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6932 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6933
6934 @item T T
6935 @kindex T T (Summary)
6936 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6937 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6938
6939 @item T s
6940 @kindex T s (Summary)
6941 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6942 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6943 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6944
6945 @item T h
6946 @kindex T h (Summary)
6947 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6948 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6949
6950 @item T S
6951 @kindex T S (Summary)
6952 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6953 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6954
6955 @item T H
6956 @kindex T H (Summary)
6957 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6958 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6959
6960 @item T t
6961 @kindex T t (Summary)
6962 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6963 Re-thread the current article's thread
6964 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6965 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6966
6967 @item T ^
6968 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
6969 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
6970 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
6971 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
6972
6973 @end table
6974
6975 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
6976 understand the numeric prefix.
6977
6978 @table @kbd
6979
6980 @item T n
6981 @kindex T n (Summary)
6982 @itemx C-M-f
6983 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
6984 @itemx M-down
6985 @kindex M-down (Summary)
6986 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
6987 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
6988
6989 @item T p
6990 @kindex T p (Summary)
6991 @itemx C-M-b
6992 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
6993 @itemx M-up
6994 @kindex M-up (Summary)
6995 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
6996 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
6997
6998 @item T d
6999 @kindex T d (Summary)
7000 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7001 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7002
7003 @item T u
7004 @kindex T u (Summary)
7005 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7006 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7007
7008 @item T o
7009 @kindex T o (Summary)
7010 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7011 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7012 @end table
7013
7014 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7015 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7016 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7017 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7018 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7019 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7020 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7021 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7022 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7023 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7024 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7025 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7026 Matching}).
7027
7028
7029 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7030 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7031
7032 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7033 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7034 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7035 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7036 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7037 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7038 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7039 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7040 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7041 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7042 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7043 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7044 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7045 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7046
7047 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7048 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7049 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7050 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7051 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7052 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7053 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7054 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7055
7056 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7057 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7058 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
7059
7060 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7061 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7062 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7063 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7064 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7065 ascending article order.
7066
7067 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7068 by number, you could do something like:
7069
7070 @lisp
7071 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7072 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7073 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7074 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7075 @end lisp
7076
7077 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7078 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7079 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7080 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7081 which the articles arrived.
7082
7083 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7084 say something like:
7085
7086 @lisp
7087 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7088 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7089 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7090 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7091 @end lisp
7092
7093 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7094 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7095 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7096 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7097 tickles your fancy.
7098
7099 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7100 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7101 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7102 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7103 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7104 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7105 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7106 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7107 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7108 variable. It is very similar to the
7109 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7110 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7111 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7112 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7113 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7114 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7115 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7116
7117 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7118 say something like:
7119
7120 @lisp
7121 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7122 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7123 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7124 @end lisp
7125
7126
7127
7128 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7129 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7130 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7131 @cindex article pre-fetch
7132 @cindex pre-fetch
7133
7134 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7135 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7136 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7137 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7138 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7139
7140 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7141 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7142
7143 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7144 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7145 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7146 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7147 connection is blocked.
7148
7149 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7150 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7151 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7152 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7153
7154 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7155 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7156 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7157 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7158 extra connection.
7159
7160 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7161 you really want to.
7162
7163 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7164 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7165 happen automatically.
7166
7167 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7168 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7169 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7170 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7171 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7172 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7173 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7174
7175 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7176 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7177 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7178 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7179 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7180 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7181 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7182 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7183 article data structure as the only parameter.
7184
7185 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7186 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7187
7188 @lisp
7189 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7190 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7191 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7192 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7193 100)))
7194
7195 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7196 @end lisp
7197
7198 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7199 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7200 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7201
7202 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7203 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7204 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7205 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7206
7207 @table @code
7208 @item read
7209 Remove articles when they are read.
7210
7211 @item exit
7212 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7213 @end table
7214
7215 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7216
7217 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7218 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7219 @c from the next group.
7220
7221
7222 @node Article Caching
7223 @section Article Caching
7224 @cindex article caching
7225 @cindex caching
7226
7227 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7228 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7229 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7230 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7231 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7232
7233 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7234
7235 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7236 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7237 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7238 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7239 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7240 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7241 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7242 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7243
7244 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7245 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7246 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7247 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7248 as dormant, and don't worry.
7249
7250 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7251
7252 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7253 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7254 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7255 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7256 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7257 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7258 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7259 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7260 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7261 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7262
7263 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7264 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7265 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7266 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7267 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7268 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7269 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7270 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7271 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7272 not then be downloaded by this command.
7273
7274 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7275 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7276 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7277 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7278 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7279 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7280
7281 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7282 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7283 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7284 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7285 variables, the group is not cached.
7286
7287 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7288 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7289 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7290 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7291 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7292 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7293 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7294 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7295 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7296 file.
7297
7298 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7299 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7300 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7301 where, isn't that cool?
7302
7303 @node Persistent Articles
7304 @section Persistent Articles
7305 @cindex persistent articles
7306
7307 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7308 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7309 useful in my opinion.
7310
7311 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7312 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7313 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7314 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7315 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7316 the expiry going on at the news server.
7317
7318 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7319 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7320 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7321
7322 @table @kbd
7323
7324 @item *
7325 @kindex * (Summary)
7326 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7327 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7328
7329 @item M-*
7330 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7331 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7332 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7333 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7334 article.
7335 @end table
7336
7337 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7338
7339 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7340 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7341 interested in persistent articles:
7342
7343 @lisp
7344 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7345 @end lisp
7346
7347
7348 @node Article Backlog
7349 @section Article Backlog
7350 @cindex backlog
7351 @cindex article backlog
7352
7353 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7354 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7355 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7356 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7357 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7358 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7359 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7360 increase memory usage some.
7361
7362 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7363 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7364 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7365 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7366 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7367 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7368 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7369
7370 The default value is 20.
7371
7372
7373 @node Saving Articles
7374 @section Saving Articles
7375 @cindex saving articles
7376
7377 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7378 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7379 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7380 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7381 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7382
7383 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7384 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7385 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7386
7387 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7388 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7389 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7390
7391 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7392 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7393 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7394 deleted before saving.
7395
7396 @table @kbd
7397
7398 @item O o
7399 @itemx o
7400 @kindex O o (Summary)
7401 @kindex o (Summary)
7402 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7403 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7404 Save the current article using the default article saver
7405 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7406
7407 @item O m
7408 @kindex O m (Summary)
7409 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7410 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7411 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7412
7413 @item O r
7414 @kindex O r (Summary)
7415 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7416 Save the current article in Rmail format
7417 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7418
7419 @item O f
7420 @kindex O f (Summary)
7421 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7422 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7423 Save the current article in plain file format
7424 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7425
7426 @item O F
7427 @kindex O F (Summary)
7428 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7429 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7430 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7431
7432 @item O b
7433 @kindex O b (Summary)
7434 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7435 Save the current article body in plain file format
7436 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7437
7438 @item O h
7439 @kindex O h (Summary)
7440 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7441 Save the current article in mh folder format
7442 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7443
7444 @item O v
7445 @kindex O v (Summary)
7446 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7447 Save the current article in a VM folder
7448 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7449
7450 @item O p
7451 @itemx |
7452 @kindex O p (Summary)
7453 @kindex | (Summary)
7454 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7455 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7456 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7457 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7458 complete headers in the piped output.
7459
7460 @item O P
7461 @kindex O P (Summary)
7462 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7463 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7464 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7465 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7466 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7467 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7468 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7469
7470 @end table
7471
7472 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7473 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7474 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7475 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7476 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7477 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7478 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7479 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7480 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7481 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7482 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7483 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7484 files.
7485
7486
7487 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7488 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7489 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7490 functions below, or you can create your own.
7491
7492 @table @code
7493
7494 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7495 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7496 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7497 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7498 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7499 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7500 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7501
7502 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7503 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7504 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7505 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7506 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7507 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7508
7509 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7510 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7511 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7512 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7513 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7514 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7515 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7516
7517 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7518 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7519 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7520 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7521 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7522 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7523
7524 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7525 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7526 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7527 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7528 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7529
7530 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7531 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7532 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7533 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7534 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7535 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7536
7537 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7538 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7539 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7540 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7541 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7542 @cindex rcvstore
7543 @cindex MH folders
7544 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7545 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7546 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7547 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7548 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7549
7550 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7551 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7552 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7553 reader to use this setting.
7554 @end table
7555
7556 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7557
7558 @table @code
7559 @item :decode
7560 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7561 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7562 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7563 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file}, and
7564 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7565
7566 @item :function
7567 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7568 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7569 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7570 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7571 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7572 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7573
7574 @item :headers
7575 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7576 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7577 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7578 headers should be saved.
7579 @end table
7580
7581 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7582 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7583 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7584 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7585 default.
7586
7587 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7588 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7589 available functions that generate names:
7590
7591 @table @code
7592
7593 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7594 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7595 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7596
7597 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7598 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7599 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7600
7601 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7602 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7603 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7604
7605 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7606 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7607 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7608
7609 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7610 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7611 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7612 @end table
7613
7614 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7615 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7616 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7617 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7618 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7619 like:
7620
7621 @lisp
7622 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7623 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7624 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7625 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7626 @end lisp
7627
7628 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7629 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7630 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7631 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7632 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7633 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7634 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7635 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7636 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7637
7638 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7639 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7640 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7641 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7642
7643 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7644 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7645 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7646 name.
7647
7648 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7649 lots of mail groups called things like
7650 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7651 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7652 following will do just that:
7653
7654 @lisp
7655 (defun my-save-name (group)
7656 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7657 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7658
7659 (setq gnus-split-methods
7660 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7661 (my-save-name)))
7662 @end lisp
7663
7664
7665 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7666 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7667 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7668 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7669 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7670 all the files in the top level directory
7671 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7672 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7673 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7674 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7675
7676 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7677 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7678 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7679 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7680 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7681 for kill files.
7682
7683 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7684 a spool, you could
7685
7686 @lisp
7687 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7688 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7689 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7690 @end lisp
7691
7692 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7693 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7694 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7695 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7696
7697
7698 @node Decoding Articles
7699 @section Decoding Articles
7700 @cindex decoding articles
7701
7702 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7703 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7704
7705 @menu
7706 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7707 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7708 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7709 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7710 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7711 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7712 @end menu
7713
7714 @cindex series
7715 @cindex article series
7716 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7717 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7718 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7719 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7720 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7721
7722 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7723 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7724 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7725
7726 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7727 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7728 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7729
7730 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7731 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7732 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7733
7734
7735 @node Uuencoded Articles
7736 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7737 @cindex uudecode
7738 @cindex uuencoded articles
7739
7740 @table @kbd
7741
7742 @item X u
7743 @kindex X u (Summary)
7744 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7745 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7746 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7747
7748 @item X U
7749 @kindex X U (Summary)
7750 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7751 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7752 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7753
7754 @item X v u
7755 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7756 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7757 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7758
7759 @item X v U
7760 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7761 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7762 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7763 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7764
7765 @end table
7766
7767 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7768 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7769 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7770 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7771 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7772
7773 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7774 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7775 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7776 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7777 @kbd{X u}.
7778
7779 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7780 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7781 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7782 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7783 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7784 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7785 off.
7786
7787
7788 @node Shell Archives
7789 @subsection Shell Archives
7790 @cindex unshar
7791 @cindex shell archives
7792 @cindex shared articles
7793
7794 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7795 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7796 some commands to deal with these:
7797
7798 @table @kbd
7799
7800 @item X s
7801 @kindex X s (Summary)
7802 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7803 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7804
7805 @item X S
7806 @kindex X S (Summary)
7807 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7808 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7809
7810 @item X v s
7811 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7812 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7813 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7814
7815 @item X v S
7816 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7817 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7818 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7819 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7820 @end table
7821
7822
7823 @node PostScript Files
7824 @subsection PostScript Files
7825 @cindex PostScript
7826
7827 @table @kbd
7828
7829 @item X p
7830 @kindex X p (Summary)
7831 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7832 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7833
7834 @item X P
7835 @kindex X P (Summary)
7836 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7837 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7838 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7839
7840 @item X v p
7841 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7842 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7843 View the current PostScript series
7844 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7845
7846 @item X v P
7847 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7848 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7849 View and save the current PostScript series
7850 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7851 @end table
7852
7853
7854 @node Other Files
7855 @subsection Other Files
7856
7857 @table @kbd
7858 @item X o
7859 @kindex X o (Summary)
7860 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7861 Save the current series
7862 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7863
7864 @item X b
7865 @kindex X b (Summary)
7866 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7867 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7868 doesn't really work yet.
7869 @end table
7870
7871
7872 @node Decoding Variables
7873 @subsection Decoding Variables
7874
7875 Adjective, not verb.
7876
7877 @menu
7878 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7879 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7880 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7881 @end menu
7882
7883
7884 @node Rule Variables
7885 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7886 @cindex rule variables
7887
7888 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7889 variables are of the form
7890
7891 @lisp
7892 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7893 '(regexp2 command2)
7894 ...)
7895 @end lisp
7896
7897 @table @code
7898
7899 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7900 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7901 @cindex sox
7902 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7903 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7904 say something like:
7905 @lisp
7906 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7907 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7908 @end lisp
7909
7910 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7911 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7912 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7913 user and default view rules.
7914
7915 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7916 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7917 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7918 archives.
7919 @end table
7920
7921
7922 @node Other Decode Variables
7923 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7924
7925 @table @code
7926 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7927
7928 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7929 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7930 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7931 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7932 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7933
7934 @table @code
7935
7936 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7937 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7938 View the file.
7939
7940 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7941 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7942 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7943 @end table
7944
7945 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7946 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7947 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7948 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7949 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7950 time.
7951
7952 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7953 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7954 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7955
7956 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7957 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7958 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7959 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7960 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7961 kludgey.
7962
7963 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7964 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7965 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7966
7967 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7968 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
7969 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
7970 looking for files to display.
7971
7972 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
7973 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
7974 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
7975 after viewing it.
7976
7977 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7978 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
7979 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
7980 rules.
7981
7982 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7983 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
7984 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
7985 unpacking commands.
7986
7987 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7988 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
7989 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
7990 from articles.
7991
7992 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7993 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
7994 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
7995 decoded articles as unread.
7996
7997 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7998 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
7999 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8000 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8001
8002 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8003 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8004 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8005
8006 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8007 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8008 @cindex metamail
8009 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8010 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8011 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8012 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8013
8014 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8015 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8016 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8017 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8018 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8019 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8020 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8021 simply dropped them.
8022
8023 @end table
8024
8025
8026 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8027 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8028
8029 @table @code
8030
8031 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8032 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8033 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8034 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8035 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8036 for you when you post the article.
8037
8038 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8039 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8040 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8041 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8042
8043 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8044 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8045 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8046 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8047 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8048 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8049 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8050
8051 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8052 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8053 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8054 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8055 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8056 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8057 Default is @code{t}.
8058
8059 @end table
8060
8061
8062 @node Viewing Files
8063 @subsection Viewing Files
8064 @cindex viewing files
8065 @cindex pseudo-articles
8066
8067 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8068 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8069 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8070 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8071 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8072 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8073 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8074
8075 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8076 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8077 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8078 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8079
8080 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8081 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8082 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8083
8084 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8085 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8086 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8087 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8088 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8089
8090 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8091 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8092 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8093 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8094 a list of parameters to that command.
8095
8096 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8097 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8098 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8099
8100 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8101 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8102 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8103
8104
8105 @node Article Treatment
8106 @section Article Treatment
8107
8108 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8109 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8110 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8111 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8112 these articles easier.
8113
8114 @menu
8115 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8116 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8117 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8118 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8119 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8120 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8121 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8122 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8123 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8124 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8125 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8126 @end menu
8127
8128
8129 @node Article Highlighting
8130 @subsection Article Highlighting
8131 @cindex highlighting
8132
8133 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8134 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8135
8136 @table @kbd
8137
8138 @item W H a
8139 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8140 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8141 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8142 Do much highlighting of the current article
8143 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8144 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8145
8146 @item W H h
8147 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8148 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8149 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8150 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8151 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8152 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8153 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8154 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8155 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8156 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8157 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8158 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8159
8160 @item W H c
8161 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8162 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8163 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8164
8165 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8166
8167 @table @code
8168 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8169
8170 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8171 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8172 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8173
8174 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8175 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8176 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8177
8178 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8179 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8180 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8181 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8182 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8183 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8184
8185 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8186 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8187 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8188
8189 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8190 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8191 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8192
8193 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8194 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8195 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8196 that it's a citation.
8197
8198 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8199 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8200 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8201
8202 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8203 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8204 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8205
8206 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8207 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8208 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8209 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8210
8211 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8212 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8213 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8214 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8215 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8216 is @code{t}.
8217
8218 @end table
8219
8220
8221 @item W H s
8222 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8223 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8224 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8225 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8226 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8227 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8228 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8229 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8230 default.
8231
8232 @end table
8233
8234 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8235
8236
8237 @node Article Fontisizing
8238 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8239 @cindex emphasis
8240 @cindex article emphasis
8241
8242 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8243 @kindex W e (Summary)
8244 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8245 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8246 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8247 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8248
8249 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8250 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8251 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8252 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8253 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8254 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8255 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8256 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8257 highlighting.
8258
8259 @lisp
8260 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8261 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8262 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8263 @end lisp
8264
8265 @cindex slash
8266 @cindex asterisk
8267 @cindex underline
8268 @cindex /
8269 @cindex *
8270
8271 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8272 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8273 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8274 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8275 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8276 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8277 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8278 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8279 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8280 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8281 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8282 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8283 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8284
8285 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8286 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8287 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8288 say something like:
8289
8290 @lisp
8291 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8292 @end lisp
8293
8294 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8295
8296 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8297 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8298 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8299 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8300
8301 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8302
8303
8304 @node Article Hiding
8305 @subsection Article Hiding
8306 @cindex article hiding
8307
8308 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8309 too much cruft in most articles.
8310
8311 @table @kbd
8312
8313 @item W W a
8314 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8315 @findex gnus-article-hide
8316 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8317 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8318 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8319
8320 @item W W h
8321 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8322 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8323 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8324 Headers}.
8325
8326 @item W W b
8327 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8328 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8329 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8330 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8331
8332 @item W W s
8333 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8334 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8335 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8336 Signature}.
8337
8338 @item W W l
8339 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8340 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8341 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8342 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8343 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8344 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8345 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8346 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8347
8348 @table @code
8349
8350 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8351 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8352 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8353 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8354
8355 @end table
8356
8357 @item W W P
8358 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8359 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8360 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8361 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8362
8363 @item W W B
8364 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8365 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8366 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8367 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8368 @cindex banner
8369 @cindex OneList
8370 @cindex stripping advertisements
8371 @cindex advertisements
8372 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8373 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8374 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8375 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8376 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8377 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8378 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8379 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8380 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8381 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8382 used.
8383
8384 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8385 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8386 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8387
8388 @table @code
8389
8390 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8391 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8392 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8393 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8394 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8395 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8396 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8397 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8398 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8399 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8400 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8401
8402 @lisp
8403 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8404 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8405 @end lisp
8406
8407 @end table
8408
8409 @item W W c
8410 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8411 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8412 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8413 customizing the hiding:
8414
8415 @table @code
8416
8417 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8418 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8419 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8420 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8421 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8422 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8423 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8424 specs are valid:
8425
8426 @table @samp
8427 @item b
8428 Starting point of the hidden text.
8429 @item e
8430 Ending point of the hidden text.
8431 @item l
8432 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8433 @item n
8434 Number of lines of hidden text.
8435 @end table
8436
8437 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8438 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8439 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8440 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8441 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8442
8443 @end table
8444
8445 @item W W C-c
8446 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8447 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8448
8449 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8450 following two variables:
8451
8452 @table @code
8453 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8454 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8455 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8456 50), hide the cited text.
8457
8458 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8459 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8460 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8461 is hidden.
8462 @end table
8463
8464 @item W W C
8465 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8466 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8467 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8468 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8469 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8470 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8471
8472 @end table
8473
8474 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8475 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8476 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8477
8478 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8479 citation customization.
8480
8481 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8482 automatically.
8483
8484
8485 @node Article Washing
8486 @subsection Article Washing
8487 @cindex washing
8488 @cindex article washing
8489
8490 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8491 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8492
8493 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8494 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8495 Cleaner, perhaps.
8496
8497 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8498 articles by default.
8499
8500 @table @kbd
8501
8502 @item C-u g
8503 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8504 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8505 the server.
8506
8507 @item g
8508 Force redisplaying of the current article
8509 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8510 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8511 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8512 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8513
8514 @item W l
8515 @kindex W l (Summary)
8516 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8517 Remove page breaks from the current article
8518 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8519 delimiters.
8520
8521 @item W r
8522 @kindex W r (Summary)
8523 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8524 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8525 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8526 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8527 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8528 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8529
8530 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8531 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8532 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8533 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8534
8535 @item W m
8536 @kindex W m (Summary)
8537 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8538 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8539
8540 @item W t
8541 @item t
8542 @kindex W t (Summary)
8543 @kindex t (Summary)
8544 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8545 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8546 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8547
8548 @item W v
8549 @kindex W v (Summary)
8550 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8551 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8552 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8553
8554 @item W o
8555 @kindex W o (Summary)
8556 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8557 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8558
8559 @item W d
8560 @kindex W d (Summary)
8561 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8562 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8563 @cindex Smartquotes
8564 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8565 @cindex Latin 1
8566 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8567 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8568 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8569 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8570 interactively.
8571
8572 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8573 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8574 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8575 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8576
8577 @item W Y f
8578 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8579 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8580 @cindex Outlook Express
8581 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8582 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8583 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8584
8585 @item W Y u
8586 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8587 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8588 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8589 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8590 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8591 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8592 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8593 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8594 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8595 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8596
8597 @item W Y a
8598 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8599 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8600 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8601 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8602
8603 @item W Y c
8604 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8605 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8606 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8607 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8608
8609 @item W w
8610 @kindex W w (Summary)
8611 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8612 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8613
8614 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8615 when filling.
8616
8617 @item W Q
8618 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8619 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8620 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8621
8622 @item W C
8623 @kindex W C (Summary)
8624 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8625 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8626 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8627
8628 @item W c
8629 @kindex W c (Summary)
8630 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8631 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8632 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8633 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8634 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8635
8636 @item W q
8637 @kindex W q (Summary)
8638 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8639 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8640 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8641 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8642 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8643 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8644 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8645 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8646 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8647
8648 @item W 6
8649 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8650 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8651 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8652 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8653 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8654 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8655 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8656 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8657
8658 @item W Z
8659 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8660 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8661 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8662 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8663 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8664
8665 @item W u
8666 @kindex W u (Summary)
8667 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8668 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8669 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8670 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8671 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8672
8673 @item W h
8674 @kindex W h (Summary)
8675 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8676 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8677 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8678 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8679
8680 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
8681 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
8682 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
8683
8684 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8685 The default is to use the function specified by
8686 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8687 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8688 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8689 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8690 can use include:
8691
8692 @table @code
8693 @item w3
8694 Use Emacs/W3.
8695
8696 @item w3m
8697 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8698
8699 @item w3m-standalone
8700 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
8701
8702 @item links
8703 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8704
8705 @item lynx
8706 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8707
8708 @item html2text
8709 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8710
8711 @end table
8712
8713 @item W b
8714 @kindex W b (Summary)
8715 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8716 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8717 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8718
8719 @item W B
8720 @kindex W B (Summary)
8721 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8722 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8723 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8724
8725 @item W p
8726 @kindex W p (Summary)
8727 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8728 Verify a signed control message
8729 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8730 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8731 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8732 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8733 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8734 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8735
8736 @item W s
8737 @kindex W s (Summary)
8738 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8739 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8740 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8741 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8742
8743 @item W a
8744 @kindex W a (Summary)
8745 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8746 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8747 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8748
8749 @item W E l
8750 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8751 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8752 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8753 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8754
8755 @item W E m
8756 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8757 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8758 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8759 lines with a single empty line.
8760 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8761
8762 @item W E t
8763 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8764 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8765 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8766 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8767
8768 @item W E a
8769 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8770 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8771 Do all the three commands above
8772 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8773
8774 @item W E A
8775 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8776 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8777 Remove all blank lines
8778 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8779
8780 @item W E s
8781 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8782 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8783 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8784 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8785
8786 @item W E e
8787 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8788 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8789 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8790 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8791
8792 @end table
8793
8794 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8795
8796
8797 @node Article Header
8798 @subsection Article Header
8799
8800 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8801
8802 @table @kbd
8803
8804 @item W G u
8805 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8806 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8807 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8808
8809 @item W G n
8810 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8811 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8812 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8813 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8814
8815 @item W G f
8816 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8817 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8818 Fold all the message headers
8819 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8820
8821 @item W E w
8822 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8823 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8824 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8825 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8826
8827 @end table
8828
8829
8830 @node Article Buttons
8831 @subsection Article Buttons
8832 @cindex buttons
8833
8834 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8835 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8836 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8837 button on these references.
8838
8839 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8840 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8841 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8842 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8843 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8844
8845 @table @code
8846
8847 @item gnus-button-alist
8848 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8849 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8850
8851 @lisp
8852 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8853 @end lisp
8854
8855 @table @var
8856
8857 @item regexp
8858 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8859 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8860 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8861 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8862 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8863
8864 @item button-par
8865 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8866 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8867 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8868
8869 @item use-p
8870 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8871 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8872 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8873 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8874 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8875
8876 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8877
8878 @item function
8879 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8880
8881 @item data-par
8882 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8883 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8884
8885 @end table
8886
8887 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8888
8889 @lisp
8890 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8891 @end lisp
8892
8893 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8894 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8895 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8896 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8897 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8898
8899 @lisp
8900 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8901 @end lisp
8902
8903 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8904 @end table
8905
8906 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8907
8908 @table @code
8909 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8910 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8911
8912 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8913
8914 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8915 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8916 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8917 default values of the variables above.
8918
8919 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8920
8921 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8922 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8923 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8924 argument with a string naming the man page.
8925
8926 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8927
8928 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8929 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8930 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8931
8932 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8933 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8934 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8935 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8936 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8937 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8938 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8939 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
8940 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8941 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8942 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8943 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8944
8945 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8946 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8947 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8948 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8949 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8950 string is invalid.
8951
8952 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8953 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8954 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8955 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8956
8957 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8958
8959 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8960 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8961 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8962 argument, the string naming the URL.
8963
8964 @item gnus-ctan-url
8965 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8966 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
8967 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
8968
8969 @c Misc stuff
8970
8971 @item gnus-article-button-face
8972 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
8973 Face used on buttons.
8974
8975 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
8976 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
8977 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
8978
8979 @end table
8980
8981 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
8982
8983
8984 @node Article Button Levels
8985 @subsection Article button levels
8986 @cindex button levels
8987 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
8988 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
8989 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
8990 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
8991 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
8992 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
8993 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
8994 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
8995
8996 @lisp
8997 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
8998 (setq gnus-parameters
8999 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9000 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9001 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9002 @end lisp
9003
9004 @table @code
9005
9006 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9007 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9008 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9009 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9010 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9011 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9012
9013 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9014 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9015 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9016 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9017 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9018 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9019 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9020 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9021 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9022 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9023 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9024 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9025 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9026
9027 @item gnus-button-man-level
9028 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9029 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9030 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9031
9032 @item gnus-button-message-level
9033 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9034 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9035 Related variables and functions include
9036 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9037 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9038 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9039 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9040
9041 @item gnus-button-tex-level
9042 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
9043 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
9044 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
9045 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
9046 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
9047 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
9048
9049 @end table
9050
9051
9052 @node Article Date
9053 @subsection Article Date
9054
9055 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9056 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9057 when the article was sent.
9058
9059 @table @kbd
9060
9061 @item W T u
9062 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9063 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9064 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9065 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9066
9067 @item W T i
9068 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9069 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9070 @cindex ISO 8601
9071 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9072 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9073
9074 @item W T l
9075 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9076 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9077 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9078
9079 @item W T p
9080 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9081 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9082 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9083 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9084
9085 @item W T s
9086 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9087 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9088 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9089 @findex format-time-string
9090 Display the date using a user-defined format
9091 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9092 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9093 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9094 for a list of possible format specs.
9095
9096 @item W T e
9097 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9098 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9099 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9100 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9101 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9102 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9103
9104 @example
9105 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9106 @end example
9107
9108 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9109 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9110 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9111 replace it.
9112
9113 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9114 into wonderful absurdities.
9115
9116 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9117
9118 @lisp
9119 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9120 @end lisp
9121
9122 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9123 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9124 command.
9125
9126 @item W T o
9127 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9128 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9129 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9130 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9131 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9132 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9133 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9134
9135 @end table
9136
9137 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9138 preferred format automatically.
9139
9140
9141 @node Article Display
9142 @subsection Article Display
9143 @cindex picons
9144 @cindex x-face
9145 @cindex smileys
9146
9147 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9148 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9149
9150 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9151 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9152
9153 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9154 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9155
9156 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9157 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9158
9159 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9160 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9161
9162 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9163 they'll be removed.
9164
9165 @table @kbd
9166 @item W D x
9167 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9168 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9169 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9170 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9171
9172 @item W D d
9173 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9174 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9175 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9176 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9177
9178 @item W D s
9179 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9180 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9181 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9182
9183 @item W D f
9184 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9185 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9186 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9187
9188 @item W D m
9189 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9190 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9191 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9192 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9193
9194 @item W D n
9195 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9196 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9197 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9198 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9199
9200 @item W D D
9201 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9202 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9203 Remove all images from the article buffer
9204 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9205
9206 @end table
9207
9208
9209
9210 @node Article Signature
9211 @subsection Article Signature
9212 @cindex signatures
9213 @cindex article signature
9214
9215 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9216 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9217 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9218 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9219 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9220 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9221 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9222 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9223 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9224
9225 @lisp
9226 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9227 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9228 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9229 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9230 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9231 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9232 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9233 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9234 @end lisp
9235
9236 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9237 positives.
9238
9239 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9240 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9241 signature when displaying articles.
9242
9243 @enumerate
9244 @item
9245 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9246 that integer.
9247 @item
9248 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9249 than that number.
9250 @item
9251 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9252 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9253 @item
9254 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9255 in question is not a signature.
9256 @end enumerate
9257
9258 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9259 listed above. Here's an example:
9260
9261 @lisp
9262 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9263 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9264 @end lisp
9265
9266 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9267 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9268 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9269 signature after all.
9270
9271
9272 @node Article Miscellanea
9273 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9274
9275 @table @kbd
9276 @item A t
9277 @kindex A t (Summary)
9278 @findex gnus-article-babel
9279 Translate the article from one language to another
9280 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9281
9282 @end table
9283
9284
9285 @node MIME Commands
9286 @section MIME Commands
9287 @cindex MIME decoding
9288 @cindex attachments
9289 @cindex viewing attachments
9290
9291 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9292 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9293
9294 @table @kbd
9295 @item b
9296 @itemx K v
9297 @kindex b (Summary)
9298 @kindex K v (Summary)
9299 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9300
9301 @item K o
9302 @kindex K o (Summary)
9303 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9304
9305 @item K c
9306 @kindex K c (Summary)
9307 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9308
9309 @item K e
9310 @kindex K e (Summary)
9311 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9312
9313 @item K i
9314 @kindex K i (Summary)
9315 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9316
9317 @item K |
9318 @kindex K | (Summary)
9319 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9320 @end table
9321
9322 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9323 the same manner:
9324
9325 @table @kbd
9326 @item K b
9327 @kindex K b (Summary)
9328 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9329 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9330 parts.
9331
9332 @item K m
9333 @kindex K m (Summary)
9334 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9335 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9336 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9337 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9338 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9339
9340 @item X m
9341 @kindex X m (Summary)
9342 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9343 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9344 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9345 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9346
9347 @item M-t
9348 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9349 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9350 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9351 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9352
9353 @item W M w
9354 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9355 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9356 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9357 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9358
9359 @item W M c
9360 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9361 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9362 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9363 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9364
9365 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9366 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9367 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9368 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9369 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9370 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9371
9372 @item W M v
9373 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9374 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9375 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9376 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9377
9378 @end table
9379
9380 Relevant variables:
9381
9382 @table @code
9383 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9384 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9385 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9386 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9387 @code{nil}.
9388
9389 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9390
9391 @lisp
9392 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9393 '("text/x-vcard"))
9394 @end lisp
9395
9396 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9397 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9398 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9399 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9400 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9401 default is @code{nil}.
9402
9403 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9404 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9405 @cindex uuencode
9406 @cindex yEnc
9407 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9408 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9409 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9410 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9411 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9412 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9413 for encoding in Gnus.
9414
9415 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9416 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9417 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9418 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9419 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9420 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9421 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9422 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9423
9424 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9425 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9426 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9427 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9428 displayed. This variable overrides
9429 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9430 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9431 is @code{nil}.
9432
9433 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9434 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9435 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9436
9437 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9438 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9439 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9440 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9441 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9442
9443 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9444 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9445 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9446 default value is @code{nil}.
9447
9448 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9449 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9450 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9451 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9452 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9453 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9454 save all jpegs into some directory).
9455
9456 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9457
9458 @lisp
9459 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9460 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9461 (with-temp-buffer
9462 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9463 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9464 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9465 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9466 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9467 @end lisp
9468
9469 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9470 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9471 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9472
9473 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9474 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9475 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9476
9477 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9478 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9479 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9480
9481 If displaying "text/html" is discouraged, see
9482 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9483 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9484 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9485 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9486
9487 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9488 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9489 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9490 overrides @code{nil} values of
9491 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9492 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9493
9494 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9495 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9496 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9497 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9498
9499 Ready-made functions include@*
9500 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9501 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9502 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9503 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9504 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9505 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9506 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9507 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9508 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9509 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9510 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9511 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9512
9513 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9514 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9515
9516 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9517 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9518 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9519
9520 @lisp
9521 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9522 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9523 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9524 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9525 @end lisp
9526
9527 @noindent
9528 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9529
9530 @end table
9531
9532
9533 @node Charsets
9534 @section Charsets
9535 @cindex charsets
9536
9537 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9538 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9539 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9540 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9541 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9542 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9543 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9544
9545 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9546 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9547 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9548 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9549
9550 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9551 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9552 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9553 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9554 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9555 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9556 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9557 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9558 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9559
9560 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9561 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9562 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9563 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9564 quoted-printable header encoding.
9565
9566 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9567 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9568 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9569
9570 @table @var
9571 @item test
9572 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9573 variable to query,
9574 @item header
9575 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9576 means encode all charsets),
9577 @item body-list
9578 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9579 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9580 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9581 @end table
9582
9583 @cindex Russian
9584 @cindex koi8-r
9585 @cindex koi8-u
9586 @cindex iso-8859-5
9587 @cindex coding system aliases
9588 @cindex preferred charset
9589
9590 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9591 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9592 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9593
9594 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9595
9596 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9597 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9598
9599 @lisp
9600 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9601 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9602 @end lisp
9603
9604 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9605 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9606
9607 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9608
9609 @lisp
9610 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9611 @end lisp
9612
9613 This will almost do the right thing.
9614
9615 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9616 something like
9617
9618 @lisp
9619 (codepage-setup 1251)
9620 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9621 @end lisp
9622
9623
9624 @node Article Commands
9625 @section Article Commands
9626
9627 @table @kbd
9628
9629 @item A P
9630 @cindex PostScript
9631 @cindex printing
9632 @kindex A P (Summary)
9633 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9634 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9635 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9636 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9637 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9638 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9639
9640 @end table
9641
9642
9643 @node Summary Sorting
9644 @section Summary Sorting
9645 @cindex summary sorting
9646
9647 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9648 can't really see why you'd want that.
9649
9650 @table @kbd
9651
9652 @item C-c C-s C-n
9653 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9654 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9655 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9656
9657 @item C-c C-s C-a
9658 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9659 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9660 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9661
9662 @item C-c C-s C-s
9663 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9664 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9665 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9666
9667 @item C-c C-s C-d
9668 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9669 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9670 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9671
9672 @item C-c C-s C-l
9673 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9674 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9675 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9676
9677 @item C-c C-s C-c
9678 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9679 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9680 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9681
9682 @item C-c C-s C-i
9683 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9684 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9685 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9686
9687 @item C-c C-s C-r
9688 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9689 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9690 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9691
9692 @item C-c C-s C-o
9693 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9694 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9695 Sort using the default sorting method
9696 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9697 @end table
9698
9699 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9700 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9701 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9702 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9703 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9704 Commands}).
9705
9706
9707 @node Finding the Parent
9708 @section Finding the Parent
9709 @cindex parent articles
9710 @cindex referring articles
9711
9712 @table @kbd
9713 @item ^
9714 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9715 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9716 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9717 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9718 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9719 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9720 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9721 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9722 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9723 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9724
9725 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9726 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9727 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9728 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9729 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9730 article.
9731
9732 @item A R (Summary)
9733 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9734 @kindex A R (Summary)
9735 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9736 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9737
9738 @item A T (Summary)
9739 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9740 @kindex A T (Summary)
9741 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9742 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9743 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9744 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9745 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9746 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9747 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9748
9749 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9750 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9751 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9752 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9753 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9754 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9755
9756 @item M-^ (Summary)
9757 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9758 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9759 @cindex Message-ID
9760 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9761 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9762 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9763 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9764 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9765 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9766
9767 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9768 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9769 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9770 @end table
9771
9772 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9773 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9774 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9775 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9776 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9777 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9778 necessary.
9779
9780 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9781 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9782 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9783 match.
9784
9785 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9786 then ask Google if that fails:
9787
9788 @lisp
9789 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9790 '(current
9791 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9792 @end lisp
9793
9794 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9795 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9796 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9797 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9798 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9799 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9800 not support this at all.
9801
9802
9803 @node Alternative Approaches
9804 @section Alternative Approaches
9805
9806 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9807 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9808
9809 @menu
9810 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9811 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9812 @end menu
9813
9814
9815 @node Pick and Read
9816 @subsection Pick and Read
9817 @cindex pick and read
9818
9819 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9820 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9821 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9822 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9823
9824 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9825 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9826 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9827 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9828 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9829 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9830
9831 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9832
9833 @table @kbd
9834 @item .
9835 @kindex . (Pick)
9836 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9837 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9838 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9839 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9840 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9841 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9842 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9843 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9844
9845 @item SPACE
9846 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9847 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9848 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9849 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9850
9851 @item u
9852 @kindex u (Pick)
9853 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9854 Unpick the thread or article
9855 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9856 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9857 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9858 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9859 the thread or article at that line.
9860
9861 @item RET
9862 @kindex RET (Pick)
9863 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9864 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9865 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9866 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9867 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9868 will still be visible when you are reading.
9869
9870 @end table
9871
9872 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9873 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9874 which is mapped to the same function
9875 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9876
9877 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9878
9879 @lisp
9880 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9881 @end lisp
9882
9883 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9884 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9885
9886 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9887 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9888 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9889
9890 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9891 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9892 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9893 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9894 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9895 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9896 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9897
9898
9899 @node Binary Groups
9900 @subsection Binary Groups
9901 @cindex binary groups
9902
9903 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9904 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9905 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9906 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9907 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9908 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9909 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9910
9911 @kindex g (Binary)
9912 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9913 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9914 command, when you have turned on this mode
9915 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9916
9917 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9918 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9919
9920
9921 @node Tree Display
9922 @section Tree Display
9923 @cindex trees
9924
9925 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9926 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9927 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9928 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9929 in the tree buffer.
9930
9931 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9932
9933 @table @code
9934 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9935 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9936 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9937
9938 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9939 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9940 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9941 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9942 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9943
9944 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9945 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9946 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9947 default is @code{modeline}.
9948
9949 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9950 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9951 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9952 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9953 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9954 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9955 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9956
9957 Valid specs are:
9958
9959 @table @samp
9960 @item n
9961 The name of the poster.
9962 @item f
9963 The @code{From} header.
9964 @item N
9965 The number of the article.
9966 @item [
9967 The opening bracket.
9968 @item ]
9969 The closing bracket.
9970 @item s
9971 The subject.
9972 @end table
9973
9974 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
9975
9976 Variables related to the display are:
9977
9978 @table @code
9979 @item gnus-tree-brackets
9980 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
9981 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
9982 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
9983 @example
9984 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
9985 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
9986 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
9987 @end example
9988 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
9989
9990 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9991 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
9992 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
9993 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
9994
9995 @end table
9996
9997 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
9998 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
9999 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10000 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10001 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10002 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10003 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10004 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10005 other windows displayed next to it.
10006
10007 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10008 at all times:
10009
10010 @lisp
10011 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10012 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10013 @end lisp
10014
10015 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10016 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10017 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10018 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10019 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10020 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10021 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10022
10023 @end table
10024
10025 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10026
10027 @example
10028 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10029 | \[Jan]
10030 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10031 | \(***)-[Eri]
10032 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10033 \[Bjo]
10034 \[Gun]
10035 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10036 @end example
10037
10038 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10039
10040 @example
10041 @group
10042 @{***@}
10043 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10044 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10045 |--\-----\-----\ |
10046 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10047 | | |--\
10048 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10049 |
10050 [Paa]
10051 @end group
10052 @end example
10053
10054 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10055 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10056 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10057
10058 @lisp
10059 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10060 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10061 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10062 (gnus-add-configuration
10063 '(article
10064 (vertical 1.0
10065 (horizontal 0.25
10066 (summary 0.75 point)
10067 (tree 1.0))
10068 (article 1.0))))
10069 @end lisp
10070
10071 @xref{Window Layout}.
10072
10073
10074 @node Mail Group Commands
10075 @section Mail Group Commands
10076 @cindex mail group commands
10077
10078 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10079 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10080
10081 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10082 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10083
10084 @table @kbd
10085
10086 @item B e
10087 @kindex B e (Summary)
10088 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10089 @cindex expiring mail
10090 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10091 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10092 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10093 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10094
10095 @item B C-M-e
10096 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10097 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10098 @cindex expiring mail
10099 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10100 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10101 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10102 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10103
10104 @item B DEL
10105 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10106 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10107 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10108 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10109 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10110 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10111
10112 @item B m
10113 @kindex B m (Summary)
10114 @cindex move mail
10115 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10116 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10117 Move the article from one mail group to another
10118 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10119 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10120
10121 @item B c
10122 @kindex B c (Summary)
10123 @cindex copy mail
10124 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10125 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10126 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10127 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10128 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10129
10130 @item B B
10131 @kindex B B (Summary)
10132 @cindex crosspost mail
10133 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10134 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10135 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10136 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10137 be properly updated.
10138
10139 @item B i
10140 @kindex B i (Summary)
10141 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10142 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10143 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10144 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10145
10146 @item B I
10147 @kindex B I (Summary)
10148 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10149 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10150 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10151 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10152
10153 @item B r
10154 @kindex B r (Summary)
10155 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10156 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10157 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10158 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10159 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10160 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10161 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10162 (which is the default).
10163
10164 @item B w
10165 @itemx e
10166 @kindex B w (Summary)
10167 @kindex e (Summary)
10168 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10169 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10170 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10171 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10172 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10173 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10174 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10175
10176 @item B q
10177 @kindex B q (Summary)
10178 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10179 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10180 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10181 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10182
10183 @item B t
10184 @kindex B t (Summary)
10185 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10186 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10187 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10188
10189 @item B p
10190 @kindex B p (Summary)
10191 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10192 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10193 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10194 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10195 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10196 article from your news server (or rather, from
10197 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10198 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10199 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10200 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10201 just not have arrived yet.
10202
10203 @item K E
10204 @kindex K E (Summary)
10205 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10206 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10207 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10208 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10209 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10210
10211 @end table
10212
10213 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10214 @cindex moving articles
10215 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10216 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10217 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10218 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10219 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10220 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10221 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10222
10223 @lisp
10224 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10225 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10226 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10227 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10228 @end lisp
10229
10230
10231 @node Various Summary Stuff
10232 @section Various Summary Stuff
10233
10234 @menu
10235 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10236 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10237 * Summary Generation Commands::
10238 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10239 @end menu
10240
10241 @table @code
10242 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10243 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10244 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10245 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10246 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10247 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10248
10249 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10250 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10251 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10252 current article.
10253
10254 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10255 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10256 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10257
10258 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10259 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10260 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10261 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10262 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10263 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10264 have been set.
10265
10266 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10267 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10268 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10269 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10270 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10271
10272 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10273 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10274 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10275 generated.
10276
10277 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10278 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10279 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10280 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10281 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10282 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10283 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10284 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10285 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10286 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10287
10288 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10289 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10290 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10291 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10292 list of articles to be selected.
10293
10294 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10295 the list in one particular group:
10296
10297 @lisp
10298 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10299 (if (string= group "some.group")
10300 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10301 articles))
10302 @end lisp
10303
10304 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10305 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10306 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10307 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10308 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10309 buffer is active.
10310
10311 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10312 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10313 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10314 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10315 variable will be used instead.
10316
10317 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10318 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10319 buffers. For example:
10320
10321 @lisp
10322 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10323 '(message-use-followup-to
10324 (gnus-visible-headers .
10325 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10326 @end lisp
10327
10328 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10329 @end table
10330
10331
10332 @node Summary Group Information
10333 @subsection Summary Group Information
10334
10335 @table @kbd
10336
10337 @item H f
10338 @kindex H f (Summary)
10339 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10340 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10341 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10342 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10343 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10344 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10345 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10346 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10347 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10348
10349 @item H d
10350 @kindex H d (Summary)
10351 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10352 Give a brief description of the current group
10353 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10354 rereading the description from the server.
10355
10356 @item H h
10357 @kindex H h (Summary)
10358 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10359 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10360 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10361
10362 @item H i
10363 @kindex H i (Summary)
10364 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10365 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10366 @end table
10367
10368
10369 @node Searching for Articles
10370 @subsection Searching for Articles
10371
10372 @table @kbd
10373
10374 @item M-s
10375 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10376 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10377 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10378 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10379
10380 @item M-r
10381 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10382 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10383 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10384 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10385
10386 @item &
10387 @kindex & (Summary)
10388 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10389 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10390 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10391 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10392 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10393 search backward instead.
10394
10395 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10396 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10397
10398 @item M-&
10399 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10400 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10401 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10402 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10403 @end table
10404
10405 @node Summary Generation Commands
10406 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10407
10408 @table @kbd
10409
10410 @item Y g
10411 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10412 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10413 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10414
10415 @item Y c
10416 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10417 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10418 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10419 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10420
10421 @item Y d
10422 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10423 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10424 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10425 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10426
10427 @end table
10428
10429
10430 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10431 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10432
10433 @table @kbd
10434
10435 @item A D
10436 @itemx C-d
10437 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10438 @kindex A D (Summary)
10439 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10440 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10441 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10442 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10443 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10444 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10445 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10446 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10447 fashion.
10448
10449 @item C-M-d
10450 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10451 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10452 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10453 several documents into one biiig group
10454 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10455 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10456 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10457 command understands the process/prefix convention
10458 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10459
10460 @item C-t
10461 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10462 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10463 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10464 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10465 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10466 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10467
10468 @item =
10469 @kindex = (Summary)
10470 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10471 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10472 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10473
10474 @item C-M-e
10475 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10476 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10477 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10478 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10479
10480 @item C-M-a
10481 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10482 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10483 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10484 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10485
10486 @end table
10487
10488
10489 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10490 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10491 @cindex summary exit
10492 @cindex exiting groups
10493
10494 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10495 group and return you to the group buffer.
10496
10497 @table @kbd
10498
10499 @item Z Z
10500 @itemx Z Q
10501 @itemx q
10502 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10503 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10504 @kindex q (Summary)
10505 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10506 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10507 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10508 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10509 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10510 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10511 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10512 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10513 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10514 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10515 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10516 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10517
10518 @item Z E
10519 @itemx Q
10520 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10521 @kindex Q (Summary)
10522 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10523 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10524 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10525
10526 @item Z c
10527 @itemx c
10528 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10529 @kindex c (Summary)
10530 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10531 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10532 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10533 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10534
10535 @item Z C
10536 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10537 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10538 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10539 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10540
10541 @item Z n
10542 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10543 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10544 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10545 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10546
10547 @item Z R
10548 @itemx C-x C-s
10549 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10550 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10551 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10552 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10553 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10554 all articles, both read and unread.
10555
10556 @item Z G
10557 @itemx M-g
10558 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10559 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10560 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10561 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10562 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10563 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10564 articles, both read and unread.
10565
10566 @item Z N
10567 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10568 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10569 Exit the group and go to the next group
10570 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10571
10572 @item Z P
10573 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10574 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10575 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10576 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10577
10578 @item Z s
10579 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10580 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10581 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10582 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10583 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10584 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10585 @end table
10586
10587 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10588 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10589 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10590 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10591
10592 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10593 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10594 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10595 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10596 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10597 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10598 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10599 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10600 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10601 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10602 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10603 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10604
10605 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10606
10607 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10608 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10609 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10610 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10611 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10612 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10613 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10614 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10615 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10616
10617
10618 @node Crosspost Handling
10619 @section Crosspost Handling
10620
10621 @cindex velveeta
10622 @cindex spamming
10623 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10624 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10625 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10626 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10627 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10628 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10629 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10630
10631 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10632 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10633 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10634 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10635 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10636
10637 @cindex cross-posting
10638 @cindex Xref
10639 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10640 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10641 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10642 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10643 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10644 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10645 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10646 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10647 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10648 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10649 the cross reference mechanism.
10650
10651 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10652 @cindex overview.fmt
10653 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10654 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10655 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10656 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10657 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10658 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10659 overview files.
10660
10661 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
10662 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10663 set @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10664 considerably.
10665
10666 C'est la vie.
10667
10668 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10669
10670
10671 @node Duplicate Suppression
10672 @section Duplicate Suppression
10673
10674 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10675 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10676 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10677 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10678 reasons.
10679
10680 @enumerate
10681 @item
10682 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10683 is evil and not very common.
10684
10685 @item
10686 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10687 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10688
10689 @item
10690 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10691 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10692
10693 @item
10694 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10695 @end enumerate
10696
10697 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10698 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10699
10700 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10701 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10702 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10703 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10704 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10705 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10706 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10707 once.
10708
10709 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10710 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10711 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10712 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10713 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10714 saw the article in.
10715
10716 @table @code
10717 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10718 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10719 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10720
10721 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10722 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10723 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10724 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10725 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10726 session are suppressed.
10727
10728 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10729 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10730 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10731 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10732
10733 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10734 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10735 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10736 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10737 @end table
10738
10739 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10740 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10741 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10742 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10743 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10744 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10745 to you to figure out, I think.
10746
10747 @node Security
10748 @section Security
10749
10750 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10751 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10752 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10753 things to work:
10754
10755 @enumerate
10756 @item
10757 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10758 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10759 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10760 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10761
10762 @item
10763 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10764 or newer is recommended.
10765
10766 @end enumerate
10767
10768 The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
10769 include:
10770
10771 @table @code
10772 @item mm-verify-option
10773 @vindex mm-verify-option
10774 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10775 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10776 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10777
10778 @item mm-decrypt-option
10779 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10780 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10781 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10782 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10783
10784 @item mml1991-use
10785 @vindex mml1991-use
10786 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10787 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10788 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10789 deprecated.
10790
10791 @item mml2015-use
10792 @vindex mml2015-use
10793 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10794 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10795 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10796 deprecated.
10797
10798 @end table
10799
10800 By default the buttons that display security information are not
10801 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
10802 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
10803 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
10804 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
10805 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
10806 how to customize these variables to always display security
10807 information.
10808
10809 @cindex snarfing keys
10810 @cindex importing PGP keys
10811 @cindex PGP key ring import
10812 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10813 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10814 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10815 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10816 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10817 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10818 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10819 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10820 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10821
10822 @example
10823 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10824 @end example
10825 @noindent
10826 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10827 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10828
10829 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
10830 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
10831 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10832
10833 @node Mailing List
10834 @section Mailing List
10835 @cindex mailing list
10836 @cindex RFC 2396
10837
10838 @kindex A M (summary)
10839 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10840 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10841 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10842 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10843 summary buffer.
10844
10845 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10846
10847 @table @kbd
10848
10849 @item C-c C-n h
10850 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10851 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10852 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10853
10854 @item C-c C-n s
10855 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10856 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10857 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10858
10859 @item C-c C-n u
10860 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10861 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10862 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10863 field exists.
10864
10865 @item C-c C-n p
10866 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10867 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10868 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10869
10870 @item C-c C-n o
10871 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10872 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10873 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10874
10875 @item C-c C-n a
10876 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10877 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10878 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10879
10880 @end table
10881
10882
10883 @node Article Buffer
10884 @chapter Article Buffer
10885 @cindex article buffer
10886
10887 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10888 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10889 tell Gnus otherwise.
10890
10891 @menu
10892 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10893 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10894 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10895 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10896 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10897 @end menu
10898
10899
10900 @node Hiding Headers
10901 @section Hiding Headers
10902 @cindex hiding headers
10903 @cindex deleting headers
10904
10905 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10906 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10907
10908 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10909 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10910 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10911 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10912 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10913 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10914 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10915 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10916 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10917
10918 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10919
10920 @table @code
10921
10922 @item gnus-visible-headers
10923 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10924 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10925 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10926 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10927
10928 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10929 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10930
10931 @lisp
10932 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10933 @end lisp
10934
10935 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10936 remain visible.
10937
10938 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10939 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10940 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10941 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10942 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10943 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10944
10945 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10946 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10947
10948 @lisp
10949 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10950 @end lisp
10951
10952 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10953 be removed.
10954
10955 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10956 variable will have no effect.
10957
10958 @end table
10959
10960 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10961 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10962 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10963 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10964 the headers are to be displayed.
10965
10966 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10967 and then the subject, you might say something like:
10968
10969 @lisp
10970 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
10971 @end lisp
10972
10973 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
10974 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
10975
10976 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
10977 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
10978 You can hide further boring headers by setting
10979 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
10980 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
10981 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
10982 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
10983 from sight.
10984
10985 These conditions are:
10986 @table @code
10987 @item empty
10988 Remove all empty headers.
10989 @item followup-to
10990 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
10991 @code{Newsgroups} header.
10992 @item reply-to
10993 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
10994 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
10995 parameter is set.
10996 @item newsgroups
10997 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
10998 name.
10999 @item to-address
11000 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11001 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11002 @item to-list
11003 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11004 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11005 @item cc-list
11006 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11007 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11008 @item date
11009 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11010 old.
11011 @item long-to
11012 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11013 @item many-to
11014 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11015 @end table
11016
11017 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11018
11019 @lisp
11020 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11021 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11022 @end lisp
11023
11024 This is also the default value for this variable.
11025
11026
11027 @node Using MIME
11028 @section Using MIME
11029 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11030
11031 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11032 while people stand around yawning.
11033
11034 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11035 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11036
11037 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11038 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11039 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11040
11041 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11042 @findex gnus-display-mime
11043 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11044 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11045 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11046 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11047
11048 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11049 @acronym{MIME} button:
11050
11051 @table @kbd
11052 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11053 @item RET (Article)
11054 @kindex RET (Article)
11055 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11056 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11057 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11058 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11059 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11060 object is displayed inline.
11061
11062 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11063 @item M-RET (Article)
11064 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11065 @itemx v (Article)
11066 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11067 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11068
11069 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11070 @item t (Article)
11071 @kindex t (Article)
11072 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11073 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11074
11075 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11076 @item C (Article)
11077 @kindex C (Article)
11078 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11079 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11080
11081 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11082 @item o (Article)
11083 @kindex o (Article)
11084 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11085 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11086
11087 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11088 @item C-o (Article)
11089 @kindex C-o (Article)
11090 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11091 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11092 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11093 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11094 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11095 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11096
11097 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11098 @item d (Article)
11099 @kindex d (Article)
11100 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11101 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11102 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11103
11104 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11105 @item c (Article)
11106 @kindex c (Article)
11107 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11108 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11109 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11110 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11111 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11112
11113 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11114 @item p (Article)
11115 @kindex p (Article)
11116 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11117 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11118 @file{.mailcap} file.
11119
11120 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11121 @item i (Article)
11122 @kindex i (Article)
11123 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11124 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as text/plain. If given a prefix, insert
11125 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11126 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11127 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11128 Article}).
11129
11130 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11131 @item E (Article)
11132 @kindex E (Article)
11133 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11134 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11135 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11136
11137 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11138 @item e (Article)
11139 @kindex e (Article)
11140 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11141 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11142
11143 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11144 @item | (Article)
11145 @kindex | (Article)
11146 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11147
11148 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11149 @item . (Article)
11150 @kindex . (Article)
11151 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11152 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11153
11154 @end table
11155
11156 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11157 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11158 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11159
11160 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11161 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11162 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11163 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11164 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11165 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11166 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11167 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11168 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11169
11170 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11171
11172 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11173
11174
11175 @node Customizing Articles
11176 @section Customizing Articles
11177 @cindex article customization
11178
11179 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11180 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11181 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11182 called automatically when you select the articles.
11183
11184 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11185 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11186 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11187 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11188
11189 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11190 for sensible values.
11191
11192 @enumerate
11193 @item
11194 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11195
11196 @item
11197 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11198
11199 @item
11200 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11201
11202 @item
11203 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11204
11205 @item
11206 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11207 than this number.
11208
11209 @item
11210 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11211 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11212 regexps in the list.
11213
11214 @item
11215 A list where the first element is not a string:
11216
11217 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11218 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11219 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11220
11221 @lisp
11222 (or last
11223 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11224 @end lisp
11225
11226 @end enumerate
11227
11228 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11229 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11230 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11231 considered to contain just a single part.
11232
11233 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11234 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11235 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11236 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11237 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11238 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11239 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11240
11241 @ifinfo
11242 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11243 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11244 @c `i foo-bar'.
11245 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11246 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11247 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11248 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11249 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11250 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11251 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11252 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11253 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11254 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11255 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11256 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11257 @vindex gnus-treat-date-english
11258 @vindex gnus-treat-date-iso8601
11259 @vindex gnus-treat-date-lapsed
11260 @vindex gnus-treat-date-local
11261 @vindex gnus-treat-date-original
11262 @vindex gnus-treat-date-user-defined
11263 @vindex gnus-treat-date-ut
11264 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11265 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11266 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11267 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11268 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11269 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11270 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11271 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11272 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11273 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11274 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11275 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11276 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11277 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11278 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11279 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11280 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11281 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11282 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11283 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11284 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11285 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
11286 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11287 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11288 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11289 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11290 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11291 @end ifinfo
11292
11293 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11294 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11295 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11296 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11297
11298 @table @code
11299 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11300 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11301
11302 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11303
11304 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11305 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11306 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11307 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11308 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11309 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11310 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11311 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11312 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11313 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11314
11315 @xref{Article Washing}.
11316
11317 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11318 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11319 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11320 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11321 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11322 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11323 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11324
11325 @xref{Article Date}.
11326
11327 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11328 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11329 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11330
11331 @xref{Picons}.
11332
11333 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11334
11335 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11336
11337 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11338 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11339 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11340
11341 @xref{Smileys}.
11342
11343 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11344 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11345
11346 @xref{X-Face}.
11347
11348 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11349 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11350
11351 @xref{Face}.
11352
11353 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11354 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11355 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11356 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11357 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11358 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11359 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11360 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11361 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11362 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11363 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11364 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11365 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11366 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11367 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11368 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11369 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11370 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11371 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11372 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11373
11374 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11375
11376 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11377 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11378 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11379 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11380 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11381 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11382
11383 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11384
11385 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11386 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11387 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
11388 @item gnus-treat-translate
11389 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11390 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11391
11392 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11393 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11394 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11395 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11396 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11397 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11398 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11399 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11400
11401 @xref{Article Header}.
11402
11403
11404 @end table
11405
11406 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11407 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11408 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11409 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11410 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11411 everything.
11412
11413
11414 @node Article Keymap
11415 @section Article Keymap
11416
11417 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11418 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11419 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11420 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11421 buffer.
11422
11423 @kindex v (Article)
11424 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
11425 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
11426 command or better use it as a prefix key.
11427
11428 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11429
11430 @table @kbd
11431
11432 @item SPACE
11433 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11434 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11435 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11436 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11437
11438 @item DEL
11439 @kindex DEL (Article)
11440 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11441 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11442 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11443
11444 @item C-c ^
11445 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11446 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11447 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11448 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11449 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11450
11451 @item C-c C-m
11452 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11453 @findex gnus-article-mail
11454 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11455 given a prefix, include the mail.
11456
11457 @item s
11458 @kindex s (Article)
11459 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11460 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11461 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11462
11463 @item ?
11464 @kindex ? (Article)
11465 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11466 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11467 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11468
11469 @item TAB
11470 @kindex TAB (Article)
11471 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11472 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11473 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11474
11475 @item M-TAB
11476 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11477 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11478 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11479
11480 @item R
11481 @kindex R (Article)
11482 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11483 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11484 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11485 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11486 region.
11487
11488 @item F
11489 @kindex F (Article)
11490 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11491 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11492 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11493 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11494 region.
11495
11496
11497 @end table
11498
11499
11500 @node Misc Article
11501 @section Misc Article
11502
11503 @table @code
11504
11505 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11506 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11507 @cindex article buffers, several
11508 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11509 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11510 article buffer.
11511
11512 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11513 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11514 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11515 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11516 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11517
11518 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11519 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11520 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11521 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11522 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11523 the contents of the article buffer.
11524
11525 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11526 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11527 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11528
11529 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11530 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11531 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11532 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11533
11534 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11535 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11536 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11537 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11538
11539 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11540 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11541 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11542 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11543 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11544 with two extensions:
11545
11546 @table @samp
11547
11548 @item w
11549 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11550 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11551 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11552
11553 @table @samp
11554
11555 @item c
11556 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11557
11558 @item h
11559 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11560
11561 @item p
11562 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11563 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11564 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11565
11566 @item s
11567 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11568
11569 @item o
11570 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11571
11572 @item e
11573 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11574
11575 @end table
11576
11577 @item m
11578 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11579
11580 @end table
11581
11582 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11583
11584 @item gnus-break-pages
11585 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11586 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11587 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11588 paging will not be done.
11589
11590 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11591 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11592 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11593 (formfeed).
11594
11595 @cindex IDNA
11596 @cindex internationalized domain names
11597 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11598 @item gnus-use-idna
11599 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11600 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11601 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11602 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11603 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11604
11605 @end table
11606
11607
11608 @node Composing Messages
11609 @chapter Composing Messages
11610 @cindex composing messages
11611 @cindex messages
11612 @cindex mail
11613 @cindex sending mail
11614 @cindex reply
11615 @cindex followup
11616 @cindex post
11617 @cindex using gpg
11618 @cindex using s/mime
11619 @cindex using smime
11620
11621 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11622 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11623 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11624 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11625 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11626 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11627
11628 @menu
11629 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11630 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11631 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11632 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11633 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11634 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11635 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11636 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11637 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11638 @end menu
11639
11640 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11641 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11642
11643
11644 @node Mail
11645 @section Mail
11646
11647 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11648
11649 @table @code
11650 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11651 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11652 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11653 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11654 @code{nil} include all headers.
11655
11656 @item gnus-add-to-list
11657 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11658 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11659 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11660
11661 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11662 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11663 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11664 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11665 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11666 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11667 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11668 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11669
11670 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11671 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11672
11673 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11674 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11675 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11676 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11677 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11678
11679 @end table
11680
11681
11682 @node Posting Server
11683 @section Posting Server
11684
11685 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11686 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11687
11688 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11689
11690 It can be quite complicated.
11691
11692 @vindex gnus-post-method
11693 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11694 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11695 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11696 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11697 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11698 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11699 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11700 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11701 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11702
11703 @lisp
11704 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11705 @end lisp
11706
11707 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11708 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11709 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11710 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11711
11712 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11713 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11714
11715 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11716 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11717 for posting.
11718
11719 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11720 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11721
11722 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11723 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11724 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11725 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11726 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11727 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11728 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11729 package correctly. An example:
11730
11731 @lisp
11732 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11733 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11734 @end lisp
11735
11736 To the thing similar to this, there is
11737 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11738 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11739 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11740
11741 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11742 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11743 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11744
11745 @node POP before SMTP
11746 @section POP before SMTP
11747 @cindex pop before smtp
11748 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11749 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11750
11751 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11752 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11753 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11754 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11755 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11756
11757 @lisp
11758 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11759 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11760 @end lisp
11761
11762 @noindent
11763 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11764 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11765 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11766 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11767 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11768 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11769 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11770 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11771
11772 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11773 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11774 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11775 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11776 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11777 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11778
11779 @lisp
11780 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11781 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11782 :password "secret"))
11783 @end lisp
11784
11785 @noindent
11786 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11787 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11788
11789 @lisp
11790 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11791 (lambda ()
11792 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11793 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11794 :password "secret")))
11795 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11796 @end lisp
11797
11798 @node Mail and Post
11799 @section Mail and Post
11800
11801 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11802 posting:
11803
11804 @table @code
11805 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11806 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11807 @cindex mailing lists
11808
11809 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11810 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11811 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11812 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11813 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11814 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11815 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11816 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11817 still a pain, though.
11818
11819 @item gnus-user-agent
11820 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11821 @cindex User-Agent
11822
11823 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11824 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
11825 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
11826 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
11827 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
11828 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
11829 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11830
11831 @end table
11832
11833 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11834 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11835 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11836
11837 @cindex ispell
11838 @findex ispell-message
11839 @lisp
11840 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11841 @end lisp
11842
11843 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11844 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11845
11846 @lisp
11847 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11848 (lambda ()
11849 (cond
11850 ((string-match
11851 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11852 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11853 (t
11854 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11855 @end lisp
11856
11857 Modify to suit your needs.
11858
11859
11860 @node Archived Messages
11861 @section Archived Messages
11862 @cindex archived messages
11863 @cindex sent messages
11864
11865 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11866 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11867 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11868 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11869 is the default.
11870
11871 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11872 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11873 Group Commands}).
11874
11875 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11876 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11877 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11878
11879 @lisp
11880 (nnfolder "archive"
11881 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11882 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11883 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11884 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11885 @end lisp
11886
11887 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11888 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11889 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11890 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11891
11892 @lisp
11893 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11894 '(nnfolder "archive"
11895 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11896 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11897 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11898 @end lisp
11899
11900 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11901 @cindex Gcc
11902 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11903 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11904 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11905
11906 This variable can be used to do the following:
11907
11908 @table @asis
11909 @item a string
11910 Messages will be saved in that group.
11911
11912 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11913 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11914 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11915 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11916 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11917 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11918 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11919 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11920 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11921
11922 @item a list of strings
11923 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11924
11925 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11926 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11927
11928 @item @code{nil}
11929 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11930 @end table
11931
11932 Let's illustrate:
11933
11934 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11935 @lisp
11936 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11937 @end lisp
11938
11939 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11940 @lisp
11941 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11942 @end lisp
11943
11944 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11945 @lisp
11946 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11947 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11948 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11949 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11950 @end lisp
11951
11952 More complex stuff:
11953 @lisp
11954 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11955 '((if (message-news-p)
11956 "misc-news"
11957 "misc-mail")))
11958 @end lisp
11959
11960 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11961 messages in one file per month:
11962
11963 @lisp
11964 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11965 '((if (message-news-p)
11966 "misc-news"
11967 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
11968 @end lisp
11969
11970 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
11971 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
11972
11973 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
11974 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
11975 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
11976 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
11977 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
11978 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
11979 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
11980 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
11981 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
11982 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
11983
11984 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
11985 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
11986 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
11987 this will disable archiving.
11988
11989 @table @code
11990 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
11991 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
11992 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
11993 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
11994 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
11995 group names.
11996
11997 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
11998 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
11999 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
12000 of names).
12001
12002 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
12003 but the latter is the preferred method.
12004
12005 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12006 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12007 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12008
12009 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12010 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12011 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12012 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12013 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12014 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12015 changed in the future.
12016
12017 @end table
12018
12019
12020 @node Posting Styles
12021 @section Posting Styles
12022 @cindex posting styles
12023 @cindex styles
12024
12025 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12026
12027 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12028 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12029 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12030 on?
12031
12032 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12033 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12034 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12035 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12036 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12037 variable:
12038
12039 @lisp
12040 ((".*"
12041 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12042 (organization "What me?"))
12043 ("^comp"
12044 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12045 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12046 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12047 @end lisp
12048
12049 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12050 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12051 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12052 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12053 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12054 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12055 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12056 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12057
12058 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12059 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12060 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12061 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12062 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12063 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12064 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12065 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12066 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12067 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12068 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12069 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12070 said to @dfn{match}.
12071
12072 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12073 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12074 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12075 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12076 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12077 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12078 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12079 name can be one of:
12080
12081 @itemize @bullet
12082 @item @code{signature}
12083 @item @code{signature-file}
12084 @item @code{x-face-file}
12085 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12086 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12087 @item @code{body}
12088 @end itemize
12089
12090 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12091 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12092 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12093 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12094 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12095
12096 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
12097 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
12098 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
12099 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12100 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
12101 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
12102 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
12103 references chars lines xref extra.
12104
12105 @vindex message-reply-headers
12106
12107 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12108 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12109 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12110
12111 @findex message-mail-p
12112 @findex message-news-p
12113
12114 So here's a new example:
12115
12116 @lisp
12117 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12118 '((".*"
12119 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12120 (name "User Name")
12121 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12122 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12123 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12124 ("^rec.humor"
12125 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12126 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12127 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12128 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12129 (signature my-news-signature))
12130 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12131 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12132 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12133 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12134 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12135 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12136 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12137 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12138 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12139 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12140 ("nnml:.*"
12141 (From (save-excursion
12142 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
12143 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12144 ("^nn.+:"
12145 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12146 @end lisp
12147
12148 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12149 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12150 if you fill many roles.
12151 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12152 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12153
12154 @node Drafts
12155 @section Drafts
12156 @cindex drafts
12157
12158 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12159 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12160 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12161 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12162 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12163
12164 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12165 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12166 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12167 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12168 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12169 group.)
12170
12171 @cindex nndraft
12172 @vindex nndraft-directory
12173 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12174 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12175 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12176 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12177 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12178 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12179
12180 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12181 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12182 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12183 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12184 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12185 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12186 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12187 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12188 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12189
12190 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12191 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12192 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12193 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12194 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12195 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12196 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12197 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12198 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12199 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12200 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12201 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12202 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12203 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12204 @c
12205 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12206 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12207 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12208
12209 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12210 @kindex D e (Draft)
12211 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12212 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12213 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12214
12215 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12216 Articles}).
12217
12218 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12219 @kindex D s (Draft)
12220 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12221 @kindex D S (Draft)
12222 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12223 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12224 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12225 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12226 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12227 in the buffer.
12228
12229 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12230 @kindex D t (Draft)
12231 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12232 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12233 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12234
12235
12236 @node Rejected Articles
12237 @section Rejected Articles
12238 @cindex rejected articles
12239
12240 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12241 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12242 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12243 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12244
12245 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12246 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12247 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12248 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12249 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12250
12251 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12252 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12253 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12254
12255 @node Signing and encrypting
12256 @section Signing and encrypting
12257 @cindex using gpg
12258 @cindex using s/mime
12259 @cindex using smime
12260
12261 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12262 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12263 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12264 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12265
12266 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12267 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12268 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12269 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12270 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12271 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12272 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12273 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12274 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12275 automatically encrypted messages.
12276
12277 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12278 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12279 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12280
12281 @table @kbd
12282
12283 @item C-c C-m s s
12284 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12285 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12286
12287 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12288
12289 @item C-c C-m s o
12290 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12291 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12292
12293 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12294
12295 @item C-c C-m s p
12296 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12297 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12298
12299 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12300
12301 @item C-c C-m c s
12302 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12303 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12304
12305 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12306
12307 @item C-c C-m c o
12308 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12309 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12310
12311 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12312
12313 @item C-c C-m c p
12314 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12315 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12316
12317 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12318
12319 @item C-c C-m C-n
12320 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12321 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12322 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12323
12324 @end table
12325
12326 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12327
12328 @node Select Methods
12329 @chapter Select Methods
12330 @cindex foreign groups
12331 @cindex select methods
12332
12333 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12334 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12335 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12336 personal mail group.
12337
12338 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12339 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12340 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12341 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12342 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12343 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12344
12345 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12346 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12347
12348 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12349 group as.
12350
12351 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12352 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12353 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12354 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12355 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12356
12357 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12358
12359 @menu
12360 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12361 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12362 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12363 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12364 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12365 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12366 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12367 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
12368 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12369 @end menu
12370
12371
12372 @node Server Buffer
12373 @section Server Buffer
12374
12375 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12376 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12377 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12378 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12379 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12380 back end represents a virtual server.
12381
12382 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12383 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12384 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12385 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12386
12387 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12388 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12389 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12390 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12391 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12392 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12393 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12394
12395 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12396 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12397
12398 @menu
12399 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12400 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12401 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12402 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12403 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12404 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12405 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12406 @end menu
12407
12408 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12409 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12410
12411
12412 @node Server Buffer Format
12413 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12414 @cindex server buffer format
12415
12416 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12417 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12418 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12419 variable, with some simple extensions:
12420
12421 @table @samp
12422
12423 @item h
12424 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12425
12426 @item n
12427 The name of this server.
12428
12429 @item w
12430 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12431
12432 @item s
12433 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12434
12435 @item a
12436 Whether this server is agentized.
12437 @end table
12438
12439 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12440 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12441 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12442 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12443
12444 @table @samp
12445 @item S
12446 Server name.
12447
12448 @item M
12449 Server method.
12450 @end table
12451
12452 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12453
12454
12455 @node Server Commands
12456 @subsection Server Commands
12457 @cindex server commands
12458
12459 @table @kbd
12460
12461 @item v
12462 @kindex v (Server)
12463 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
12464 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12465 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12466
12467 @item a
12468 @kindex a (Server)
12469 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12470 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12471
12472 @item e
12473 @kindex e (Server)
12474 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12475 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12476
12477 @item SPACE
12478 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12479 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12480 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12481
12482 @item q
12483 @kindex q (Server)
12484 @findex gnus-server-exit
12485 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12486
12487 @item k
12488 @kindex k (Server)
12489 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12490 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12491
12492 @item y
12493 @kindex y (Server)
12494 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12495 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12496
12497 @item c
12498 @kindex c (Server)
12499 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12500 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12501
12502 @item l
12503 @kindex l (Server)
12504 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12505 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12506
12507 @item s
12508 @kindex s (Server)
12509 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12510 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12511 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12512 servers.
12513
12514 @item g
12515 @kindex g (Server)
12516 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12517 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12518 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12519 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12520
12521 @end table
12522
12523
12524 @node Example Methods
12525 @subsection Example Methods
12526
12527 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12528
12529 @lisp
12530 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12531 @end lisp
12532
12533 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12534
12535 @lisp
12536 (nnspool "")
12537 @end lisp
12538
12539 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12540 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12541 will.
12542
12543 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12544 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12545
12546 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12547 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12548 look like then:
12549
12550 @lisp
12551 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12552 @end lisp
12553
12554 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12555 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12556
12557 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12558 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12559 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12560 your private mail:
12561
12562 @lisp
12563 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12564 @end lisp
12565
12566 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12567 that.)
12568
12569 Here's the method for a public spool:
12570
12571 @lisp
12572 (nnmh "public"
12573 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12574 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12575 @end lisp
12576
12577 @cindex proxy
12578 @cindex firewall
12579
12580 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12581 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12582 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12583 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12584 should probably look something like this:
12585
12586 @lisp
12587 (nntp "firewall"
12588 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12589 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12590 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12591 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12592 @end lisp
12593
12594 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12595 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12596 configuration to the example above:
12597
12598 @lisp
12599 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12600 @end lisp
12601
12602 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12603
12604 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12605 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12606 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12607
12608 @lisp
12609 (nntp "outside"
12610 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12611 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12612 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12613 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12614 @end lisp
12615
12616 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12617 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12618 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12619 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12620
12621
12622 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12623 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12624
12625 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12626 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12627
12628 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12629 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12630 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12631
12632 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12633
12634 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12635 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12636 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12637 will contain the following:
12638
12639 @lisp
12640 (nnml "cache")
12641 @end lisp
12642
12643 Change that to:
12644
12645 @lisp
12646 (nnml "cache"
12647 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12648 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12649 @end lisp
12650
12651 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12652 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12653 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12654
12655
12656 @node Server Variables
12657 @subsection Server Variables
12658 @cindex server variables
12659 @cindex server parameters
12660
12661 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12662 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12663 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12664 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12665 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12666
12667 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12668 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12669 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12670 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12671 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12672 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12673 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12674 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12675 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12676
12677 @lisp
12678 (nnml "public"
12679 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12680 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12681 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12682 @end lisp
12683
12684 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12685
12686 @node Servers and Methods
12687 @subsection Servers and Methods
12688
12689 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12690 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12691 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12692 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12693 over.
12694
12695
12696 @node Unavailable Servers
12697 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12698
12699 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12700 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12701 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12702 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12703 actually the case or not.
12704
12705 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12706 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12707 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12708 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12709 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12710 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12711 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12712 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12713
12714 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12715 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12716
12717 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12718 with the following commands:
12719
12720 @table @kbd
12721
12722 @item O
12723 @kindex O (Server)
12724 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12725 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12726 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12727
12728 @item C
12729 @kindex C (Server)
12730 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12731 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12732 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12733
12734 @item D
12735 @kindex D (Server)
12736 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12737 Mark the current server as unreachable
12738 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12739
12740 @item M-o
12741 @kindex M-o (Server)
12742 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12743 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12744 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12745
12746 @item M-c
12747 @kindex M-c (Server)
12748 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12749 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12750 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12751
12752 @item R
12753 @kindex R (Server)
12754 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12755 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12756 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12757
12758 @item L
12759 @kindex L (Server)
12760 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12761 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12762
12763 @end table
12764
12765
12766 @node Getting News
12767 @section Getting News
12768 @cindex reading news
12769 @cindex news back ends
12770
12771 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12772 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12773 or it can read from a local spool.
12774
12775 @menu
12776 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12777 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12778 @end menu
12779
12780
12781 @node NNTP
12782 @subsection NNTP
12783 @cindex nntp
12784
12785 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12786 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12787 server as the, uhm, address.
12788
12789 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12790 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12791 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12792 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12793
12794 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12795 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12796 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12797
12798 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12799 server:
12800
12801 @table @code
12802
12803 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12804 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12805 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12806 @cindex authinfo
12807 @cindex authentication
12808 @cindex nntp authentication
12809 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12810 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12811 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12812 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12813 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12814 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12815 present in this hook.
12816
12817 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12818 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12819 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12820 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12821 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12822 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12823 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12824 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12825 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12826 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12827 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12828 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12829
12830 @enumerate
12831 @item
12832 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12833
12834 @item
12835 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12836
12837 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12838 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12839 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12840 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12841 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12842 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12843 @samp{force} is explained below.
12844
12845 @end enumerate
12846
12847 Here's an example file:
12848
12849 @example
12850 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12851 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12852 @end example
12853
12854 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12855 have to be first, for instance.
12856
12857 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12858 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12859 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12860 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12861 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12862 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12863 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12864
12865 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12866 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12867
12868 @example
12869 default force yes
12870 @end example
12871
12872 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12873 previously mentioned.
12874
12875 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12876
12877 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12878 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12879 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12880 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12881 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12882
12883 @lisp
12884 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12885 '(("innd" (ding))))
12886 @end lisp
12887
12888 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12889
12890 The default value is
12891
12892 @lisp
12893 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12894 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12895 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12896 @end lisp
12897
12898 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12899 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12900
12901 @item nntp-maximum-request
12902 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12903 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12904 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12905 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12906 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12907 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12908 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12909
12910 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12911 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12912 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12913 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12914 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12915 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12916 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12917 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12918 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12919 no timeouts are done.
12920
12921 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12922 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12923 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12924 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12925 can be used.
12926
12927 @item nntp-xover-commands
12928 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12929 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12930 @cindex XOVER
12931 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12932 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12933 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12934
12935 @item nntp-nov-gap
12936 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12937 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12938 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12939 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12940 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12941 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12942 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12943 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12944 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12945 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12946 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12947
12948 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
12949 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
12950 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12951
12952 @item nntp-record-commands
12953 @vindex nntp-record-commands
12954 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
12955 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
12956 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
12957 that doesn't seem to work.
12958
12959 @item nntp-open-connection-function
12960 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
12961 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
12962 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
12963 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
12964 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
12965 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
12966 indirect ones (two pre-made).
12967
12968 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
12969 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
12970 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
12971 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
12972 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
12973 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
12974 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
12975 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
12976 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
12977
12978 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
12979 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
12980 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
12981 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
12982 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
12983 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
12984 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
12985
12986 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
12987 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
12988 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
12989 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
12990 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
12991 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
12992 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
12993
12994 @lisp
12995 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
12996 @end lisp
12997
12998 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
12999 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13000
13001 @end table
13002
13003 @menu
13004 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13005 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13006 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13007 @end menu
13008
13009
13010 @node Direct Functions
13011 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13012 @cindex direct connection functions
13013
13014 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13015 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13016 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13017 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13018
13019 @table @code
13020 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13021 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13022 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13023 remote system.
13024
13025 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13026 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13027 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13028 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
13029 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13030
13031 @lisp
13032 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13033 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13034 ;;
13035 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13036 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13037 (nntp-port-number )
13038 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13039 @end lisp
13040
13041 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13042 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13043 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13044 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13045 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13046 then define a server as follows:
13047
13048 @lisp
13049 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13050 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13051 ;;
13052 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13053 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13054 (nntp-port-number 563)
13055 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13056 @end lisp
13057
13058 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13059 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13060 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
13061 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
13062 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13063 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13064 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13065 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13066
13067 @lisp
13068 (nntp "socksified"
13069 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13070 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13071 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13072 @end lisp
13073
13074 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13075 session, which is not a good idea.
13076 @end table
13077
13078
13079 @node Indirect Functions
13080 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13081 @cindex indirect connection functions
13082
13083 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13084 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13085 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13086 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13087 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13088 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13089
13090 @table @code
13091 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13092 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13093 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
13094 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13095 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13096
13097 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13098
13099 @table @code
13100 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13101 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13102 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13103 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13104
13105 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13106 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13107 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13108 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13109 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13110 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
13111 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13112 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13113 host.
13114 @end table
13115
13116 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13117 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13118 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13119 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13120
13121 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13122
13123 @table @code
13124 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13125 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13126 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13127 @samp{telnet}.
13128
13129 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13130 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13131 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13132 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13133
13134 @item nntp-via-user-password
13135 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13136 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13137
13138 @item nntp-via-envuser
13139 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13140 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13141 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13142 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13143
13144 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13145 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13146 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13147 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13148
13149 @end table
13150
13151 @end table
13152
13153
13154 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13155 functions:
13156
13157 @table @code
13158
13159 @item nntp-via-user-name
13160 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13161 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13162
13163 @item nntp-via-address
13164 @vindex nntp-via-address
13165 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13166
13167 @end table
13168
13169
13170 @node Common Variables
13171 @subsubsection Common Variables
13172
13173 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13174 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13175 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13176 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13177 variables individually).
13178
13179 @table @code
13180
13181 @item nntp-pre-command
13182 @vindex nntp-pre-command
13183 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
13184 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
13185 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
13186 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
13187
13188 @item nntp-address
13189 @vindex nntp-address
13190 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13191
13192 @item nntp-port-number
13193 @vindex nntp-port-number
13194 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13195 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
13196 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
13197 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
13198 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
13199 not work with named ports.
13200
13201 @item nntp-end-of-line
13202 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
13203 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
13204 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
13205 using a non native connection function.
13206
13207 @item nntp-telnet-command
13208 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13209 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
13210 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
13211 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13212 @samp{telnet}.
13213
13214 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13215 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13216 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
13217 is @samp{("-8")}.
13218
13219 @end table
13220
13221
13222 @node News Spool
13223 @subsection News Spool
13224 @cindex nnspool
13225 @cindex news spool
13226
13227 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13228 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13229 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13230 instance.
13231
13232 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13233 anything else) as the address.
13234
13235 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13236 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13237 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13238 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13239
13240 @table @code
13241
13242 @item nnspool-inews-program
13243 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13244 Program used to post an article.
13245
13246 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13247 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13248 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13249
13250 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13251 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13252 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13253 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13254
13255 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13256 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13257 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13258 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13259
13260 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13261 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13262 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13263
13264 @item nnspool-active-file
13265 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13266 The name of the active file.
13267
13268 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13269 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13270 The name of the group descriptions file.
13271
13272 @item nnspool-history-file
13273 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13274 The name of the news history file.
13275
13276 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13277 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13278 The name of the active date file.
13279
13280 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13281 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13282 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13283 that it finds.
13284
13285 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13286 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13287 @cindex sed
13288 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13289 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13290 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13291 there.
13292
13293 @end table
13294
13295
13296 @node Getting Mail
13297 @section Getting Mail
13298 @cindex reading mail
13299 @cindex mail
13300
13301 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13302 course.
13303
13304 @menu
13305 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13306 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13307 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13308 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13309 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13310 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13311 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13312 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13313 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13314 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13315 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13316 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13317 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13318 @end menu
13319
13320
13321 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13322 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13323
13324 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13325 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13326 of a culture shock.
13327
13328 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13329 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13330
13331 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13332 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13333 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13334 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13335
13336 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13337
13338 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13339 deleted? How awful!
13340
13341 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13342 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13343 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13344 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13345 Mail}.
13346
13347 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13348 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13349 they want to treat a message.
13350
13351 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13352 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13353 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13354 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13355 archived somewhere else.
13356
13357 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13358 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13359 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13360 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13361 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13362
13363 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13364 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13365 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13366
13367 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13368 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13369 differently.
13370
13371 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13372 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13373 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13374 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13375 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13376
13377 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13378 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13379 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13380 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13381 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13382 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13383 You Do.)
13384
13385
13386 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13387 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13388
13389 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13390 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13391 and things will happen automatically.
13392
13393 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13394 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13395
13396 @lisp
13397 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13398 @end lisp
13399
13400 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13401 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13402 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13403 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13404 like any other group.
13405
13406 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13407
13408 @lisp
13409 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13410 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13411 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13412 ("other" "")))
13413 @end lisp
13414
13415 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13416 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13417 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13418 last group.
13419
13420 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13421 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13422 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13423
13424
13425 @node Splitting Mail
13426 @subsection Splitting Mail
13427 @cindex splitting mail
13428 @cindex mail splitting
13429 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13430
13431 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13432 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13433 to be split into groups.
13434
13435 @lisp
13436 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13437 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13438 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13439 ("mail.other" "")))
13440 @end lisp
13441
13442 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13443 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13444 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13445 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13446 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13447 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13448 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13449
13450 @lisp
13451 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13452 @end lisp
13453
13454 @noindent
13455 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13456 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13457
13458 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13459 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13460 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13461 mail belongs in that group.
13462
13463 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13464 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13465 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13466 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13467 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13468 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13469 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13470 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13471 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13472 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13473
13474 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13475 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13476 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13477 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13478 thinks should carry this mail message.
13479
13480 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13481 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13482 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13483 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13484
13485 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13486 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13487 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13488 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13489 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13490
13491 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13492 @cindex crosspost
13493 @cindex links
13494 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13495 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13496 links. If that's the case for you, set
13497 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13498 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13499
13500 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13501 @findex nnmail-split-history
13502 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13503 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13504 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13505 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13506 Group Commands}).
13507
13508 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13509 Header lines longer than the value of
13510 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13511 function.
13512
13513 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13514 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13515 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
13516 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
13517 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
13518 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
13519 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
13520 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
13521 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
13522 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
13523 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
13524 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
13525
13526 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13527 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13528 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13529 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13530 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13531 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13532 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13533 other kinds of entries.)
13534
13535 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13536 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13537 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13538 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13539 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13540 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13541 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13542 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13543 month's rent money.
13544
13545
13546 @node Mail Sources
13547 @subsection Mail Sources
13548
13549 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13550 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13551 maildir, for instance.
13552
13553 @menu
13554 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13555 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13556 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13557 @end menu
13558
13559
13560 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13561 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13562 @cindex POP
13563 @cindex mail server
13564 @cindex procmail
13565 @cindex mail spool
13566 @cindex mail source
13567
13568 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13569 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13570
13571 Here's an example:
13572
13573 @lisp
13574 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13575 @end lisp
13576
13577 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13578 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13579 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13580 default values.
13581
13582 The following mail source types are available:
13583
13584 @table @code
13585 @item file
13586 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13587
13588 Keywords:
13589
13590 @table @code
13591 @item :path
13592 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13593 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13594 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13595
13596 @item :prescript
13597 @itemx :postscript
13598 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13599 @end table
13600
13601 An example file mail source:
13602
13603 @lisp
13604 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13605 @end lisp
13606
13607 Or using the default file name:
13608
13609 @lisp
13610 (file)
13611 @end lisp
13612
13613 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13614 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13615 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13616 mail spool while moving the mail.
13617
13618 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13619
13620 @lisp
13621 (setq mail-sources
13622 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13623 @end lisp
13624
13625 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13626
13627 @example
13628 #!/bin/sh
13629 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13630 # flu@@iki.fi
13631
13632 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13633 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13634 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13635 @end example
13636
13637 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
13638 file you want to use.
13639
13640
13641 @item directory
13642 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13643 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13644 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13645 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13646 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13647 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13648 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13649 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13650 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13651 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13652
13653 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13654 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13655 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13656 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13657
13658 Keywords:
13659
13660 @table @code
13661 @item :path
13662 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13663 value.
13664
13665 @item :suffix
13666 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13667 @samp{.spool}.
13668
13669 @item :predicate
13670 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13671 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13672 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13673 predicate are considered.
13674
13675 @item :prescript
13676 @itemx :postscript
13677 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13678
13679 @end table
13680
13681 An example directory mail source:
13682
13683 @lisp
13684 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13685 :suffix ".prcml")
13686 @end lisp
13687
13688 @item pop
13689 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13690
13691 Keywords:
13692
13693 @table @code
13694 @item :server
13695 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13696 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13697
13698 @item :port
13699 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13700 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13701 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13702 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13703 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13704
13705 @item :user
13706 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13707 name.
13708
13709 @item :password
13710 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13711 the user is prompted.
13712
13713 @item :program
13714 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13715 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13716
13717 @example
13718 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13719 @end example
13720
13721 The valid format specifier characters are:
13722
13723 @table @samp
13724 @item t
13725 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13726 included in this string.
13727
13728 @item s
13729 The name of the server.
13730
13731 @item P
13732 The port number of the server.
13733
13734 @item u
13735 The user name to use.
13736
13737 @item p
13738 The password to use.
13739 @end table
13740
13741 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13742 corresponding keywords.
13743
13744 @item :prescript
13745 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13746 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13747
13748 @item :postscript
13749 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13750 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13751
13752 @item :function
13753 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13754 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13755 mail should be moved to.
13756
13757 @item :authentication
13758 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13759 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13760 @code{password}.
13761
13762 @end table
13763
13764 @vindex pop3-movemail
13765 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13766 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13767 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
13768 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
13769 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
13770 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
13771 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
13772 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
13773 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13774
13775 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13776 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
13777 name, and default fetcher:
13778
13779 @lisp
13780 (pop)
13781 @end lisp
13782
13783 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13784
13785 @lisp
13786 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13787 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13788 @end lisp
13789
13790 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13791
13792 @lisp
13793 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13794 @end lisp
13795
13796 @item maildir
13797 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13798 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13799 contains exactly one mail.
13800
13801 Keywords:
13802
13803 @table @code
13804 @item :path
13805 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13806 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13807 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13808 @item :subdirs
13809 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13810 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13811
13812 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13813 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13814 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13815 @c below.
13816
13817 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13818 from locking problems).
13819
13820 @end table
13821
13822 Two example maildir mail sources:
13823
13824 @lisp
13825 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13826 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13827 @end lisp
13828
13829 @lisp
13830 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13831 :subdirs ("new"))
13832 @end lisp
13833
13834 @item imap
13835 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13836 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13837 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13838 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13839 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13840
13841 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13842 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13843
13844 Keywords:
13845
13846 @table @code
13847 @item :server
13848 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13849 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13850
13851 @item :port
13852 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13853 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13854
13855 @item :user
13856 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13857 name.
13858
13859 @item :password
13860 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13861 prompted.
13862
13863 @item :stream
13864 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13865 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13866 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13867 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13868
13869 @item :authentication
13870 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13871 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13872 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13873 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13874
13875 @item :program
13876 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13877 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13878 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13879
13880 @example
13881 ssh %s imapd
13882 @end example
13883
13884 The valid format specifier characters are:
13885
13886 @table @samp
13887 @item s
13888 The name of the server.
13889
13890 @item l
13891 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13892
13893 @item p
13894 The port number of the server.
13895 @end table
13896
13897 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13898 corresponding keywords.
13899
13900 @item :mailbox
13901 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13902 which normally is the mailbox which receive incoming mail.
13903
13904 @item :predicate
13905 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13906 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13907 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13908 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13909 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13910 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13911
13912 @item :fetchflag
13913 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13914 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13915 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13916 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13917
13918 @item :dontexpunge
13919 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13920 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13921
13922 @end table
13923
13924 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13925
13926 @lisp
13927 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13928 :stream kerberos4
13929 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13930 @end lisp
13931
13932 @item webmail
13933 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13934 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13935 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13936
13937 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13938 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13939
13940 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
13941
13942 Keywords:
13943
13944 @table @code
13945 @item :subtype
13946 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
13947 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
13948
13949 @item :user
13950 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
13951 name.
13952
13953 @item :password
13954 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
13955 prompted.
13956
13957 @item :dontexpunge
13958 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
13959 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
13960
13961 @end table
13962
13963 An example webmail source:
13964
13965 @lisp
13966 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
13967 :user "user-name"
13968 :password "secret")
13969 @end lisp
13970 @end table
13971
13972 @table @dfn
13973 @item Common Keywords
13974 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
13975
13976 Keywords:
13977
13978 @table @code
13979 @item :plugged
13980 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
13981 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
13982 example:
13983
13984 @lisp
13985 (setq mail-sources
13986 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
13987 :suffix ""
13988 :plugged t)))
13989 @end lisp
13990
13991 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
13992 useful when you use local mail and news.
13993
13994 @end table
13995 @end table
13996
13997 @subsubsection Function Interface
13998
13999 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14000 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14001 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14002 consider the following mail-source setting:
14003
14004 @lisp
14005 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
14006 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
14007 @end lisp
14008
14009 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
14010 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
14011 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
14012 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
14013 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
14014
14015 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
14016
14017
14018 @node Mail Source Customization
14019 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
14020
14021 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
14022 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
14023 variables.
14024
14025 @table @code
14026 @item mail-source-crash-box
14027 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
14028 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
14029 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
14030
14031 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
14032 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
14033 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
14034 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
14035 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
14036 (This will only happen, when receiving new mail). You may also set
14037 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
14038 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
14039
14040 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
14041 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
14042 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
14043 files. This variable only applies when
14044 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
14045
14046 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
14047 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
14048 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
14049
14050 @item mail-source-directory
14051 @vindex mail-source-directory
14052 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
14053 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
14054 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
14055 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
14056
14057 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14058 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14059 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
14060 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
14061 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
14062 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
14063 number.
14064
14065 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
14066 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
14067 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
14068
14069 @item mail-source-movemail-program
14070 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
14071 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
14072 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
14073
14074 @end table
14075
14076
14077 @node Fetching Mail
14078 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
14079
14080 @vindex mail-sources
14081 @vindex nnmail-spool-file
14082 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
14083 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
14084 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
14085
14086 If this variable (and the obsolescent @code{nnmail-spool-file}) is
14087 @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to fetch mail by
14088 themselves.
14089
14090 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
14091 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
14092
14093 @lisp
14094 (setq mail-sources
14095 '((file)
14096 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14097 :password "secret")))
14098 @end lisp
14099
14100 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
14101
14102 @lisp
14103 (setq mail-sources
14104 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
14105 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14106 :user "user-name"
14107 :port "pop3"
14108 :password "secret")))
14109 @end lisp
14110
14111
14112 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
14113 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
14114 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
14115 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
14116 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
14117 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
14118
14119
14120
14121 @node Mail Back End Variables
14122 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
14123
14124 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
14125 mail back ends.
14126
14127 @table @code
14128 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14129 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14130 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
14131 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
14132
14133 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
14134 @item nnmail-split-hook
14135 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
14136 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
14137 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
14138 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
14139 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
14140 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
14141 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
14142 in the buffer will show up in any files.
14143 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
14144 to this hook.
14145
14146 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14147 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14148 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14149 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14150 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
14151 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
14152 starting to handle the new mail) and
14153 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
14154 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
14155 default file modes the new mail files get:
14156
14157 @lisp
14158 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14159 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
14160
14161 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14162 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
14163 @end lisp
14164
14165 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
14166 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
14167 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
14168 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
14169 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
14170 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
14171 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
14172
14173 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
14174 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
14175 @findex delete-file
14176 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
14177
14178 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14179 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14180 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
14181 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
14182 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
14183
14184 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14185 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14186 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
14187 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
14188 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
14189
14190 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
14191 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
14192 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
14193
14194 @end table
14195
14196
14197 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
14198 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
14199 @cindex mail splitting
14200 @cindex fancy mail splitting
14201
14202 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
14203 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
14204 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
14205 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
14206 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
14207 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
14208
14209 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
14210
14211 @lisp
14212 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
14213 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
14214 ;; @r{from real errors.}
14215 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
14216 "mail.misc"))
14217 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
14218 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
14219 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
14220 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
14221 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
14222 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
14223 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
14224 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
14225 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
14226 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
14227 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
14228 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14229 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14230 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14231 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14232 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14233 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14234 "misc.misc")
14235 @end lisp
14236
14237 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14238 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14239 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14240
14241 @table @code
14242
14243 @item group
14244 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14245 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14246
14247 @c Don't fold this line.
14248 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
14249 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
14250 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
14251 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
14252 @var{split}.
14253
14254 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
14255 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
14256 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
14257 @var{split} is processed.
14258
14259 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
14260 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
14261 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
14262 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14263
14264 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14265 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14266 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14267 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14268 stored in one or more groups.
14269
14270 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14271 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14272 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14273
14274 @item junk
14275 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14276 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14277
14278 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14279 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14280 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14281 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14282
14283 @cindex body split
14284 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14285 body of the messages:
14286
14287 @lisp
14288 (defun split-on-body ()
14289 (save-excursion
14290 (save-restriction
14291 (widen)
14292 (goto-char (point-min))
14293 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14294 "string.group"))))
14295 @end lisp
14296
14297 The buffer is narrowed to the message in question when @var{function}
14298 is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called after
14299 @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14300 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14301 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14302 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14303 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14304
14305 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14306 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14307 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14308 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14309 should return a split.
14310
14311 @item nil
14312 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14313
14314 @end table
14315
14316 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14317
14318 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
14319 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
14320 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
14321 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
14322 for example,
14323
14324 @example
14325 (any "joe" "joemail")
14326 @end example
14327
14328 @noindent
14329 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
14330 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
14331 of the following three ways:
14332
14333 @enumerate
14334 @item
14335 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14336 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
14337 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
14338 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
14339 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
14340 @code{nil}.
14341
14342 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
14343
14344 @item
14345 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
14346 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
14347 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
14348 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
14349 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
14350
14351 @item
14352 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
14353 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
14354 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
14355 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14356 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
14357 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14358 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14359 @end enumerate
14360
14361 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14362 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14363 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14364 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14365 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14366 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14367 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14368
14369 @table @code
14370 @item from
14371 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14372 @item to
14373 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14374 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14375 @item any
14376 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14377 @end table
14378
14379 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14380 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14381 when all this splitting is performed.
14382
14383 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14384 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14385 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14386
14387 @example
14388 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14389 @end example
14390
14391 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14392 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14393
14394 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14395 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14396 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14397 groupings 1 through 9.
14398
14399 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14400 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14401 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14402 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14403 groups when users send to an address using different case
14404 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14405 is @code{t}.
14406
14407 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14408 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14409 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14410 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14411 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14412 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14413 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14414 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14415 it once per thread.
14416
14417 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14418 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14419 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14420 using the colon feature, like so:
14421 @lisp
14422 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14423 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14424 nnmail-split-fancy
14425 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14426 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14427 ))
14428 @end lisp
14429
14430 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14431 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14432 in the file specified by the variable
14433 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14434 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14435 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14436 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14437 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14438 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14439 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14440 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14441 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14442 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14443 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14444 300 kBytes in size.)
14445 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14446 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14447 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14448 messages goes into the new group.
14449
14450 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14451 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14452 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14453 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14454 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14455 ``outgoing'' group.
14456
14457
14458 @node Group Mail Splitting
14459 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14460 @cindex mail splitting
14461 @cindex group mail splitting
14462
14463 @findex gnus-group-split
14464 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14465 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14466 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14467 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14468 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14469 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14470 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14471 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14472
14473 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14474 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14475 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14476 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14477
14478 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14479 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14480 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14481 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14482 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14483 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14484 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14485
14486 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14487 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14488 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14489 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14490 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14491 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14492 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14493
14494 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14495 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14496 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14497 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14498 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14499 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14500 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14501 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14502 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14503 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14504 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14505 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14506 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14507
14508 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14509 been defined:
14510
14511 @example
14512 nnml:mail.bar:
14513 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14514 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14515 nnml:mail.foo:
14516 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14517 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14518 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14519 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14520 nnml:mail.others:
14521 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14522 @end example
14523
14524 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14525 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14526 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14527
14528 @lisp
14529 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14530 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14531 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14532 "mail.others")
14533 @end lisp
14534
14535 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14536 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14537 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14538 splits like this:
14539
14540 @lisp
14541 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14542 @end lisp
14543
14544 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14545 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14546 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14547 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14548 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14549 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14550 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14551 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14552 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14553
14554 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14555 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14556 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14557 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14558 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14559 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14560 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14561 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14562 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14563
14564 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14565 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14566 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14567 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14568 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14569 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14570
14571 @lisp
14572 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14573 @end lisp
14574
14575 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14576 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14577 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14578 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14579 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14580 value.
14581
14582 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14583 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14584 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14585 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14586
14587 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14588 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14589 @cindex incorporating old mail
14590 @cindex import old mail
14591
14592 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14593 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14594 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14595 your mail groups.
14596
14597 Doing so can be quite easy.
14598
14599 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14600 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14601 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14602 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14603 your @code{nnml} groups.
14604
14605 Here's how:
14606
14607 @enumerate
14608 @item
14609 Go to the group buffer.
14610
14611 @item
14612 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14613 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14614
14615 @item
14616 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14617
14618 @item
14619 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14620 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14621
14622 @item
14623 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14624 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14625 @end enumerate
14626
14627 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14628 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14629 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14630 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14631 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14632
14633 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14634 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14635 using the new mail back end.
14636
14637
14638 @node Expiring Mail
14639 @subsection Expiring Mail
14640 @cindex article expiry
14641 @cindex expiring mail
14642
14643 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14644 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14645 different approach to mail reading.
14646
14647 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14648 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14649 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14650 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14651 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14652 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14653 course.
14654
14655 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14656 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14657 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14658 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14659 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14660 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14661 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14662 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14663 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14664
14665 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14666 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14667 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14668 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14669 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14670 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14671 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14672 expirable.
14673
14674 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14675 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14676 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14677 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14678 into its own group.)
14679
14680 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14681 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14682 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14683 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14684 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14685 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14686 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14687 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14688 scoring.
14689
14690 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14691 Groups that match the regular expression
14692 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14693 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14694 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14695
14696 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14697 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14698 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14699 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14700 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14701
14702 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14703 @lisp
14704 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14705 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14706 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14707 @end lisp
14708
14709 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14710 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14711 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14712 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14713 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14714
14715 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14716 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14717
14718 @lisp
14719 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14720 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14721 @end lisp
14722
14723 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14724 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14725
14726 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14727 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14728 don't really mix very well.
14729
14730 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14731 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14732 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14733 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14734 days.
14735
14736 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14737 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14738 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14739 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14740 everywhere else:
14741
14742 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14743 @lisp
14744 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14745 (lambda (group)
14746 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14747 31)
14748 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14749 1)
14750 ((string= group "important")
14751 'never)
14752 (t
14753 6))))
14754 @end lisp
14755
14756 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14757 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14758
14759 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14760 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14761 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14762 @code{never}.
14763
14764 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14765 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14766
14767 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14768 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14769 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14770 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14771 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14772 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14773 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14774 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14775 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14776 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14777 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14778 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14779 name or @code{delete}.
14780
14781 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14782 @lisp
14783 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14784 @end lisp
14785
14786 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14787 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14788 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14789 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14790 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14791
14792 @lisp
14793 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14794 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14795 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14796 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14797 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14798 @end lisp
14799
14800 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14801 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14802 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14803 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14804 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14805 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14806
14807 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14808 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14809 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14810 easier for procmail users.
14811
14812 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14813 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14814 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14815 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14816 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14817 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14818 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14819 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14820 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14821 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14822 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14823 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14824 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14825 with! So there!
14826
14827 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14828
14829 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14830 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14831 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14832 auto-expire turned on.
14833
14834
14835 @node Washing Mail
14836 @subsection Washing Mail
14837 @cindex mail washing
14838 @cindex list server brain damage
14839 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14840
14841 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14842 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14843 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14844 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14845 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14846 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14847
14848 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14849 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14850 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14851 laugh.
14852
14853 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14854 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14855 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14856 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14857
14858 @table @code
14859 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14860 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14861 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14862 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14863 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14864
14865 @table @code
14866 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14867 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14868 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14869 Emacs running on MS machines.
14870
14871 @end table
14872
14873 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14874 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14875 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14876 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14877
14878 @table @code
14879 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14880 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14881 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14882 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14883
14884 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14885 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14886 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14887 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14888 into a feature by documenting it.)
14889
14890 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14891 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14892 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14893 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14894 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14895 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14896 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14897 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14898
14899 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14900 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14901
14902 @lisp
14903 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14904 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14905 @end lisp
14906
14907 This can also be done non-destructively with
14908 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14909
14910 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14911 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14912 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14913
14914 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14915 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14916 @cindex Eudora
14917 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14918 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14919 @code{References} headers.
14920
14921 @end table
14922
14923 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14924 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14925 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14926 include:
14927
14928 @table @code
14929 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14930 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14931 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14932
14933 @end table
14934 @end table
14935
14936
14937 @node Duplicates
14938 @subsection Duplicates
14939
14940 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
14941 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
14942 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
14943 @cindex duplicate mails
14944 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
14945 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
14946 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
14947 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
14948 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
14949 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
14950 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
14951 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
14952 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
14953 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
14954 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
14955 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
14956 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
14957
14958 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
14959 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
14960 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
14961 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
14962
14963 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
14964 @code{nil}.
14965
14966 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
14967 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
14968 methods:
14969
14970 @lisp
14971 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
14972 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
14973 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
14974 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
14975 (any mail "mail.misc")
14976 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14977 [...] ))
14978 @end lisp
14979 @noindent
14980 Or something like:
14981 @lisp
14982 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14983 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
14984 ;; @r{Other rules.}
14985 [...]))
14986 @end lisp
14987
14988 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
14989 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
14990 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
14991 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
14992 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
14993
14994
14995 @node Not Reading Mail
14996 @subsection Not Reading Mail
14997
14998 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
14999 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
15000 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
15001
15002 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
15003 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
15004 mail, which should help.
15005
15006 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15007 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15008 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15009 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15010 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15011 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
15012 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
15013 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
15014 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
15015 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
15016 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
15017
15018 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
15019 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
15020 incoming mail.
15021
15022
15023 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
15024 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
15025
15026 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
15027 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
15028 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
15029
15030 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
15031 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
15032 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
15033 Spool}).
15034
15035 @menu
15036 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
15037 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
15038 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
15039 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
15040 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
15041 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
15042 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
15043 @end menu
15044
15045
15046 @node Unix Mail Box
15047 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
15048 @cindex nnmbox
15049 @cindex unix mail box
15050
15051 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
15052 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15053 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
15054 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
15055 which group it belongs in.
15056
15057 Virtual server settings:
15058
15059 @table @code
15060 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
15061 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15062 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
15063 @file{~/mbox}.
15064
15065 @item nnmbox-active-file
15066 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
15067 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
15068 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
15069
15070 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
15071 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15072 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
15073 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
15074 @end table
15075
15076
15077 @node Rmail Babyl
15078 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
15079 @cindex nnbabyl
15080 @cindex Rmail mbox
15081
15082 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15083 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15084 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
15085 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
15086 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
15087
15088 Virtual server settings:
15089
15090 @table @code
15091 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
15092 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15093 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
15094
15095 @item nnbabyl-active-file
15096 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15097 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
15098 @file{~/.rmail-active}
15099
15100 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15101 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15102 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
15103 @code{t}
15104 @end table
15105
15106
15107 @node Mail Spool
15108 @subsubsection Mail Spool
15109 @cindex nnml
15110 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
15111
15112 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
15113 format. It should be used with some caution.
15114
15115 @vindex nnml-directory
15116 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
15117 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
15118 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
15119 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
15120
15121 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
15122 care of all that.
15123
15124 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
15125 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
15126 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
15127 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
15128 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
15129 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
15130 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
15131 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
15132
15133 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
15134 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
15135 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
15136 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
15137
15138 @cindex self contained nnml servers
15139 @cindex marks
15140 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
15141 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15142 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15143 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
15144 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
15145 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
15146 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
15147 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
15148 directory).
15149
15150 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
15151 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
15152 them next time it starts.
15153
15154 Virtual server settings:
15155
15156 @table @code
15157 @item nnml-directory
15158 @vindex nnml-directory
15159 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
15160 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
15161 is @file{~/Mail}).
15162
15163 @item nnml-active-file
15164 @vindex nnml-active-file
15165 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
15166 @file{~/Mail/active}.
15167
15168 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
15169 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
15170 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15171 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
15172
15173 @item nnml-get-new-mail
15174 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15175 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
15176 @code{t}.
15177
15178 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
15179 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
15180 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15181 default is @code{nil}.
15182
15183 @item nnml-nov-file-name
15184 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
15185 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
15186
15187 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15188 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15189 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
15190
15191 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
15192 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
15193 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15194 default is @code{nil}.
15195
15196 @item nnml-marks-file-name
15197 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
15198 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
15199
15200 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
15201 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
15202 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
15203 files.
15204
15205 @end table
15206
15207 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
15208 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
15209 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
15210 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
15211 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
15212 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
15213 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
15214 Commands}).
15215
15216
15217 @node MH Spool
15218 @subsubsection MH Spool
15219 @cindex nnmh
15220 @cindex mh-e mail spool
15221
15222 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
15223 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
15224 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
15225 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
15226 for.
15227
15228 Virtual server settings:
15229
15230 @table @code
15231 @item nnmh-directory
15232 @vindex nnmh-directory
15233 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
15234 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
15235 @file{~/Mail})
15236
15237 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
15238 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15239 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
15240 @code{t}.
15241
15242 @item nnmh-be-safe
15243 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
15244 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
15245 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
15246 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
15247 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
15248 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
15249 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
15250 @end table
15251
15252
15253 @node Maildir
15254 @subsubsection Maildir
15255 @cindex nnmaildir
15256 @cindex maildir
15257
15258 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15259 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15260 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15261 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15262 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15263 within a maildir.
15264
15265 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15266 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15267 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15268 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15269 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15270 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15271 that appear as group in Gnus.
15272
15273 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15274 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15275 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15276
15277 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15278 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15279 another, and you will keep your marks.
15280
15281 Virtual server settings:
15282
15283 @table @code
15284 @item directory
15285 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15286 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15287 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15288 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15289 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15290 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15291 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15292 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15293 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15294 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15295
15296 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15297 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15298 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15299 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15300 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15301 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15302 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15303 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15304 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15305 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15306 value.
15307
15308 @item target-prefix
15309 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15310 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15311 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15312 closed.
15313
15314 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15315 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15316 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15317 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15318 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15319 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15320 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15321 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15322 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15323
15324 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15325 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15326 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15327 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15328 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15329
15330 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15331 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15332 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15333 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15334 @code{force} argument.
15335
15336 @item directory-files
15337 This should be a function with the same interface as
15338 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15339 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15340 parameter is optional; the default is
15341 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15342 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15343 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15344 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15345 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15346 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15347
15348 @item get-new-mail
15349 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15350 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15351 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15352 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15353 value is @code{nil}.
15354
15355 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15356 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15357 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15358 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15359 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15360 @end table
15361
15362 @subsubsection Group parameters
15363
15364 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15365 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15366 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15367 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15368 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15369 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15370 another back end.
15371
15372 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15373 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15374 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15375 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15376 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15377 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15378 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15379 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15380 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15381
15382 @table @code
15383 @item expire-age
15384 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15385 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15386 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15387 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15388 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15389 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15390 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15391 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15392 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15393 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15394 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15395 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15396 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15397
15398 @item expire-group
15399 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15400 @example
15401 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15402 @end example
15403 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15404 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15405 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15406 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15407 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15408 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15409 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15410 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15411 article. So that form can refer to
15412 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15413 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15414 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15415 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15416
15417 @item read-only
15418 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15419 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15420 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15421 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15422 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15423 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15424 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15425 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15426 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15427 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15428 contain extra copies of the articles.
15429
15430 @item directory-files
15431 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15432 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15433 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15434 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15435
15436 @item distrust-Lines:
15437 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15438 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15439 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15440
15441 @item always-marks
15442 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15443 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15444 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15445 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15446 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15447 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15448
15449 @item never-marks
15450 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15451 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15452 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15453 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15454 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15455 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15456 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15457
15458 @item nov-cache-size
15459 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15460 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15461 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15462 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15463 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15464 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15465 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15466 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15467 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15468 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15469 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15470 @end table
15471
15472 @subsubsection Article identification
15473 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15474 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15475 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15476 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15477 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15478 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15479 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15480 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15481 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15482 request the article in the summary buffer.
15483
15484 @subsubsection NOV data
15485 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15486 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15487 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15488 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15489 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15490 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15491 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15492 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15493 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15494 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15495 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15496
15497 @subsubsection Article marks
15498 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15499 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15500 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15501 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15502 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15503 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15504 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15505 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15506
15507 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15508 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15509 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15510 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15511 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15512 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15513 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15514 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15515 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15516
15517
15518 @node Mail Folders
15519 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15520 @cindex nnfolder
15521 @cindex mbox folders
15522 @cindex mail folders
15523
15524 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15525 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15526 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15527 numbers and arrival dates.
15528
15529 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15530 @cindex marks
15531 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15532 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15533 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15534 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15535 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15536 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15537 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15538 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15539 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15540 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15541
15542 Virtual server settings:
15543
15544 @table @code
15545 @item nnfolder-directory
15546 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15547 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15548 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15549 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15550
15551 @item nnfolder-active-file
15552 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15553 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15554
15555 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15556 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15557 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15558 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15559
15560 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15561 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15562 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15563 default is @code{t}
15564
15565 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15566 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15567 @cindex backup files
15568 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15569 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15570 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15571 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15572
15573 @lisp
15574 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15575 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15576
15577 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15578 @end lisp
15579
15580 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15581 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15582 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15583 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15584 extract some information from it before removing it.
15585
15586 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15587 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15588 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15589 default is @code{nil}.
15590
15591 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15592 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15593 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15594
15595 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15596 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15597 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15598 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15599
15600 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15601 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15602 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15603 default is @code{nil}.
15604
15605 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15606 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15607 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15608
15609 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15610 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15611 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15612 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15613
15614 @end table
15615
15616
15617 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15618 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15619 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15620 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15621 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15622 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15623 though.
15624
15625 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15626 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15627
15628 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15629 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15630 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15631 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15632 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15633
15634 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15635 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15636 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15637 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15638 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15639 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15640 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15641 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15642 via NFS).
15643
15644 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15645 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15646 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15647 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15648
15649 @table @code
15650 @item nnmbox
15651
15652 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15653 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15654 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15655 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15656 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15657 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15658 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15659 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15660 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15661 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15662 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15663 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15664 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15665 what's where.
15666
15667 @item nnbabyl
15668
15669 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15670 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15671 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15672 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15673 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15674 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15675 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15676 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15677 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15678 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15679 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15680 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15681 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15682 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15683
15684 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15685 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15686 look at your mail.
15687
15688 @item nnml
15689
15690 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15691 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15692 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15693 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15694 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15695 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15696 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15697 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15698 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15699 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15700 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15701 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15702 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15703 provided by the active file and overviews.
15704
15705 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15706 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15707 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15708 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15709 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15710 wins big.
15711
15712 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15713 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15714 tiny files.
15715
15716 @item nnmh
15717
15718 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15719 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15720 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15721 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15722 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15723 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15724 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15725
15726 @item nnfolder
15727
15728 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15729 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15730 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15731 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15732 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15733 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15734 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15735 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15736 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15737
15738 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15739 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15740 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15741 friendly mail back end all over.
15742
15743 @item nnmaildir
15744
15745 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15746 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15747 mail back ends.
15748
15749 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15750 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15751 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15752 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15753 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15754 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15755 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15756 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15757 file system.
15758
15759 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15760 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15761 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15762 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15763 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15764 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15765 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15766 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15767 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15768 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15769 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15770
15771 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15772 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15773 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15774 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15775 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15776 @code{nnmaildir}.
15777
15778 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15779 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15780 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15781 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15782 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15783 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15784 removed in the future.
15785
15786 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15787 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15788 on your file system.
15789
15790 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15791 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15792
15793 @end table
15794
15795
15796 @node Browsing the Web
15797 @section Browsing the Web
15798 @cindex web
15799 @cindex browsing the web
15800 @cindex www
15801 @cindex http
15802
15803 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15804 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15805 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15806 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15807 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15808 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15809 even know what a news group is.
15810
15811 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15812 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15813 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15814 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15815 you mad in the end.
15816
15817 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15818 to do it instead?
15819
15820 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15821 interfaces to these sources.
15822
15823 @menu
15824 * Archiving Mail::
15825 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15826 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15827 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15828 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15829 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15830 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15831 @end menu
15832
15833 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15834 alternatives to work.
15835
15836 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15837 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15838 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15839 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15840 though, you should be ok.
15841
15842 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15843 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15844 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15845 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15846 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15847
15848 @node Archiving Mail
15849 @subsection Archiving Mail
15850 @cindex archiving mail
15851 @cindex backup of mail
15852
15853 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15854 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15855 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15856 marks is fairly simple.
15857
15858 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15859 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15860 though.)
15861
15862 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15863 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15864 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15865 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15866 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15867 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15868 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15869 before you restore the data.
15870
15871 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15872 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15873 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15874 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15875 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15876 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15877 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15878 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15879 is unnecessary in that case.
15880
15881 @node Web Searches
15882 @subsection Web Searches
15883 @cindex nnweb
15884 @cindex Google
15885 @cindex dejanews
15886 @cindex gmane
15887 @cindex Usenet searches
15888 @cindex searching the Usenet
15889
15890 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15891 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15892 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15893 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15894 searches without having to use a browser.
15895
15896 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15897 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15898 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15899 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15900 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15901
15902 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15903 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15904 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15905 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15906 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15907 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15908 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15909 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15910 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15911 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15912 group as read.
15913
15914 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15915 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15916 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15917 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15918 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15919 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15920
15921 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15922 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15923 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15924
15925 Virtual server variables:
15926
15927 @table @code
15928 @item nnweb-type
15929 @vindex nnweb-type
15930 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15931 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15932 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15933
15934 @item nnweb-search
15935 @vindex nnweb-search
15936 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15937
15938 @item nnweb-max-hits
15939 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
15940 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
15941 999.
15942
15943 @item nnweb-type-definition
15944 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
15945 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
15946 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
15947 present:
15948
15949 @table @code
15950 @item article
15951 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
15952 understands.
15953
15954 @item map
15955 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
15956
15957 @item search
15958 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
15959
15960 @item address
15961 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
15962 to.
15963
15964 @item id
15965 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
15966 @end table
15967
15968 @end table
15969
15970
15971 @node Slashdot
15972 @subsection Slashdot
15973 @cindex Slashdot
15974 @cindex nnslashdot
15975
15976 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
15977 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
15978 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
15979
15980 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
15981 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15982
15983 @lisp
15984 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
15985 '((nnslashdot "")))
15986 @end lisp
15987
15988 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
15989 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
15990 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
15991 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
15992 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
15993 Methods}).
15994
15995 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
15996 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15997
15998 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
15999 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
16000 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
16001 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
16002 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
16003 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
16004 @acronym{HTML} forms.
16005
16006 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
16007
16008 @table @code
16009 @item nnslashdot-threaded
16010 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
16011 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
16012 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
16013 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
16014 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
16015 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
16016
16017 @item nnslashdot-login-name
16018 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
16019 The login name to use when posting.
16020
16021 @item nnslashdot-password
16022 @vindex nnslashdot-password
16023 The password to use when posting.
16024
16025 @item nnslashdot-directory
16026 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
16027 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
16028 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
16029
16030 @item nnslashdot-active-url
16031 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
16032 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
16033 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
16034 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
16035
16036 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
16037 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
16038 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
16039
16040 @item nnslashdot-article-url
16041 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
16042 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
16043 article. The default is
16044 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
16045
16046 @item nnslashdot-threshold
16047 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
16048 The score threshold. The default is -1.
16049
16050 @item nnslashdot-group-number
16051 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
16052 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
16053 updated. The default is 0.
16054
16055 @end table
16056
16057
16058
16059 @node Ultimate
16060 @subsection Ultimate
16061 @cindex nnultimate
16062 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
16063
16064 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
16065 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
16066 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
16067 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16068
16069 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
16070 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
16071 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
16072 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
16073 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
16074 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
16075 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
16076
16077 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
16078
16079 @table @code
16080 @item nnultimate-directory
16081 @vindex nnultimate-directory
16082 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
16083 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
16084 @end table
16085
16086
16087 @node Web Archive
16088 @subsection Web Archive
16089 @cindex nnwarchive
16090 @cindex Web Archive
16091
16092 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
16093 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
16094 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
16095 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
16096 groups updated.
16097
16098 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
16099 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
16100 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
16101 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
16102 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
16103 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
16104 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
16105 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
16106
16107 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
16108
16109 @table @code
16110 @item nnwarchive-directory
16111 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
16112 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
16113 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
16114
16115 @item nnwarchive-login
16116 @vindex nnwarchive-login
16117 The account name on the web server.
16118
16119 @item nnwarchive-passwd
16120 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
16121 The password for your account on the web server.
16122 @end table
16123
16124 @node RSS
16125 @subsection RSS
16126 @cindex nnrss
16127 @cindex RSS
16128
16129 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16130 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16131 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16132 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16133 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16134
16135 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16136 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16137
16138 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16139 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16140 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16141 group names.
16142
16143 @kindex G R (Group)
16144 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16145 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16146 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16147 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16148
16149 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16150 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16151 subscribe to groups.
16152
16153 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16154 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16155 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16156 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16157 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
16158 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
16159 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
16160 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
16161
16162 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16163 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16164 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16165
16166 @cindex OPML
16167 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16168 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16169 Markup Language).
16170
16171 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16172 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16173 file.
16174 @end defun
16175
16176 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16177 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16178 @acronym{OPML} format.
16179 @end defun
16180
16181 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16182
16183 @table @code
16184 @item nnrss-directory
16185 @vindex nnrss-directory
16186 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16187 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16188
16189 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16190 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16191 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16192 data files. The default is the value of
16193 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16194 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16195
16196 @item nnrss-use-local
16197 @vindex nnrss-use-local
16198 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
16199 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
16200 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
16201 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
16202 download script using @command{wget}.
16203
16204 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
16205 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
16206 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
16207 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
16208 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
16209 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
16210 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
16211 @samp{text/html} parts.
16212 @end table
16213
16214 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
16215 the summary buffer.
16216
16217 @lisp
16218 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16219 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16220
16221 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
16222 (let ((descr
16223 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
16224 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
16225 @end lisp
16226
16227 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
16228 summary buffer.
16229
16230 @lisp
16231 (require 'browse-url)
16232
16233 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
16234 (interactive "p")
16235 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
16236 (mail-header-extra
16237 (gnus-data-header
16238 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
16239 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
16240 (if url
16241 (progn
16242 (browse-url (cdr url))
16243 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
16244 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
16245
16246 (eval-after-load "gnus"
16247 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
16248 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
16249 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
16250 @end lisp
16251
16252 Even if you have added @code{"text/html"} to the
16253 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
16254 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
16255 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
16256 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
16257 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
16258 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
16259 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
16260 @code{nnrss} groups:
16261
16262 @lisp
16263 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
16264 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
16265 '(add-to-list
16266 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
16267 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16268 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16269
16270 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16271 (add-to-list
16272 'gnus-parameters
16273 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16274 @end lisp
16275
16276
16277 @node Customizing W3
16278 @subsection Customizing W3
16279 @cindex W3
16280 @cindex html
16281 @cindex url
16282 @cindex Netscape
16283
16284 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16285 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16286 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16287 users.
16288
16289 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16290 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16291 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16292
16293 @lisp
16294 (eval-after-load "w3"
16295 '(progn
16296 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16297 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16298 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16299 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16300 (browse-url url)
16301 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16302 @end lisp
16303
16304 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16305 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16306 follow the link.
16307
16308
16309 @node IMAP
16310 @section IMAP
16311 @cindex nnimap
16312 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16313
16314 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16315 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16316 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16317 specify the network address of the server.
16318
16319 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16320 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16321 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16322 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16323 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16324 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16325
16326 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16327 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16328 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16329 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16330
16331 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16332 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16333 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16334 usage explained in this section.
16335
16336 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16337 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16338 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16339 see below.)
16340
16341 @lisp
16342 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16343 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16344 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16345 (nnimap "dolk"
16346 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16347 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16348 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16349 (nnimap "barbar"
16350 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16351 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16352 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16353 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16354 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16355 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16356 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16357 (nnimap-stream network))
16358 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16359 (nnimap "vic20"
16360 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16361 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16362 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16363 @end lisp
16364
16365 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16366 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16367 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16368 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16369
16370 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16371 server:
16372
16373 @table @code
16374
16375 @item nnimap-address
16376 @vindex nnimap-address
16377
16378 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16379 server name if not specified.
16380
16381 @item nnimap-server-port
16382 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16383 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16384
16385 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16386
16387 @lisp
16388 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16389 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16390 @end lisp
16391
16392 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16393 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16394 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16395 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16396 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16397 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16398 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16399
16400 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16401 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16402 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16403 mailbox.
16404
16405 Example server specification:
16406
16407 @lisp
16408 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16409 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16410 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16411 @end lisp
16412
16413 @item nnimap-stream
16414 @vindex nnimap-stream
16415 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16416 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16417 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16418 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16419 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16420
16421 Example server specification:
16422
16423 @lisp
16424 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16425 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16426 @end lisp
16427
16428 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16429
16430 @itemize @bullet
16431 @item
16432 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16433 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16434 @item
16435 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16436 @item
16437 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16438 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16439 @samp{starttls}.
16440 @item
16441 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16442 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16443 @item
16444 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16445 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16446 @item
16447 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16448 @item
16449 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16450 @end itemize
16451
16452 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16453 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16454 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16455 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16456 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16457 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16458 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16459 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16460 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16461 program.
16462
16463 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16464 needed. It is available from
16465 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16466
16467 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16468 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16469 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16470 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16471 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16472 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16473 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16474 tried.
16475
16476 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16477 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16478 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16479 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16480 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16481 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16482 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16483 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16484
16485 @vindex imap-shell-program
16486 @vindex imap-shell-host
16487 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16488 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16489
16490 @item nnimap-authenticator
16491 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16492
16493 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16494 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16495
16496 Example server specification:
16497
16498 @lisp
16499 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16500 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16501 @end lisp
16502
16503 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16504
16505 @itemize @bullet
16506 @item
16507 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16508 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16509 @item
16510 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16511 @code{imtest}.
16512 @item
16513 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16514 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16515 @item
16516 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16517 @item
16518 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16519 @item
16520 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16521 @end itemize
16522
16523 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16524 @cindex expunging
16525 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16526 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16527 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16528 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16529 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16530 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16531 similar).
16532
16533 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16534 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16535 running in circles yet?
16536
16537 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16538 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16539 variable.
16540
16541 The possible options are:
16542
16543 @table @code
16544
16545 @item always
16546 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16547 closing a mailbox.
16548 @item never
16549 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16550 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16551 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16552 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16553 @item ask
16554 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16555 articles or not.
16556
16557 @end table
16558
16559 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16560 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16561
16562 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16563 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16564 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16565 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16566 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16567 has only one.)
16568
16569 Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
16570 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16571
16572 @lisp
16573 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16574 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16575 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16576 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16577 @end lisp
16578
16579 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16580 as ticked for other users.
16581
16582 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16583 @cindex expunging
16584 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16585 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16586
16587 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16588 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16589 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16590 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16591
16592 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16593 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16594 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16595 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16596
16597 However, if @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}
16598 is true, this variable has no effect since the search logic
16599 is reversed, as described below.
16600
16601 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16602 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16603
16604 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16605 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16606 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16607 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16608
16609 @example
16610 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16611 @end example
16612
16613 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16614 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16615 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16616 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16617 @code{port imap}.
16618
16619 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16620 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16621
16622 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16623 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16624 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16625
16626 @item nnimap-nov-is-evil
16627 @vindex nnimap-nov-is-evil
16628 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
16629 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
16630
16631 Never generate or use a local @acronym{NOV} database. Defaults to the
16632 value of @code{gnus-agent}.
16633
16634 Using a @acronym{NOV} database usually makes header fetching much
16635 faster, but it uses the @code{UID SEARCH UID} command, which is very
16636 slow on some servers (notably some versions of Courier). Since the Gnus
16637 Agent caches the information in the @acronym{NOV} database without using
16638 the slow command, this variable defaults to true if the Agent is in use,
16639 and false otherwise.
16640
16641 @item nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
16642 @vindex nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
16643 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
16644 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16645
16646 Avoid the @code{UID SEARCH UID @var{message numbers} NOT SINCE
16647 @var{date}} command, which is slow on some @acronym{IMAP} servers
16648 (notably, some versions of Courier). Instead, use @code{UID SEARCH SINCE
16649 @var{date}} and prune the list of expirable articles within Gnus.
16650
16651 When Gnus expires your mail (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), it starts with a
16652 list of expirable articles and asks the IMAP server questions like ``Of
16653 these articles, which ones are older than a week?'' While this seems
16654 like a perfectly reasonable question, some IMAP servers take a long time
16655 to answer it, since they seemingly go looking into every old article to
16656 see if it is one of the expirable ones. Curiously, the question ``Of
16657 @emph{all} articles, which ones are newer than a week?'' seems to be
16658 much faster to answer, so setting this variable causes Gnus to ask this
16659 question and figure out the answer to the real question itself.
16660
16661 This problem can really sneak up on you: when you first configure Gnus,
16662 everything works fine, but once you accumulate a couple thousand
16663 messages, you start cursing Gnus for being so slow. On the other hand,
16664 if you get a lot of email within a week, setting this variable will
16665 cause a lot of network traffic between Gnus and the IMAP server.
16666
16667 @end table
16668
16669 @menu
16670 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16671 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16672 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16673 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16674 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16675 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16676 @end menu
16677
16678
16679
16680 @node Splitting in IMAP
16681 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16682 @cindex splitting imap mail
16683
16684 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16685 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16686 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16687 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16688 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16689
16690 And it does.
16691
16692 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16693 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16694 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16695
16696 Here are the variables of interest:
16697
16698 @table @code
16699
16700 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16701 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16702 @cindex crosspost
16703 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16704
16705 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16706 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16707 found will be used.
16708
16709 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16710
16711 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16712 @cindex splitting, inbox
16713 @cindex inbox
16714 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16715
16716 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16717 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16718 splitting is disabled!
16719
16720 @lisp
16721 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16722 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16723 @end lisp
16724
16725 No nnmail equivalent.
16726
16727 @item nnimap-split-rule
16728 @cindex splitting, rules
16729 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16730
16731 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16732 this variable.
16733
16734 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16735 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16736 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16737 Neither did I, we need examples.
16738
16739 @lisp
16740 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16741 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16742 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16743 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16744 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16745 @end lisp
16746
16747 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16748 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16749 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16750
16751 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16752 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16753 instance:
16754
16755 @lisp
16756 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16757 @end lisp
16758
16759 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16760 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16761
16762 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16763 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16764 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16765 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16766
16767 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16768 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16769 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16770 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16771 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16772 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16773
16774 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16775 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16776 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16777
16778 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16779 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16780 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16781
16782 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16783
16784 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16785 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16786 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16787
16788 @lisp
16789 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16790 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16791 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16792 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16793 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16794 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16795 @end lisp
16796
16797 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16798 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16799 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16800 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16801 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16802 group/function elements.
16803
16804 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16805
16806 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16807 @cindex splitting
16808 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16809
16810 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16811 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16812
16813 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16814 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16815 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16816 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16817
16818 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16819 @cindex splitting, fancy
16820 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16821 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16822
16823 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16824 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16825 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16826
16827 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16828 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16829 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16830 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16831
16832 Example:
16833
16834 @lisp
16835 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16836 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16837 @end lisp
16838
16839 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16840
16841 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16842 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16843 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16844
16845 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16846 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16847 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16848 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16849
16850 @end table
16851
16852 @node Expiring in IMAP
16853 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16854 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16855
16856 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16857 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16858 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16859 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16860 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16861 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16862 process.
16863
16864 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16865 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16866 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16867 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16868 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16869 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16870 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16871 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16872
16873 If expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail seems very slow, try setting the server
16874 variable @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}.
16875
16876 @table @code
16877
16878 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16879 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16880
16881 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16882 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16883
16884 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16885
16886 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16887 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16888 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16889 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16890
16891 @end table
16892
16893 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16894 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16895 @cindex editing imap acls
16896 @cindex Access Control Lists
16897 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16898 @kindex G l (Group)
16899 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16900
16901 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16902 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16903 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16904 doesn't.
16905
16906 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16907 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16908 editing window with detailed instructions.
16909
16910 Some possible uses:
16911
16912 @itemize @bullet
16913 @item
16914 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16915 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16916 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16917 @item
16918 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16919 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16920 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16921 INBOX.mailbox).
16922 @end itemize
16923
16924 @node Expunging mailboxes
16925 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16926 @cindex expunging
16927
16928 @cindex expunge
16929 @cindex manual expunging
16930 @kindex G x (Group)
16931 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16932
16933 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16934 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16935 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16936
16937 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16938 delete them.
16939
16940 @node A note on namespaces
16941 @subsection A note on namespaces
16942 @cindex IMAP namespace
16943 @cindex namespaces
16944
16945 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
16946 by the following text in the RFC2060:
16947
16948 @display
16949 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
16950
16951 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
16952 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
16953 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
16954 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
16955
16956 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
16957 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
16958 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
16959 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
16960 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
16961 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
16962 @end display
16963
16964 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
16965 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
16966 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
16967
16968 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
16969 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
16970 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
16971 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
16972 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
16973 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
16974 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
16975 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
16976 Gnus.
16977
16978 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
16979 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
16980 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
16981
16982 @node Debugging IMAP
16983 @subsection Debugging IMAP
16984 @cindex IMAP debugging
16985 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
16986
16987 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
16988 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
16989 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
16990 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
16991
16992 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
16993 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
16994 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
16995 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
16996 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
16997 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
16998 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
16999
17000
17001 @vindex imap-log
17002 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
17003 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
17004 follows:
17005
17006 @lisp
17007 (setq imap-log t)
17008 @end lisp
17009
17010 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
17011 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
17012 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
17013 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
17014 data.
17015
17016 @node Other Sources
17017 @section Other Sources
17018
17019 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17020 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17021 newsgroups.
17022
17023 @menu
17024 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17025 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17026 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17027 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
17028 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17029 @end menu
17030
17031
17032 @node Directory Groups
17033 @subsection Directory Groups
17034 @cindex nndir
17035 @cindex directory groups
17036
17037 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17038 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17039 names, of course.
17040
17041 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17042 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17043 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17044 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17045
17046 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17047 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17048 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17049 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17050 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17051
17052 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17053
17054 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17055 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17056 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17057 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17058
17059
17060 @node Anything Groups
17061 @subsection Anything Groups
17062 @cindex nneething
17063
17064 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17065 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17066 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17067 true.
17068
17069 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17070 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17071 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17072 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17073 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17074 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17075 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17076 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
17077 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17078 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17079 elements.
17080
17081 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17082 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17083 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17084 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17085
17086 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17087 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17088 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17089 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17090
17091 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17092 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17093 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17094 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17095 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17096 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17097 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17098 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17099
17100 Some variables:
17101
17102 @table @code
17103 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17104 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17105 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17106 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17107
17108 @item nneething-exclude-files
17109 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17110 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17111 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17112
17113 @item nneething-include-files
17114 @vindex nneething-include-files
17115 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17116 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17117
17118 @item nneething-map-file
17119 @vindex nneething-map-file
17120 Name of the map files.
17121 @end table
17122
17123
17124 @node Document Groups
17125 @subsection Document Groups
17126 @cindex nndoc
17127 @cindex documentation group
17128 @cindex help group
17129
17130 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17131 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17132
17133 @table @code
17134 @cindex Babyl
17135 @cindex Rmail mbox
17136 @item babyl
17137 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
17138
17139 @cindex mbox
17140 @cindex Unix mbox
17141 @item mbox
17142 The standard Unix mbox file.
17143
17144 @cindex MMDF mail box
17145 @item mmdf
17146 The MMDF mail box format.
17147
17148 @item news
17149 Several news articles appended into a file.
17150
17151 @cindex rnews batch files
17152 @item rnews
17153 The rnews batch transport format.
17154
17155 @item nsmail
17156 Netscape mail boxes.
17157
17158 @item mime-parts
17159 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17160
17161 @item standard-digest
17162 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17163
17164 @item mime-digest
17165 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17166
17167 @item lanl-gov-announce
17168 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17169
17170 @cindex forwarded messages
17171 @item rfc822-forward
17172 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17173
17174 @item outlook
17175 The Outlook mail box.
17176
17177 @item oe-dbx
17178 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17179
17180 @item exim-bounce
17181 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17182
17183 @item forward
17184 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17185
17186 @item rfc934
17187 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17188
17189 @item mailman
17190 A mailman digest.
17191
17192 @item clari-briefs
17193 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17194
17195 @item slack-digest
17196 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17197
17198 @item mail-in-mail
17199 The last resort.
17200 @end table
17201
17202 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17203 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17204 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17205 file is.
17206
17207 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17208 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17209 group. And that's it.
17210
17211 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17212 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17213 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17214 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17215 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17216 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17217 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17218 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17219 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17220 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17221
17222 Virtual server variables:
17223
17224 @table @code
17225 @item nndoc-article-type
17226 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17227 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17228 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17229 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17230 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17231 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17232
17233 @item nndoc-post-type
17234 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17235 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17236 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17237 and @code{news}.
17238 @end table
17239
17240 @menu
17241 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17242 @end menu
17243
17244
17245 @node Document Server Internals
17246 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17247
17248 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17249 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17250 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17251 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17252
17253 First, here's an example document type definition:
17254
17255 @example
17256 (mmdf
17257 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17258 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17259 @end example
17260
17261 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17262 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17263 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17264 types can be defined with very few settings:
17265
17266 @table @code
17267 @item first-article
17268 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17269 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17270 totally ignored.
17271
17272 @item article-begin
17273 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17274 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17275 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17276 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17277
17278 @item article-begin-function
17279 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17280 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17281
17282 @item head-begin
17283 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17284 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17285 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17286
17287 @item head-begin-function
17288 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17289 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17290
17291 @item head-end
17292 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17293 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17294
17295 @item body-begin
17296 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17297 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17298 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17299
17300 @item body-begin-function
17301 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17302 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17303
17304 @item body-end
17305 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17306 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17307 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17308
17309 @item body-end-function
17310 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17311 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17312
17313 @item file-begin
17314 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17315 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17316
17317 @item file-end
17318 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17319 regexp will be totally ignored.
17320
17321 @end table
17322
17323 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17324 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17325 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17326 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17327 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17328
17329 @table @code
17330 @item prepare-body-function
17331 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17332 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17333 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17334
17335 @item article-transform-function
17336 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17337 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17338 body of the article.
17339
17340 @item generate-head-function
17341 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17342 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17343 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17344 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17345
17346 @item generate-article-function
17347 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17348 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17349 parameter when requesting all articles.
17350
17351 @item dissection-function
17352 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17353 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17354 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17355 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17356 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17357 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17358
17359 @end table
17360
17361 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17362 digests:
17363
17364 @example
17365 (standard-digest
17366 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17367 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17368 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17369 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17370 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17371 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17372 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17373 (subtype digest guess))
17374 @end example
17375
17376 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17377 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17378 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17379 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17380 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17381
17382 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17383 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17384 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17385 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17386 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17387 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17388 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17389 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17390 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17391 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17392 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17393 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17394
17395
17396 @node SOUP
17397 @subsection SOUP
17398 @cindex SOUP
17399 @cindex offline
17400
17401 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17402 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17403 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17404
17405 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17406 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17407 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17408 newsreaders.
17409
17410 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17411 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17412 that interested in doing things properly.
17413
17414 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17415 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17416 fiddly.
17417
17418 First some terminology:
17419
17420 @table @dfn
17421
17422 @item server
17423 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17424 get news and/or mail from.
17425
17426 @item home machine
17427 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17428 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17429
17430 @item packet
17431 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17432 of packets:
17433
17434 @table @dfn
17435 @item message packets
17436 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17437 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17438 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17439
17440 @item response packets
17441 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17442 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17443 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17444
17445 @end table
17446
17447 @end table
17448
17449
17450 @enumerate
17451
17452 @item
17453 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17454 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17455 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17456 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17457
17458 @item
17459 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17460
17461 @item
17462 You put the packet in your home directory.
17463
17464 @item
17465 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17466 the native or secondary server.
17467
17468 @item
17469 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17470 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17471
17472 @item
17473 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17474 packet.
17475
17476 @item
17477 You transfer this packet to the server.
17478
17479 @item
17480 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17481
17482 @item
17483 You then repeat until you die.
17484
17485 @end enumerate
17486
17487 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17488 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17489
17490 @menu
17491 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17492 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17493 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17494 @end menu
17495
17496
17497 @node SOUP Commands
17498 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17499
17500 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17501
17502 @table @kbd
17503 @item G s b
17504 @kindex G s b (Group)
17505 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17506 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17507 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17508 process/prefix convention.
17509
17510 @item G s w
17511 @kindex G s w (Group)
17512 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17513 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17514
17515 @item G s s
17516 @kindex G s s (Group)
17517 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17518 Send all replies from the replies packet
17519 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17520
17521 @item G s p
17522 @kindex G s p (Group)
17523 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17524 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17525
17526 @item G s r
17527 @kindex G s r (Group)
17528 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17529 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17530
17531 @item O s
17532 @kindex O s (Summary)
17533 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17534 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17535 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17536 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17537
17538 @end table
17539
17540
17541 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17542 thingies:
17543
17544 @table @code
17545
17546 @item gnus-soup-directory
17547 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17548 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17549 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17550
17551 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17552 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17553 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17554 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17555
17556 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17557 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17558 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17559 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17560
17561 @item gnus-soup-packer
17562 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17563 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17564 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17565
17566 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17567 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17568 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17569 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17570
17571 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17572 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17573 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17574
17575 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17576 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17577 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17578 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17579
17580 @end table
17581
17582
17583 @node SOUP Groups
17584 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17585 @cindex nnsoup
17586
17587 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17588 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17589 you can read them at leisure.
17590
17591 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17592
17593 @table @code
17594
17595 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17596 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17597 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17598 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17599
17600 @item nnsoup-directory
17601 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17602 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17603 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17604
17605 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17606 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17607 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17608 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17609
17610 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17611 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17612 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17613 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17614 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17615
17616 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17617 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17618 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17619 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17620
17621 @item nnsoup-active-file
17622 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17623 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17624 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17625 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17626 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17627
17628 @item nnsoup-packer
17629 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17630 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17631 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17632
17633 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17634 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17635 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17636 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17637
17638 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17639 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17640 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17641 @file{~/}.
17642
17643 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17644 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17645 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17646 @samp{Soupout}.
17647
17648 @item nnsoup-always-save
17649 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17650 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17651
17652 @end table
17653
17654
17655 @node SOUP Replies
17656 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17657
17658 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17659 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17660 more for that to happen.
17661
17662 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17663 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17664 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17665 @sc{soup} system.
17666
17667 In specific, this is what it does:
17668
17669 @lisp
17670 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17671 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17672 @end lisp
17673
17674 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17675 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17676 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17677
17678
17679 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17680 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17681 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17682 @cindex gateways
17683
17684 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17685 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17686 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17687
17688 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17689 used to post with.
17690
17691 Server variables:
17692
17693 @table @code
17694 @item nngateway-address
17695 @vindex nngateway-address
17696 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17697
17698 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17699 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17700 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17701 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17702 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17703 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17704 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17705 gateway address.
17706
17707 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17708 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17709 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17710
17711 @example
17712 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17713 @end example
17714
17715 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17716
17717 @example
17718 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17719 @end example
17720
17721 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17722
17723 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17724 @table @code
17725
17726 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17727 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17728 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17729
17730 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17731
17732 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17733 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17734 @code{nngateway-address}.
17735 @end table
17736
17737 @end table
17738
17739 Here's an example:
17740
17741 @lisp
17742 (setq gnus-post-method
17743 '(nngateway
17744 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17745 (nngateway-header-transformation
17746 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17747 @end lisp
17748
17749 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17750
17751 @lisp
17752 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17753 @end lisp
17754
17755
17756
17757 @node Combined Groups
17758 @section Combined Groups
17759
17760 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17761 groups.
17762
17763 @menu
17764 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17765 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17766 @end menu
17767
17768
17769 @node Virtual Groups
17770 @subsection Virtual Groups
17771 @cindex nnvirtual
17772 @cindex virtual groups
17773 @cindex merging groups
17774
17775 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17776 other groups.
17777
17778 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17779 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17780 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17781
17782 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17783 regexp to match component groups.
17784
17785 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17786 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17787 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17788 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17789 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17790 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17791 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17792 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17793
17794 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17795 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17796
17797 @lisp
17798 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17799 @end lisp
17800
17801 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17802 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17803
17804 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17805 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17806 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17807 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17808
17809 @example
17810 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17811 @end example
17812
17813 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17814 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17815 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17816
17817 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17818 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17819 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17820 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17821 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17822
17823 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17824 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17825 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17826
17827 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17828 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17829 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17830 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17831 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17832 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17833 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17834 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17835 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17836 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17837 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17838
17839 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17840 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17841 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17842 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17843 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17844 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17845 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17846
17847 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17848 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17849
17850 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17851 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17852 inherited.
17853
17854
17855 @node Kibozed Groups
17856 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17857 @cindex nnkiboze
17858 @cindex kibozing
17859
17860 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17861 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17862 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17863 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17864
17865 @kindex G k (Group)
17866 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17867 buffer.
17868
17869 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17870 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17871 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17872 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17873
17874 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17875 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17876 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17877
17878 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17879 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17880 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17881 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17882 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17883 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17884 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17885 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17886
17887 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17888 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17889 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17890 Stranger things have happened.
17891
17892 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17893 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17894
17895 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17896 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17897 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17898 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17899 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17900 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17901 component articles.
17902
17903 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17904 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17905
17906
17907 @node Email Based Diary
17908 @section Email Based Diary
17909 @cindex diary
17910 @cindex email based diary
17911 @cindex calendar
17912
17913 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17914 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17915 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17916 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17917 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17918 namely, as event reminders.
17919
17920 Here is a typical scenario:
17921
17922 @itemize @bullet
17923 @item
17924 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17925 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17926 @item
17927 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17928 @item
17929 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17930 @item
17931 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17932 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17933 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17934 @item
17935 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17936 of the night you're gonna have.
17937 @item
17938 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17939 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17940 @end itemize
17941
17942 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17943 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17944 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17945 explained in the sections below.
17946
17947 @menu
17948 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17949 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17950 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17951 @end menu
17952
17953
17954 @node The NNDiary Back End
17955 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17956 @cindex nndiary
17957 @cindex the nndiary back end
17958
17959 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17960 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17961 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17962 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17963 directory per group.
17964
17965 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17966 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17967 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17968 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17969
17970 @menu
17971 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17972 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17973 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17974 @end menu
17975
17976 @node Diary Messages
17977 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17978 @cindex nndiary messages
17979 @cindex nndiary mails
17980
17981 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17982 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17983 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17984 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17985 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17986 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17987 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17988
17989 @itemize @bullet
17990 @item
17991 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17992 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17993 (separated by a comma).
17994 @item
17995 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17996 @item
17997 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17998 @item
17999 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
18000 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
18001 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
18002 @item
18003 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
18004 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
18005 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
18006 @item
18007 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
18008 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
18009 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
18010 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
18011 list of available time zone values, see the variable
18012 @code{nndiary-headers}.
18013 @end itemize
18014
18015 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
18016 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
18017 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
18018 what to do then):
18019
18020 @example
18021 X-Diary-Minute: 0
18022 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
18023 X-Diary-Dom: 1
18024 X-Diary-Month: *
18025 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
18026 X-Diary-Dow: 1
18027 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
18028 @end example
18029
18030 @node Running NNDiary
18031 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
18032 @cindex running nndiary
18033 @cindex nndiary operation modes
18034
18035 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
18036 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
18037 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
18038 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
18039 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
18040 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
18041
18042 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
18043 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
18044 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
18045 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
18046 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
18047 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
18048 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
18049 mode.
18050
18051 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
18052 things to do:
18053
18054 @itemize @bullet
18055 @item
18056 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
18057 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
18058
18059 @lisp
18060 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
18061 @end lisp
18062 @item
18063 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
18064 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
18065 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
18066 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
18067 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
18068
18069 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
18070 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
18071
18072 @example
18073 :0 HD :
18074 * ^X-Diary
18075 .nndiary
18076 @end example
18077 @end itemize
18078
18079 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
18080 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
18081
18082 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
18083 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
18084 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
18085 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
18086 @end defvar
18087
18088 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
18089 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
18090 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
18091 @end defvar
18092
18093 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
18094 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
18095 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
18096
18097 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
18098 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
18099 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
18100 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
18101 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
18102
18103 @node Customizing NNDiary
18104 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
18105 @cindex customizing nndiary
18106 @cindex nndiary customization
18107
18108 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
18109 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
18110 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
18111 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
18112
18113 @defvar nndiary-reminders
18114 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
18115 appointments (e.g. 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
18116 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
18117 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
18118 mail.
18119 @end defvar
18120
18121 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
18122 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
18123 default).
18124 @end defvar
18125
18126
18127 @node The Gnus Diary Library
18128 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
18129 @cindex gnus-diary
18130 @cindex the gnus diary library
18131
18132 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
18133 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
18134 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
18135 useful things for you.
18136
18137 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
18138
18139 @lisp
18140 (require 'gnus-diary)
18141 @end lisp
18142
18143 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
18144 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
18145 (sorry if you used them before).
18146
18147
18148 @menu
18149 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
18150 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
18151 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
18152 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
18153 @end menu
18154
18155 @node Diary Summary Line Format
18156 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
18157 @cindex diary summary buffer line
18158 @cindex diary summary line format
18159
18160 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
18161 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
18162 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
18163 see the event's date.
18164
18165 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
18166 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
18167 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
18168 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximative remaining time until the
18169 next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
18170
18171 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
18172 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
18173 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
18174
18175 @example
18176 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
18177 @end example
18178
18179 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18180 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
18181
18182 @lisp
18183 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18184 @end lisp
18185
18186 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18187 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18188 with the following user options:
18189
18190 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18191 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18192 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18193 diary groups'parameters.
18194 @end defvar
18195
18196 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18197 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18198 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18199 @end defvar
18200
18201 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18202 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18203 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18204 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18205 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18206 @end defvar
18207
18208 @node Diary Articles Sorting
18209 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18210 @cindex diary articles sorting
18211 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
18212 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18213 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18214 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
18215
18216 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18217 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18218 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18219 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18220 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18221
18222 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18223 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18224 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18225 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18226 Parameters}).
18227
18228 @node Diary Headers Generation
18229 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18230 @cindex diary headers generation
18231 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18232
18233 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18234 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18235 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18236 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18237 needed.
18238
18239 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18240 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18241 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c D c} in @code{message-mode}
18242 and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the process of converting
18243 a usual mail to a diary one.
18244
18245 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18246 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18247 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18248 instance.
18249
18250 @node Diary Group Parameters
18251 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18252 @cindex diary group parameters
18253
18254 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18255 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18256 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18257 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18258 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18259 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18260 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18261 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18262
18263 @node Sending or Not Sending
18264 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18265
18266 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18267 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18268
18269 @itemize @bullet
18270 @item
18271 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18272 messsages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18273 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18274 sending the diary message to them as well.
18275 @item
18276 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18277 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18278 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18279 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18280 @end itemize
18281
18282 @node Gnus Unplugged
18283 @section Gnus Unplugged
18284 @cindex offline
18285 @cindex unplugged
18286 @cindex agent
18287 @cindex Gnus agent
18288 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18289
18290 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18291 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18292 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18293 read news. Believe it or not.
18294
18295 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18296 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18297 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18298 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18299 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18300
18301 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18302 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18303 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18304 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18305 reading news on a machine.
18306
18307 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18308 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
18309
18310 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18311
18312 @menu
18313 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18314 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18315 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18316 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18317 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18318 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18319 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18320 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18321 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18322 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18323 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18324 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18325 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18326 @end menu
18327
18328
18329 @node Agent Basics
18330 @subsection Agent Basics
18331
18332 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18333
18334 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18335 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18336 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18337 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18338
18339 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18340 connected to the net continuously.
18341
18342 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18343 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18344
18345 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18346 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18347 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18348 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18349 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18350
18351 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18352 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18353 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18354 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18355 they're kinda like plugged always).
18356
18357 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18358 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18359 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18360 the culprit.
18361
18362 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18363 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18364 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18365 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18366 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18367
18368 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18369
18370 @itemize @bullet
18371
18372 @item
18373 @findex gnus-unplugged
18374 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18375 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18376 already fetched while in this mode.
18377
18378 @item
18379 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18380 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18381 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18382 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18383 Source Specifiers}).
18384
18385 @item
18386 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18387 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18388 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18389 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18390 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18391
18392 @item
18393 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18394 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18395 then you read the news offline.
18396
18397 @item
18398 And then you go to step 2.
18399 @end itemize
18400
18401 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18402 the Agent.
18403
18404 @itemize @bullet
18405
18406 @item
18407 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18408 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18409 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18410 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18411 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18412 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18413 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
18414 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
18415
18416 @item
18417 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18418 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18419 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18420 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18421
18422 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18423 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18424 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18425 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18426 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18427 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18428 configure them.
18429
18430 @item
18431 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18432 @end itemize
18433
18434
18435 @node Agent Categories
18436 @subsection Agent Categories
18437
18438 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18439 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18440 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18441 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18442 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18443 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18444 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18445
18446 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18447 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18448 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18449 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18450 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18451
18452 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18453 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18454 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18455 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18456 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18457 sink.
18458
18459 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18460 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18461 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18462 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18463 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18464 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18465 your settings.
18466
18467 @menu
18468 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18469 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18470 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18471 @end menu
18472
18473
18474 @node Category Syntax
18475 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18476
18477 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18478 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18479 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18480 listed below.
18481
18482 @cindex Agent Parameters
18483 @table @code
18484 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
18485 The name of the category.
18486
18487 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
18488 The list of groups that are in this category.
18489
18490 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
18491 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18492 are eligible for downloading; and
18493
18494 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
18495 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18496 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18497 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18498
18499 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
18500 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18501 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18502 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18503 only groups that should not be expired.
18504
18505 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
18506 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18507 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18508
18509 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
18510 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18511
18512 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
18513 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18514
18515 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
18516 an integer that overrides the value of
18517 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18518
18519 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
18520 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18521
18522 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
18523 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
18524 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
18525 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
18526 @c all other symbols disable them.
18527
18528 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
18529 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18530 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
18531 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
18532 all other symbols enable them.
18533 @end table
18534
18535 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18536 created.
18537
18538 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18539 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18540 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18541 category.
18542
18543 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18544 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18545 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18546 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18547
18548 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18549 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18550 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18551
18552 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18553 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18554 operators sprinkled in between.
18555
18556 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18557
18558 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18559 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18560
18561 @lisp
18562 short
18563 @end lisp
18564
18565 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18566 short (for some value of ``short'').
18567
18568 Here's a more complex predicate:
18569
18570 @lisp
18571 (or high
18572 (and
18573 (not low)
18574 (not long)))
18575 @end lisp
18576
18577 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18578 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18579 drift.
18580
18581 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18582 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18583 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18584
18585 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18586 you want to do, you can write your own.
18587
18588 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18589 bound to the value determined by calling
18590 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18591 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18592 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18593 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18594 predicate to individual groups.
18595
18596 @table @code
18597 @item short
18598 True iff the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18599 lines; default 100.
18600
18601 @item long
18602 True iff the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18603 lines; default 200.
18604
18605 @item low
18606 True iff the article has a download score less than
18607 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18608
18609 @item high
18610 True iff the article has a download score greater than
18611 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18612
18613 @item spam
18614 True iff the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18615 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18616 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18617
18618 @item true
18619 Always true.
18620
18621 @item false
18622 Always false.
18623 @end table
18624
18625 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18626 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18627 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18628 useful values.
18629
18630 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18631 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
18632 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18633 something along the lines of the following:
18634
18635 @lisp
18636 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18637 "Say whether an article is old."
18638 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18639 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18640 @end lisp
18641
18642 with the predicate then defined as:
18643
18644 @lisp
18645 (not my-article-old-p)
18646 @end lisp
18647
18648 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18649 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18650 wherever.
18651
18652 @lisp
18653 (require 'gnus-agent)
18654 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18655 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18656 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18657 @end lisp
18658
18659 and simply specify your predicate as:
18660
18661 @lisp
18662 (not old)
18663 @end lisp
18664
18665 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18666 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18667 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18668 just don't give a damn.
18669
18670 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18671 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18672 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18673 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18674 parameters like so:
18675
18676 @lisp
18677 (agent-predicate . short)
18678 @end lisp
18679
18680 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18681 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18682 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18683
18684 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18685
18686 @lisp
18687 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18688 @end lisp
18689
18690 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18691 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18692 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18693
18694
18695 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18696 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18697 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18698 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18699 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18700 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18701
18702 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18703 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18704 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18705 if it's to be specific to that group.
18706
18707 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18708 three forms:
18709
18710 @enumerate
18711 @item
18712 Score rule
18713
18714 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18715 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18716
18717 example:
18718
18719 @itemize @bullet
18720 @item
18721 Category specification
18722
18723 @lisp
18724 (("from"
18725 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18726 ("lines"
18727 (500 -100 nil <)))
18728 @end lisp
18729
18730 @item
18731 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18732
18733 @lisp
18734 (agent-score ("from"
18735 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18736 ("lines"
18737 (500 -100 nil <)))
18738 @end lisp
18739
18740 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18741 @end itemize
18742
18743 @item
18744 Agent score file
18745
18746 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18747 keywords stated above.
18748
18749 example:
18750
18751 @itemize @bullet
18752 @item
18753 Category specification
18754
18755 @lisp
18756 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18757 @end lisp
18758
18759 or perhaps
18760
18761 @lisp
18762 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18763 @end lisp
18764
18765 @item
18766 Group Parameter specification
18767
18768 @lisp
18769 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18770 @end lisp
18771
18772 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18773 about parenthesis?
18774 @end itemize
18775
18776 @item
18777 Use @code{normal} score files
18778
18779 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18780 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18781 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18782 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18783
18784 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18785 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18786 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18787 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18788
18789 @itemize @bullet
18790 @item
18791 Category Specification
18792
18793 @lisp
18794 file
18795 @end lisp
18796
18797 @item
18798 Group Parameter specification
18799
18800 @lisp
18801 (agent-score . file)
18802 @end lisp
18803 @end itemize
18804 @end enumerate
18805
18806 @node Category Buffer
18807 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18808
18809 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18810 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18811 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18812
18813 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18814
18815 @table @kbd
18816 @item q
18817 @kindex q (Category)
18818 @findex gnus-category-exit
18819 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18820
18821 @item e
18822 @kindex e (Category)
18823 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18824 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18825 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18826
18827 @item k
18828 @kindex k (Category)
18829 @findex gnus-category-kill
18830 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18831
18832 @item c
18833 @kindex c (Category)
18834 @findex gnus-category-copy
18835 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18836
18837 @item a
18838 @kindex a (Category)
18839 @findex gnus-category-add
18840 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18841
18842 @item p
18843 @kindex p (Category)
18844 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18845 Edit the predicate of the current category
18846 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18847
18848 @item g
18849 @kindex g (Category)
18850 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18851 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18852 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18853
18854 @item s
18855 @kindex s (Category)
18856 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18857 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18858 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18859
18860 @item l
18861 @kindex l (Category)
18862 @findex gnus-category-list
18863 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18864 @end table
18865
18866
18867 @node Category Variables
18868 @subsubsection Category Variables
18869
18870 @table @code
18871 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18872 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18873 Hook run in category buffers.
18874
18875 @item gnus-category-line-format
18876 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18877 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18878 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18879
18880 @table @samp
18881 @item c
18882 The name of the category.
18883
18884 @item g
18885 The number of groups in the category.
18886 @end table
18887
18888 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18889 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18890 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18891
18892 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18893 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18894 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18895
18896 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18897 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18898 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18899
18900 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18901 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18902 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18903 0.
18904
18905 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18906 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18907 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18908 0.
18909
18910 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18911 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18912 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18913 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18914 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18915 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18916 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18917 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18918 read.
18919 Default 7.
18920
18921 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18922 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18923 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18924 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18925 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18926 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18927 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18928
18929 @end table
18930
18931
18932 @node Agent Commands
18933 @subsection Agent Commands
18934 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18935 @kindex J j (Agent)
18936
18937 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18938 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18939 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18940
18941
18942 @menu
18943 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18944 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18945 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18946 @end menu
18947
18948
18949
18950
18951 @node Group Agent Commands
18952 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18953
18954 @table @kbd
18955 @item J u
18956 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18957 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18958 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18959 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18960
18961 @item J c
18962 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18963 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18964 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18965
18966 @item J s
18967 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18968 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18969 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18970 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18971
18972 @item J S
18973 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18974 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18975 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18976 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18977
18978 @item J a
18979 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18980 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18981 Add the current group to an Agent category
18982 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18983 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18984
18985 @item J r
18986 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18987 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18988 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18989 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18990 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18991
18992 @item J Y
18993 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18994 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18995 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18996
18997
18998 @end table
18999
19000
19001 @node Summary Agent Commands
19002 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
19003
19004 @table @kbd
19005 @item J #
19006 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
19007 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
19008 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
19009
19010 @item J M-#
19011 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
19012 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
19013 Remove the downloading mark from the article
19014 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
19015
19016 @cindex %
19017 @item @@
19018 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
19019 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
19020 Toggle whether to download the article
19021 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
19022 default.
19023
19024 @item J c
19025 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
19026 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
19027 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
19028
19029 @item J S
19030 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
19031 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
19032 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
19033 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
19034
19035 @item J s
19036 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
19037 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
19038 Download all processable articles in this group.
19039 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
19040
19041 @item J u
19042 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
19043 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
19044 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
19045 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
19046
19047 @end table
19048
19049
19050 @node Server Agent Commands
19051 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
19052
19053 @table @kbd
19054 @item J a
19055 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
19056 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
19057 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
19058 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
19059
19060 @item J r
19061 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
19062 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
19063 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
19064 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
19065
19066 @end table
19067
19068
19069 @node Agent Visuals
19070 @subsection Agent Visuals
19071
19072 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
19073 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
19074 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
19075 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
19076 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
19077 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
19078 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
19079 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
19080 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
19081 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
19082
19083 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
19084 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
19085 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
19086 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
19087 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
19088 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
19089 the download status of each article so that you always know which
19090 articles will be available when unplugged.
19091
19092 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
19093 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
19094 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
19095 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
19096 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
19097 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
19098 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
19099 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
19100
19101 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
19102 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
19103 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
19104 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
19105 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
19106 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
19107 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
19108 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
19109 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
19110
19111 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
19112 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
19113 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
19114 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
19115 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
19116
19117 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
19118 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
19119 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
19120 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
19121 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
19122 disable the undownload faces by customizing
19123 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
19124 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
19125 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
19126 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
19127 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
19128 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
19129 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
19130
19131 @node Agent as Cache
19132 @subsection Agent as Cache
19133
19134 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
19135 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
19136 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
19137 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
19138 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
19139 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
19140 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
19141 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
19142 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
19143
19144 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
19145 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
19146 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
19147 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
19148 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
19149
19150 @node Agent Expiry
19151 @subsection Agent Expiry
19152
19153 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
19154 @findex gnus-agent-expire
19155 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
19156 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
19157 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
19158 @cindex agent expiry
19159 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
19160 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
19161
19162 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
19163 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
19164 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
19165 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
19166 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
19167 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
19168 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
19169 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
19170
19171 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
19172 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
19173 synchronized with the group.
19174
19175 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
19176 prevent expiration in selected groups.
19177
19178 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
19179 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
19180 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
19181 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19182 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19183 be kept indefinitely.
19184
19185 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19186 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19187 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19188 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
19189
19190 @node Agent Regeneration
19191 @subsection Agent Regeneration
19192
19193 @cindex agent regeneration
19194 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19195 @cindex regeneration
19196
19197 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19198 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19199 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19200 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19201 internal inconsistencies.
19202
19203 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19204 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19205 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19206 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19207 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19208 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
19209
19210 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19211 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19212 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19213 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19214 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19215 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
19216
19217 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19218 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19219 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19220 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19221 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19222 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19223 agent as unread.
19224
19225 @node Agent and IMAP
19226 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19227
19228 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19229 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19230 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19231 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19232
19233 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
19234 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
19235 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
19236 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
19237
19238 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
19239 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
19240 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
19241 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19242
19243 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19244 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19245 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19246 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19247 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19248 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19249
19250 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19251 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19252 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19253 in the group buffer.
19254
19255 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19256 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19257
19258 @itemize @bullet
19259
19260 @item
19261 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19262
19263 @item
19264 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19265
19266 @end itemize
19267
19268 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19269 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
19270 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19271 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
19272 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19273 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19274 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19275 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19276
19277
19278 @node Outgoing Messages
19279 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19280
19281 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
19282 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
19283 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19284
19285 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
19286 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
19287 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
19288 messages in the draft group.
19289
19290
19291
19292 @node Agent Variables
19293 @subsection Agent Variables
19294
19295 @table @code
19296 @item gnus-agent-directory
19297 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19298 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19299 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19300
19301 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19302 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19303 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19304 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19305 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19306 by default.
19307
19308 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19309 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19310 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19311
19312 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19313 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19314 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19315
19316 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19317 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19318 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19319
19320 @item gnus-agent-cache
19321 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19322 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19323 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19324 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19325
19326 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19327 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19328 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19329 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19330 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19331 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19332 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19333 online status.
19334
19335 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19336 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19337 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19338 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19339 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19340 read. The default is @code{t}.
19341
19342 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19343 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19344 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19345 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19346 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19347 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19348 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19349 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19350 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19351 over and over again.
19352
19353 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19354 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19355 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19356 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19357 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19358 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19359 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19360 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19361 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19362 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19363 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
19364 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19365 see any cycling.
19366
19367 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19368 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19369 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19370 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19371 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19372 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19373 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19374 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19375 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19376
19377 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19378 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19379 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19380 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19381 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19382 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19383
19384 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19385 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19386 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19387 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19388 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19389
19390 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19391 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19392 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19393 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19394 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19395 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19396 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19397 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19398 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19399 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19400 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
19401
19402 @end table
19403
19404
19405 @node Example Setup
19406 @subsection Example Setup
19407
19408 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19409 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19410 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19411
19412 @lisp
19413 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19414 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19415 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19416
19417 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19418 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19419 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19420
19421 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19422 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19423
19424 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19425 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19426 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19427 @end lisp
19428
19429 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19430 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19431 gnus}.
19432
19433 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19434 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19435 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19436 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19437 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19438 once.
19439
19440 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19441 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19442 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19443 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19444 back all the killed groups.)
19445
19446 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19447 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19448 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19449
19450
19451 @node Batching Agents
19452 @subsection Batching Agents
19453 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19454
19455 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19456 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19457 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19458
19459 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19460 following incantation:
19461
19462 @example
19463 #!/bin/sh
19464 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19465 @end example
19466
19467
19468 @node Agent Caveats
19469 @subsection Agent Caveats
19470
19471 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19472 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19473 may ask:
19474
19475 @table @dfn
19476 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19477
19478 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19479 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19480 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19481
19482 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19483 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19484
19485 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19486
19487 @end table
19488
19489 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19490 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19491 locally stored articles.
19492
19493
19494 @node Scoring
19495 @chapter Scoring
19496 @cindex scoring
19497
19498 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19499 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19500 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19501 attention!
19502
19503 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19504 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19505 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19506 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19507 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19508
19509 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19510 before generating the summary buffer.
19511
19512 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19513 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19514 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19515
19516 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19517 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19518 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19519 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19520
19521 @menu
19522 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19523 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19524 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19525 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19526 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19527 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19528 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19529 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19530 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19531 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19532 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19533 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19534 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19535 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19536 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
19537 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19538 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19539 @end menu
19540
19541
19542 @node Summary Score Commands
19543 @section Summary Score Commands
19544 @cindex score commands
19545
19546 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19547 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19548 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19549 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19550 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19551
19552 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19553 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19554 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19555 score file the current one.
19556
19557 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19558
19559 @table @kbd
19560
19561 @item V s
19562 @kindex V s (Summary)
19563 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19564 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19565
19566 @item V S
19567 @kindex V S (Summary)
19568 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19569 Display the score of the current article
19570 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19571
19572 @item V t
19573 @kindex V t (Summary)
19574 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19575 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19576 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19577 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19578 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19579 score file and edit it.
19580
19581 @item V w
19582 @kindex V w (Summary)
19583 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19584 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19585
19586 @item V R
19587 @kindex V R (Summary)
19588 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19589 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19590 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19591 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19592 effect you're having.
19593
19594 @item V c
19595 @kindex V c (Summary)
19596 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19597 Make a different score file the current
19598 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19599
19600 @item V e
19601 @kindex V e (Summary)
19602 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19603 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19604 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19605 File Editing}).
19606
19607 @item V f
19608 @kindex V f (Summary)
19609 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19610 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19611 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19612
19613 @item V F
19614 @kindex V F (Summary)
19615 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19616 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19617 after editing score files.
19618
19619 @item V C
19620 @kindex V C (Summary)
19621 @findex gnus-score-customize
19622 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19623 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19624
19625 @end table
19626
19627 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19628
19629 @table @kbd
19630
19631 @item V m
19632 @kindex V m (Summary)
19633 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19634 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19635 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19636
19637 @item V x
19638 @kindex V x (Summary)
19639 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19640 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19641 expunge all articles below this score
19642 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19643 @end table
19644
19645 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19646 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19647 them.)
19648
19649 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19650 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19651
19652 @enumerate
19653 @item
19654 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19655 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19656 @item
19657 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19658 keys are available:
19659 @table @kbd
19660
19661 @item a
19662 Score on the author name.
19663
19664 @item s
19665 Score on the subject line.
19666
19667 @item x
19668 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19669
19670 @item r
19671 Score on the @code{References} line.
19672
19673 @item d
19674 Score on the date.
19675
19676 @item l
19677 Score on the number of lines.
19678
19679 @item i
19680 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19681
19682 @item e
19683 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19684 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19685
19686 @item f
19687 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19688 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19689 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19690
19691 @item b
19692 Score on the body.
19693
19694 @item h
19695 Score on the head.
19696
19697 @item t
19698 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19699 files.)
19700
19701 @end table
19702
19703 @item
19704 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19705 what headers you are scoring on.
19706
19707 @table @code
19708
19709 @item strings
19710
19711 @table @kbd
19712
19713 @item e
19714 Exact matching.
19715
19716 @item s
19717 Substring matching.
19718
19719 @item f
19720 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19721
19722 @item r
19723 Regexp matching
19724 @end table
19725
19726 @item date
19727 @table @kbd
19728
19729 @item b
19730 Before date.
19731
19732 @item a
19733 After date.
19734
19735 @item n
19736 This date.
19737 @end table
19738
19739 @item number
19740 @table @kbd
19741
19742 @item <
19743 Less than number.
19744
19745 @item =
19746 Equal to number.
19747
19748 @item >
19749 Greater than number.
19750 @end table
19751 @end table
19752
19753 @item
19754 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19755 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19756 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19757 file.
19758 @table @kbd
19759
19760 @item t
19761 Temporary score entry.
19762
19763 @item p
19764 Permanent score entry.
19765
19766 @item i
19767 Immediately scoring.
19768 @end table
19769
19770 @item
19771 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19772 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19773 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19774
19775 @end enumerate
19776
19777 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19778 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19779 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19780 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19781
19782 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19783 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19784 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19785 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19786 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19787
19788 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19789 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19790 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19791 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19792 current score file.
19793
19794 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19795 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19796 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19797
19798
19799 @node Group Score Commands
19800 @section Group Score Commands
19801 @cindex group score commands
19802
19803 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19804
19805 @table @kbd
19806
19807 @item W f
19808 @kindex W f (Group)
19809 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19810 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19811 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19812 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19813
19814 @end table
19815
19816 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19817
19818 @findex gnus-batch-score
19819 @cindex batch scoring
19820 @example
19821 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19822 @end example
19823
19824
19825 @node Score Variables
19826 @section Score Variables
19827 @cindex score variables
19828
19829 @table @code
19830
19831 @item gnus-use-scoring
19832 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19833 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19834 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19835
19836 @item gnus-kill-killed
19837 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19838 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19839 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19840 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19841 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19842 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19843 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19844
19845 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19846 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19847 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19848 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19849 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19850
19851 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19852 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19853 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19854 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19855
19856 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19857 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19858 @cindex score cache
19859 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19860 score files. However, if this might make your Emacs grow big and
19861 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19862 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19863 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19864 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19865 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19866 be cached.
19867
19868 @item gnus-save-score
19869 @vindex gnus-save-score
19870 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19871 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19872 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19873
19874 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19875 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19876 across group visits.
19877
19878 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19879 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19880 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19881 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19882 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19883 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19884 manually entered data.
19885
19886 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19887 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19888 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19889
19890 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19891 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19892 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19893 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19894 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19895 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19896
19897 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19898 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19899 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19900 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19901
19902 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19903 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19904 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19905 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19906
19907 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19908 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19909 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19910 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19911
19912 Predefined functions available are:
19913 @table @code
19914
19915 @item gnus-score-find-single
19916 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19917 Only apply the group's own score file.
19918
19919 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19920 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19921 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19922 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19923 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19924 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19925 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19926 then a regexp match is done.
19927
19928 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19929 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19930
19931 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19932 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19933 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19934 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19935
19936 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19937 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19938 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19939 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19940 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19941 server.
19942
19943 @end table
19944 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19945 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19946 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19947 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19948 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19949 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19950 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19951 Phu.
19952
19953 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19954 overall score file, you could use the value
19955 @example
19956 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19957 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19958 @end example
19959
19960 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19961 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19962 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19963 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19964 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19965
19966 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19967 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19968 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19969 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19970 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19971 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19972 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19973 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19974
19975 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19976 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19977 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19978
19979 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19980 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19981 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19982 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19983 threading---according to the current value of
19984 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19985 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19986 simplified in this manner.
19987
19988 @end table
19989
19990
19991 @node Score File Format
19992 @section Score File Format
19993 @cindex score file format
19994
19995 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19996 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19997 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19998
19999 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
20000
20001 @lisp
20002 (("from"
20003 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
20004 ("Per Abrahamsen")
20005 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
20006 ("subject"
20007 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
20008 ("xref"
20009 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
20010 ("lines"
20011 (2 -100 nil <))
20012 (mark 0)
20013 (expunge -1000)
20014 (mark-and-expunge -10)
20015 (read-only nil)
20016 (orphan -10)
20017 (adapt t)
20018 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
20019 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
20020 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
20021 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
20022 (eval (ding)))
20023 @end lisp
20024
20025 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
20026 Scoring}, for a different approach.
20027
20028 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
20029 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
20030 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
20031
20032 Six keys are supported by this alist:
20033
20034 @table @code
20035
20036 @item STRING
20037 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
20038 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
20039 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
20040 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
20041 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
20042 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
20043 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
20044 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
20045 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
20046 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
20047 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
20048 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
20049 to articles that matches these score entries.
20050
20051 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
20052 score entry has one to four elements.
20053 @enumerate
20054
20055 @item
20056 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
20057 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
20058 integer.
20059
20060 @item
20061 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
20062 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
20063 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
20064 is successful. If this element is not present, the
20065 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
20066 instead. This is 1000 by default.
20067
20068 @item
20069 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
20070 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
20071 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
20072 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
20073 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
20074
20075 @item
20076 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
20077 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
20078 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
20079 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
20080 @table @dfn
20081
20082 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
20083 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
20084 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
20085 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
20086 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
20087 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
20088 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
20089 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
20090 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
20091 instead, if you feel like.
20092
20093 @item Extra
20094 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
20095 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
20096 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
20097 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
20098 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
20099 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
20100 overviews:
20101
20102 @lisp
20103 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
20104 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
20105 @end lisp
20106
20107 @item Lines, Chars
20108 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
20109 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
20110
20111 These predicates are true if
20112
20113 @example
20114 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
20115 @end example
20116
20117 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
20118 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
20119 following form:
20120
20121 @lisp
20122 (< header-value 4)
20123 @end lisp
20124
20125 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
20126 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
20127 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
20128 it's not. I think.)
20129
20130 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
20131 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
20132 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
20133 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
20134
20135 @item Date
20136 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20137 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20138 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20139 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20140 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20141 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20142 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
20143
20144 @cindex ISO8601
20145 @cindex date
20146 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20147 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20148 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20149 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20150 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20151 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20152 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20153 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20154 whole family, eh?)
20155
20156 @item Head, Body, All
20157 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
20158 header uses.
20159
20160 @item Followup
20161 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20162 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20163 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
20164 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
20165 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20166 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20167 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20168 files.)
20169
20170 @item Thread
20171 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20172 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20173 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20174 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20175 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20176 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20177 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20178 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20179 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20180 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20181 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20182 @end table
20183 @end enumerate
20184
20185 @cindex score file atoms
20186 @item mark
20187 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20188 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20189
20190 @item expunge
20191 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20192 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20193
20194 @item mark-and-expunge
20195 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20196 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20197 summary buffer.
20198
20199 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20200 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20201 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20202 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20203 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20204
20205 @item files
20206 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20207 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20208 this one was.
20209
20210 @item exclude-files
20211 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20212 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20213 other.
20214
20215 @item eval
20216 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
20217 ignored when handling global score files.
20218
20219 @item read-only
20220 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20221 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20222 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20223 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20224
20225 @item orphan
20226 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20227 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20228 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20229 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20230
20231 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20232
20233 @example
20234 (orphan -500)
20235 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20236 @end example
20237
20238 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20239 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20240 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
20241 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20242 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20243
20244 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20245 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20246 scoring rules exist.
20247
20248 @item adapt
20249 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20250 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20251 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20252 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20253 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20254 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20255 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20256 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20257 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20258 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20259 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20260 it.
20261
20262 @item adapt-file
20263 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20264 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20265 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20266 file for a number of groups.
20267
20268 @item local
20269 @cindex local variables
20270 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20271 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20272 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20273 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20274 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20275 be evaluated.
20276 @end table
20277
20278
20279 @node Score File Editing
20280 @section Score File Editing
20281
20282 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20283 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20284 with a mode for that.
20285
20286 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20287 additional commands:
20288
20289 @table @kbd
20290
20291 @item C-c C-c
20292 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20293 @findex gnus-score-edit-done
20294 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20295 (@code{gnus-score-edit-done}).
20296
20297 @item C-c C-d
20298 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20299 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20300 Insert the current date in numerical format
20301 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20302 you were wondering.
20303
20304 @item C-c C-p
20305 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20306 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20307 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20308 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20309 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20310 you.
20311
20312 @end table
20313
20314 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20315
20316 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20317 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20318
20319 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20320 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20321
20322
20323 @node Adaptive Scoring
20324 @section Adaptive Scoring
20325 @cindex adaptive scoring
20326
20327 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20328 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20329 stupidity, to be precise.
20330
20331 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20332 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20333 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20334 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20335 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20336 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20337 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20338 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20339 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20340
20341 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20342 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20343 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20344 might look something like this:
20345
20346 @lisp
20347 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20348 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20349 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20350 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20351 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20352 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20353 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20354 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20355 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20356 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20357 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20358 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20359 @end lisp
20360
20361 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20362 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20363 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20364 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20365 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20366 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20367 entries.
20368
20369 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20370 will be applied to each article.
20371
20372 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20373 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20374 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20375 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20376
20377 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20378 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20379 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20380 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20381
20382 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20383 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20384 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20385 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20386
20387 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20388 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20389 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20390 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20391 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20392 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20393
20394 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20395 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20396 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20397
20398 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20399 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20400 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20401
20402 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20403 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20404 let you use different rules in different groups.
20405
20406 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20407 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20408 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20409 is @file{ADAPT}.
20410
20411 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20412 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20413 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20414 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20415 the length of the match is less than
20416 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20417 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20418 this problem.
20419
20420 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20421 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20422 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20423 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20424 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20425
20426 @lisp
20427 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20428 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20429 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20430 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20431 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20432 @end lisp
20433
20434 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20435 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20436 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20437 score with 30 points.
20438
20439 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20440 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20441 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20442 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20443 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20444
20445 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20446 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20447 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20448 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20449 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20450
20451 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20452 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20453 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20454 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20455
20456 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20457 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20458 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20459 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20460
20461 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20462 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20463 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20464 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20465 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20466
20467 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20468 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20469 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20470
20471 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20472 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20473 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20474 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20475
20476
20477 @node Home Score File
20478 @section Home Score File
20479
20480 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20481 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20482 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20483 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20484
20485 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20486 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20487 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20488
20489 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20490 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20491 be:
20492
20493 @enumerate
20494 @item
20495 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20496 groups.
20497
20498 @item
20499 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20500 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20501 parameter.
20502
20503 @item
20504 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20505
20506 @enumerate
20507 @item
20508 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20509 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20510
20511 @item
20512 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20513 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20514 name of the group as the parameter.
20515
20516 @item
20517 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20518 @end enumerate
20519
20520 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20521 for matches.
20522
20523 @end enumerate
20524
20525 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20526
20527 @lisp
20528 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20529 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20530 @end lisp
20531
20532 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20533 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20534
20535 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20536 @lisp
20537 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20538 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20539 @end lisp
20540
20541 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20542 Other functions include
20543
20544 @table @code
20545 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20546 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20547 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20548 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20549
20550 @end table
20551
20552 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20553 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20554 their own home score files:
20555
20556 @lisp
20557 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20558 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20559 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20560 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20561 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20562 @end lisp
20563
20564 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20565 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20566 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20567 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20568 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20569
20570 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20571 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20572 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20573 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20574 precedence over this variable.
20575
20576
20577 @node Followups To Yourself
20578 @section Followups To Yourself
20579
20580 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20581 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20582 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20583 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20584 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20585 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20586
20587 @table @code
20588
20589 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20590 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20591 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20592 article.
20593
20594 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20595 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20596 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20597 your own article.
20598 @end table
20599
20600 @vindex message-sent-hook
20601 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20602 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20603 @lisp
20604 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20605 @end lisp
20606
20607
20608 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20609 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20610 mine:
20611
20612 @example
20613 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20614 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20615 @end example
20616
20617 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20618 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20619 myself:
20620
20621 @lisp
20622 ("references"
20623 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20624 1000 nil r))
20625 @end lisp
20626
20627 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20628 is system-dependent.
20629
20630
20631 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20632 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20633 @cindex scoring on other headers
20634
20635 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20636 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20637 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20638 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20639 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20640
20641 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
20642 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20643 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20644 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20645 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20646
20647 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20648
20649 @lisp
20650 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20651 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20652 @end lisp
20653
20654 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20655 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20656 time if you have much mail.
20657
20658 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20659 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20660
20661 See? Simple.
20662
20663
20664 @node Scoring Tips
20665 @section Scoring Tips
20666 @cindex scoring tips
20667
20668 @table @dfn
20669
20670 @item Crossposts
20671 @cindex crossposts
20672 @cindex scoring crossposts
20673 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20674 the @code{Xref} header.
20675 @lisp
20676 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20677 @end lisp
20678
20679 @item Multiple crossposts
20680 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20681 more than, say, 3 groups:
20682 @lisp
20683 ("xref"
20684 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20685 -1000 nil r))
20686 @end lisp
20687
20688 @item Matching on the body
20689 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20690 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20691 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20692 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20693 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20694 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20695 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20696 the matches.
20697
20698 @item Marking as read
20699 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20700 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20701 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20702 @lisp
20703 ((mark -100))
20704 @end lisp
20705 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20706
20707 @item Negated character classes
20708 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20709 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20710 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20711 @end table
20712
20713
20714 @node Reverse Scoring
20715 @section Reverse Scoring
20716 @cindex reverse scoring
20717
20718 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20719 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20720 like this in your score file:
20721
20722 @lisp
20723 (("subject"
20724 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20725 (mark 1)
20726 (expunge 1))
20727 @end lisp
20728
20729 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20730 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20731
20732
20733 @node Global Score Files
20734 @section Global Score Files
20735 @cindex global score files
20736
20737 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20738 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20739 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20740
20741 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20742 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20743 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20744
20745 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20746 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20747 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20748 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20749 files are applicable to which group.
20750
20751 To use the score file
20752 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20753 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20754 say this:
20755
20756 @lisp
20757 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20758 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20759 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20760 @end lisp
20761
20762 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20763 @noindent
20764 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20765 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20766 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20767 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20768
20769 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20770 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20771
20772 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20773 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20774 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20775 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20776 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20777 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20778
20779 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20780 head:
20781
20782 @itemize @bullet
20783
20784 @item
20785 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20786 @item
20787 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20788 @item
20789 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20790 @item
20791 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20792 lowered out of existence.
20793 @item
20794 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20795 articles completely.
20796
20797 @item
20798 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20799 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20800 old articles for a long time.
20801 @end itemize
20802
20803 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20804 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20805 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20806 holding our breath yet?
20807
20808
20809 @node Kill Files
20810 @section Kill Files
20811 @cindex kill files
20812
20813 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20814 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20815 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20816
20817 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20818 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20819 files into score files.
20820
20821 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20822 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20823 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20824 that isn't a very good idea.
20825
20826 Normal kill files look like this:
20827
20828 @lisp
20829 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20830 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20831 (gnus-expunge "X")
20832 @end lisp
20833
20834 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20835 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20836
20837 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20838 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20839 interpreting it.
20840
20841 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20842
20843 @table @kbd
20844
20845 @item M-k
20846 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20847 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20848 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20849
20850 @item M-K
20851 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20852 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20853 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20854 @end table
20855
20856 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20857
20858 @table @kbd
20859
20860 @item M-k
20861 @kindex M-k (Group)
20862 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20863 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20864
20865 @item M-K
20866 @kindex M-K (Group)
20867 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20868 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20869 @end table
20870
20871 Kill file variables:
20872
20873 @table @code
20874 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20875 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20876 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20877 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20878 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20879 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20880 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20881
20882 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20883 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20884 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20885 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20886 kills.
20887
20888 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20889 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20890 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20891 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20892 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20893 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20894 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20895 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20896 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20897
20898 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20899 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20900 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20901
20902 @end table
20903
20904
20905 @node Converting Kill Files
20906 @section Converting Kill Files
20907 @cindex kill files
20908 @cindex converting kill files
20909
20910 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20911 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20912 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20913 by hand.
20914
20915 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20916 You can fetch it from
20917 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20918
20919 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20920 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20921 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20922 before.
20923
20924
20925 @node GroupLens
20926 @section GroupLens
20927 @cindex GroupLens
20928
20929 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20930 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20931
20932 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20933 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20934 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20935 news articles generated every day.
20936
20937 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20938 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
20939 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
20940 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
20941 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
20942 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
20943 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
20944 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
20945 article.
20946
20947 @menu
20948 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
20949 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
20950 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
20951 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
20952 @end menu
20953
20954
20955 @node Using GroupLens
20956 @subsection Using GroupLens
20957
20958 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
20959 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
20960 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
20961
20962 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
20963
20964 @table @code
20965
20966 @item gnus-use-grouplens
20967 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
20968 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
20969 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
20970
20971 @item grouplens-pseudonym
20972 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
20973 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
20974 with the Better Bit Bureau.
20975
20976 @item grouplens-newsgroups
20977 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
20978 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
20979
20980 @end table
20981
20982 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
20983 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
20984 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
20985 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
20986 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
20987 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
20988
20989
20990 @node Rating Articles
20991 @subsection Rating Articles
20992
20993 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
20994 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
20995 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
20996 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
20997 like this one?''
20998
20999 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
21000
21001 @table @kbd
21002
21003 @item r
21004 @kindex r (GroupLens)
21005 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
21006 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
21007
21008 @item k
21009 @kindex k (GroupLens)
21010 @findex grouplens-score-thread
21011 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
21012 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
21013 threads in rec.humor.
21014
21015 @end table
21016
21017 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
21018 the score of the article you're reading.
21019
21020 @table @kbd
21021
21022 @item 1-5 n
21023 @kindex n (GroupLens)
21024 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
21025 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
21026
21027 @item 1-5 ,
21028 @kindex , (GroupLens)
21029 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
21030 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
21031
21032 @end table
21033
21034 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
21035 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
21036
21037
21038 @node Displaying Predictions
21039 @subsection Displaying Predictions
21040
21041 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
21042 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
21043 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
21044 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
21045 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
21046
21047 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
21048 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
21049 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
21050 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
21051 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
21052 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
21053 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
21054 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
21055 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
21056 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
21057 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
21058 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
21059 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
21060
21061 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
21062 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
21063 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
21064 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
21065
21066 The following are valid values for that variable.
21067
21068 @table @code
21069 @item prediction-spot
21070 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
21071 displayed.
21072
21073 @item confidence-interval
21074 A numeric confidence interval.
21075
21076 @item prediction-bar
21077 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
21078
21079 @item confidence-bar
21080 Numerical confidence.
21081
21082 @item confidence-spot
21083 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
21084
21085 @item prediction-num
21086 Plain-old numeric value.
21087
21088 @item confidence-plus-minus
21089 Prediction +/- confidence.
21090
21091 @end table
21092
21093
21094 @node GroupLens Variables
21095 @subsection GroupLens Variables
21096
21097 @table @code
21098
21099 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
21100 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
21101 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
21102 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
21103 %s\n}.
21104
21105 @item grouplens-bbb-host
21106 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
21107 default.
21108
21109 @item grouplens-bbb-port
21110 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
21111
21112 @item grouplens-score-offset
21113 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
21114 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
21115 default is 0.
21116
21117 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
21118 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
21119 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
21120
21121 @end table
21122
21123
21124 @node Advanced Scoring
21125 @section Advanced Scoring
21126
21127 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
21128 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
21129 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
21130 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
21131 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
21132
21133 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
21134 scoring patterns.
21135
21136 @menu
21137 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
21138 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
21139 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
21140 @end menu
21141
21142
21143 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
21144 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
21145
21146 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
21147 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
21148 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
21149 non-@code{nil} value.
21150
21151 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
21152 operator, and various match operators.
21153
21154 Logical operators:
21155
21156 @table @code
21157 @item &
21158 @itemx and
21159 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
21160 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
21161 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
21162 @code{true}.
21163
21164 @item |
21165 @itemx or
21166 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
21167 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
21168 then this operator will return @code{false}.
21169
21170 @item !
21171 @itemx not
21172 @itemx ¬
21173 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
21174 logical negation of the value of its argument.
21175
21176 @end table
21177
21178 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
21179 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
21180 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
21181 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
21182 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
21183 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
21184 the ancestry you want to go.
21185
21186 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
21187 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
21188 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
21189 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
21190 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
21191
21192
21193 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
21194 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
21195
21196 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
21197 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
21198 of parentheses.
21199
21200 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
21201 when he's talking about Gnus:
21202
21203 @example
21204 @group
21205 ((&
21206 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21207 ("subject" "Gnus"))
21208 1000)
21209 @end group
21210 @end example
21211
21212 Quite simple, huh?
21213
21214 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
21215
21216 @example
21217 ((&
21218 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21219 (|
21220 ("subject" "Gnus")
21221 ("lines" 100 >)))
21222 1000)
21223 @end example
21224
21225 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
21226 really don't want to read what he's written:
21227
21228 @example
21229 ((&
21230 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21231 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
21232 -100000)
21233 @end example
21234
21235 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
21236 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
21237 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
21238 very interesting:
21239
21240 @example
21241 ((&
21242 (1-
21243 (&
21244 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
21245 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
21246 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
21247 ("body" "white.*socks"))
21248 1000)
21249 @end example
21250
21251 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
21252 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
21253 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
21254 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
21255
21256 @example
21257 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
21258 -200)
21259 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
21260 200)
21261 @end example
21262
21263 The possibilities are endless.
21264
21265 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
21266 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
21267
21268 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
21269 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
21270 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
21271 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
21272 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
21273 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
21274 @samp{subject}) first.
21275
21276 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
21277 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
21278 something like:
21279
21280 @example
21281 ...
21282 (1-
21283 (1-
21284 ("from" "lars")))
21285 ...
21286 @end example
21287
21288 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
21289 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
21290
21291 @example
21292 (1-
21293 (&
21294 ("from" "Lars")
21295 ("subject" "Gnus")))
21296 @end example
21297
21298 than it is to say:
21299
21300 @example
21301 (&
21302 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
21303 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
21304 @end example
21305
21306
21307 @node Score Decays
21308 @section Score Decays
21309 @cindex score decays
21310 @cindex decays
21311
21312 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
21313 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
21314 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
21315 use them in any sensible way.
21316
21317 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
21318 @findex gnus-decay-score
21319 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
21320 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
21321 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
21322 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
21323 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
21324 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
21325 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
21326 definition of that function:
21327
21328 @lisp
21329 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
21330 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
21331 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21332 (let ((n (- score
21333 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21334 (min (abs score)
21335 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21336 (* (abs score)
21337 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21338 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
21339 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
21340 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21341 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21342 (string-to-number
21343 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21344 (floor n))))
21345 @end lisp
21346
21347 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21348 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21349 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21350 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
21351
21352 @enumerate
21353 @item
21354 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21355
21356 @item
21357 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21358
21359 @item
21360 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21361 score.
21362 @end enumerate
21363
21364 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21365 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21366 the new score, which should be an integer.
21367
21368 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21369 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21370
21371 @iftex
21372 @iflatex
21373 @chapter Message
21374 @include message.texi
21375 @chapter Emacs MIME
21376 @include emacs-mime.texi
21377 @chapter Sieve
21378 @include sieve.texi
21379 @chapter PGG
21380 @include pgg.texi
21381 @end iflatex
21382 @end iftex
21383
21384 @node Various
21385 @chapter Various
21386
21387 @menu
21388 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
21389 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
21390 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
21391 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
21392 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
21393 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
21394 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
21395 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
21396 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
21397 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
21398 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
21399 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
21400 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
21401 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
21402 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
21403 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
21404 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
21405 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
21406 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
21407 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
21408 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
21409 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
21410 @end menu
21411
21412
21413 @node Process/Prefix
21414 @section Process/Prefix
21415 @cindex process/prefix convention
21416
21417 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
21418 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
21419
21420 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
21421 command to be performed on.
21422
21423 It goes like this:
21424
21425 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
21426 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
21427 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
21428 with the current one.
21429
21430 @vindex transient-mark-mode
21431 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
21432 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
21433
21434 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
21435 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
21436 the process mark.
21437
21438 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
21439 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
21440
21441 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
21442 are avoided.
21443
21444 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
21445 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
21446 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
21447 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
21448
21449 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
21450 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
21451 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
21452 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
21453 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
21454 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
21455 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
21456 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
21457
21458 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
21459 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
21460 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
21461 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
21462 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
21463
21464
21465 @node Interactive
21466 @section Interactive
21467 @cindex interaction
21468
21469 @table @code
21470
21471 @item gnus-novice-user
21472 @vindex gnus-novice-user
21473 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
21474 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
21475 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
21476 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
21477 default.
21478
21479 @item gnus-expert-user
21480 @vindex gnus-expert-user
21481 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
21482 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
21483 matter how strange.
21484
21485 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
21486 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
21487 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
21488 is @code{t} by default.
21489
21490 @item gnus-interactive-exit
21491 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
21492 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
21493 default.
21494 @end table
21495
21496
21497 @node Symbolic Prefixes
21498 @section Symbolic Prefixes
21499 @cindex symbolic prefixes
21500
21501 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
21502 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
21503 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
21504 rule of 900 to the current article.
21505
21506 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
21507 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
21508 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
21509 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
21510 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
21511 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
21512 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
21513
21514 @kindex M-i (Summary)
21515 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
21516 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
21517 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
21518 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
21519 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
21520 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
21521 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
21522 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
21523
21524 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
21525 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
21526 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
21527
21528 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
21529 Interactive}.
21530
21531
21532 @node Formatting Variables
21533 @section Formatting Variables
21534 @cindex formatting variables
21535
21536 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
21537 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
21538 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
21539 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
21540 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
21541 be annoyed by.
21542
21543 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
21544 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
21545 lots of percentages everywhere.
21546
21547 @menu
21548 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
21549 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
21550 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
21551 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
21552 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
21553 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
21554 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
21555 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
21556 @end menu
21557
21558 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
21559 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
21560 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
21561 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
21562 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
21563 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
21564 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
21565 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
21566
21567 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
21568 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
21569
21570 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
21571 @findex gnus-update-format
21572 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
21573 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
21574 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
21575 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
21576
21577
21578
21579 @node Formatting Basics
21580 @subsection Formatting Basics
21581
21582 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
21583 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
21584 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
21585
21586 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
21587 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
21588 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
21589 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
21590 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
21591 the right instead.
21592
21593 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
21594 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
21595 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
21596 less than 4 characters wide.
21597
21598 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
21599 @samp{%&user-date;}.
21600
21601
21602 @node Mode Line Formatting
21603 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
21604
21605 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
21606 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
21607 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
21608 with the following two differences:
21609
21610 @enumerate
21611
21612 @item
21613 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
21614
21615 @item
21616 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
21617 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
21618 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
21619 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
21620 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
21621 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
21622 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
21623
21624 @end enumerate
21625
21626
21627 @node Advanced Formatting
21628 @subsection Advanced Formatting
21629
21630 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
21631 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
21632 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
21633 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
21634
21635 These are the valid modifiers:
21636
21637 @table @code
21638 @item pad
21639 @itemx pad-left
21640 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
21641 length.
21642
21643 @item pad-right
21644 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
21645 length.
21646
21647 @item max
21648 @itemx max-left
21649 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
21650
21651 @item max-right
21652 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
21653 length.
21654
21655 @item cut
21656 @itemx cut-left
21657 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
21658
21659 @item cut-right
21660 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
21661
21662 @item ignore
21663 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
21664
21665 @item form
21666 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
21667 used.
21668
21669 Here's an example:
21670
21671 @lisp
21672 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
21673 @end lisp
21674
21675 @end table
21676
21677 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
21678 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
21679 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
21680 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
21681 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
21682 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
21683 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
21684
21685 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
21686 last operation, padding.
21687
21688 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
21689 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
21690 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
21691 @xref{Compilation}.
21692
21693
21694 @node User-Defined Specs
21695 @subsection User-Defined Specs
21696
21697 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
21698 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
21699 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
21700 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
21701 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
21702 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
21703 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
21704 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
21705 should protect against that.
21706
21707 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
21708 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
21709
21710 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
21711 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
21712 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
21713 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
21714 inserted.
21715
21716
21717 @node Formatting Fonts
21718 @subsection Formatting Fonts
21719
21720 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
21721 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
21722 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
21723 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
21724 over it.
21725
21726 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
21727 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
21728 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
21729 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
21730 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
21731 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
21732
21733 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
21734 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
21735 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
21736 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21737 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21738 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21739 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21740 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21741 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21742 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21743 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21744 paragraph.)
21745
21746 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21747
21748 @lisp
21749 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21750 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21751 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21752
21753 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21754 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21755 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21756 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21757 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21758 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21759 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21760
21761 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21762 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21763 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21764 @end lisp
21765
21766 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21767 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21768
21769 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21770 mode-line variables.
21771
21772 @node Positioning Point
21773 @subsection Positioning Point
21774
21775 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21776 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21777 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21778
21779 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21780
21781 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21782 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21783 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21784
21785 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21786 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21787 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21788 place point there.
21789
21790
21791 @node Tabulation
21792 @subsection Tabulation
21793
21794 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21795 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21796 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21797 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21798
21799 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21800 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21801
21802 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21803 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21804 This is the soft tabulator.
21805
21806 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21807 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21808 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21809
21810
21811 @node Wide Characters
21812 @subsection Wide Characters
21813
21814 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21815 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21816 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21817
21818 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21819 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21820 these countries, that's not true.
21821
21822 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21823 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21824 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21825 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21826 for Emacs.
21827
21828
21829 @node Window Layout
21830 @section Window Layout
21831 @cindex window layout
21832
21833 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21834
21835 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21836 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21837 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21838 @code{t} by default.
21839
21840 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21841 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21842
21843 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21844 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21845 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21846
21847 @lisp
21848 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21849 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21850 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21851 (article 1.0))))
21852 @end lisp
21853
21854 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21855 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21856 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21857 possible names is listed below.
21858
21859 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21860 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21861
21862 @lisp
21863 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21864 (article 1.0)))
21865 @end lisp
21866
21867 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21868 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21869 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21870 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21871 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21872 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21873 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21874 size spec per split.
21875
21876 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21877 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21878 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21879 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21880 present) gets focus.
21881
21882 Here's a more complicated example:
21883
21884 @lisp
21885 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21886 (summary 0.25 point)
21887 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21888 (article 1.0)))
21889 @end lisp
21890
21891 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21892 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21893 occupy, not a percentage.
21894
21895 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21896 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21897 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21898 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21899 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21900 is non-@code{nil}.
21901
21902 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21903
21904 @lisp
21905 (article (horizontal 1.0
21906 (vertical 0.5
21907 (group 1.0)
21908 (gnus-carpal 4))
21909 (vertical 1.0
21910 (summary 0.25 point)
21911 (summary-carpal 4)
21912 (article 1.0))))
21913 @end lisp
21914
21915 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21916 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21917
21918 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21919 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21920 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21921 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21922 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21923
21924 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21925 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21926 lines from the splits.
21927
21928 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21929 may look like:
21930
21931 @example
21932 @group
21933 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
21934 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
21935 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
21936 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
21937 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
21938 size = number | frame-params
21939 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
21940 @end group
21941 @end example
21942
21943 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
21944 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
21945 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
21946 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
21947
21948 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
21949 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
21950 @cindex window height
21951 @cindex window width
21952 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
21953 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
21954 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
21955 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
21956 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
21957 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
21958
21959 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
21960 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
21961 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
21962 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
21963
21964 @findex gnus-configure-frame
21965 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
21966 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
21967 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
21968 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
21969 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
21970 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
21971 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
21972 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
21973 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
21974 configuration list.
21975
21976 @lisp
21977 (gnus-configure-frame
21978 '(horizontal 1.0
21979 (vertical 10
21980 (group 1.0)
21981 (article 0.3 point))
21982 (vertical 1.0
21983 (article 1.0)
21984 (horizontal 4
21985 (group 1.0)
21986 (article 10)))))
21987 @end lisp
21988
21989 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
21990 @code{frame} split:
21991
21992 @lisp
21993 (gnus-configure-frame
21994 '(frame 1.0
21995 (vertical 1.0
21996 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
21997 (article 1.0))
21998 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
21999 (user-position . t)
22000 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22001 (picon 1.0))))
22002
22003 @end lisp
22004
22005 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22006 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22007 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22008 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22009 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22010 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22011 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22012 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22013 is such a plist.
22014 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22015 be found in its default value.
22016
22017 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22018 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22019 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22020 might be used:
22021
22022 @lisp
22023 (message (horizontal 1.0
22024 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22025 (vertical 0.24
22026 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22027 '(summary 0.5))
22028 (group 1.0))))
22029 @end lisp
22030
22031 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22032 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22033 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22034
22035 @lisp
22036 (message
22037 (frame 1.0
22038 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22039 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22040 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22041 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22042 (name . "Message"))
22043 (message 1.0 point))))
22044 @end lisp
22045
22046 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22047 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22048 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22049 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22050 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22051
22052 @lisp
22053 (gnus-add-configuration
22054 '(article (vertical 1.0
22055 (group 4)
22056 (summary .25 point)
22057 (article 1.0))))
22058 @end lisp
22059
22060 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22061 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22062 Gnus has been loaded.
22063
22064 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22065 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22066 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22067 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22068 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22069
22070 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22071 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22072 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22073 windows resized.
22074
22075 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22076
22077 @itemize @bullet
22078 @item
22079 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22080 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22081
22082 @ifinfo
22083 @example
22084 +---+---------+
22085 | G | Summary |
22086 | r +---------+
22087 | o | |
22088 | u | Article |
22089 | p | |
22090 +---+---------+
22091 @end example
22092 @end ifinfo
22093
22094 @lisp
22095 (gnus-add-configuration
22096 '(article
22097 (horizontal 1.0
22098 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22099 (vertical 1.0
22100 (summary 0.16 point)
22101 (article 1.0)))))
22102
22103 (gnus-add-configuration
22104 '(summary
22105 (horizontal 1.0
22106 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22107 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22108 @end lisp
22109
22110 @end itemize
22111
22112
22113 @node Faces and Fonts
22114 @section Faces and Fonts
22115 @cindex faces
22116 @cindex fonts
22117 @cindex colors
22118
22119 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22120 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22121 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22122 interface.
22123
22124
22125 @node Compilation
22126 @section Compilation
22127 @cindex compilation
22128 @cindex byte-compilation
22129
22130 @findex gnus-compile
22131
22132 Remember all those line format specification variables?
22133 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
22134 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
22135 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
22136 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
22137 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
22138 course.)
22139
22140 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
22141 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
22142 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
22143 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
22144 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
22145 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
22146 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
22147
22148
22149 @node Mode Lines
22150 @section Mode Lines
22151 @cindex mode lines
22152
22153 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22154 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22155 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22156 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22157 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22158 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22159 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22160 quicker.
22161
22162 @cindex display-time
22163
22164 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22165 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22166 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22167 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22168 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22169 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22170 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22171 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
22172 this variable:
22173
22174 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22175 @lisp
22176 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
22177 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22178 (+ 21
22179 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22180 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22181 (length display-time-string)))))
22182 @end lisp
22183
22184 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22185 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22186 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22187 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22188 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22189
22190
22191 @node Highlighting and Menus
22192 @section Highlighting and Menus
22193 @cindex visual
22194 @cindex highlighting
22195 @cindex menus
22196
22197 @vindex gnus-visual
22198 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
22199 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
22200 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
22201 file.
22202
22203 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
22204 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
22205
22206 @table @code
22207 @item group-highlight
22208 Do highlights in the group buffer.
22209 @item summary-highlight
22210 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
22211 @item article-highlight
22212 Do highlights in the article buffer.
22213 @item highlight
22214 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
22215 @item group-menu
22216 Create menus in the group buffer.
22217 @item summary-menu
22218 Create menus in the summary buffers.
22219 @item article-menu
22220 Create menus in the article buffer.
22221 @item browse-menu
22222 Create menus in the browse buffer.
22223 @item server-menu
22224 Create menus in the server buffer.
22225 @item score-menu
22226 Create menus in the score buffers.
22227 @item menu
22228 Create menus in all buffers.
22229 @end table
22230
22231 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
22232 buffers, you could say something like:
22233
22234 @lisp
22235 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
22236 @end lisp
22237
22238 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
22239
22240 @lisp
22241 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
22242 @end lisp
22243
22244 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
22245 in all Gnus buffers.
22246
22247 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
22248
22249 @table @code
22250 @item gnus-mouse-face
22251 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22252 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
22253 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
22254
22255 @end table
22256
22257 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
22258
22259 @table @code
22260
22261 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
22262 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
22263 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
22264
22265 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
22266 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
22267 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
22268
22269 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
22270 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
22271 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
22272
22273 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
22274 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
22275 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
22276
22277 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
22278 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
22279 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
22280
22281 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
22282 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
22283 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
22284
22285 @end table
22286
22287
22288 @node Buttons
22289 @section Buttons
22290 @cindex buttons
22291 @cindex mouse
22292 @cindex click
22293
22294 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
22295 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
22296 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
22297 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
22298 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
22299
22300 Right.
22301
22302 @vindex gnus-carpal
22303 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
22304 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
22305 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
22306
22307
22308 @table @code
22309
22310 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
22311 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
22312 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
22313
22314 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
22315 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
22316 Face used on buttons.
22317
22318 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
22319 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
22320 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
22321
22322 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
22323 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
22324 Buttons in the group buffer.
22325
22326 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
22327 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
22328 Buttons in the summary buffer.
22329
22330 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
22331 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
22332 Buttons in the server buffer.
22333
22334 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
22335 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
22336 Buttons in the browse buffer.
22337 @end table
22338
22339 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
22340 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
22341 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
22342
22343
22344 @node Daemons
22345 @section Daemons
22346 @cindex demons
22347 @cindex daemons
22348
22349 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
22350 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
22351 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
22352 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
22353 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
22354
22355 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
22356 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
22357 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
22358
22359 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
22360 been idle for thirty minutes:
22361
22362 @lisp
22363 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
22364 @end lisp
22365
22366 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
22367 Emacs is idle:
22368
22369 @lisp
22370 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
22371 @end lisp
22372
22373 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
22374 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
22375 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
22376
22377 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
22378 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
22379 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
22380 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
22381
22382 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
22383 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
22384 @var{idle} minutes.
22385
22386 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
22387 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
22388 minutes.
22389
22390 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
22391 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
22392 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
22393
22394 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
22395 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
22396 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
22397 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
22398
22399 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
22400 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22401
22402 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
22403 @lisp
22404 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
22405 @end lisp
22406
22407 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
22408 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
22409 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
22410 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
22411 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
22412 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
22413 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
22414 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
22415 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
22416 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
22417 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
22418
22419 @findex gnus-demon-init
22420 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
22421 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
22422 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
22423 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
22424 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
22425
22426 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
22427 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
22428 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
22429 behave.
22430
22431
22432 @node NoCeM
22433 @section NoCeM
22434 @cindex nocem
22435 @cindex spam
22436
22437 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
22438 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
22439
22440 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
22441 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
22442 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
22443 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
22444 away.
22445
22446 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
22447 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
22448 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
22449 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
22450
22451 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
22452 this will make spam disappear.
22453
22454 There are some variables to customize, of course:
22455
22456 @table @code
22457 @item gnus-use-nocem
22458 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
22459 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
22460 by default.
22461
22462 You can also set this variable to a positive number as a group level.
22463 In that case, Gnus scans NoCeM messages when checking new news if this
22464 value is not exceeding a group level that you specify as the prefix
22465 argument to some commands, e.g. @code{gnus},
22466 @code{gnus-group-get-new-news}, etc. Otherwise, Gnus does not scan
22467 NoCeM messages if you specify a group level to those commands. For
22468 example, if you use 1 or 2 on the mail groups and the levels on the news
22469 groups remain the default, 3 is the best choice.
22470
22471 @item gnus-nocem-groups
22472 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
22473 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
22474 default is
22475 @lisp
22476 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
22477 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
22478 @end lisp
22479
22480 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
22481 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
22482 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
22483 people you want to listen to. The default is
22484 @lisp
22485 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
22486 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
22487 @end lisp
22488 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
22489
22490 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
22491 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
22492
22493 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
22494 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
22495 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
22496 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
22497 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
22498 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
22499 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
22500 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
22501 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
22502 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
22503
22504 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
22505 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
22506
22507 @lisp
22508 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
22509 @end lisp
22510
22511 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
22512 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
22513
22514 @lisp
22515 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
22516 @end lisp
22517
22518 The specs are applied left-to-right.
22519
22520
22521 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
22522 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
22523 @findex pgg-verify
22524 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
22525 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
22526 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
22527 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
22528 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
22529 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
22530
22531 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
22532 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
22533 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
22534 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
22535
22536 @item gnus-nocem-directory
22537 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
22538 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
22539 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
22540
22541 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
22542 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
22543 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
22544 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
22545 might then see old spam.
22546
22547 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
22548 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
22549 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
22550 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
22551 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
22552 issuers.
22553
22554 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
22555 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
22556 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
22557 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
22558
22559 @end table
22560
22561 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
22562 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
22563 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
22564 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
22565
22566
22567 @node Undo
22568 @section Undo
22569 @cindex undo
22570
22571 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
22572 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
22573 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
22574
22575 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
22576 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
22577 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
22578 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
22579 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
22580 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
22581 @code{undo} function.
22582
22583 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
22584 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
22585 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
22586 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
22587 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
22588 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
22589 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
22590 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
22591 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
22592 never be totally undoable.
22593
22594 @findex gnus-undo-mode
22595 @vindex gnus-use-undo
22596 @findex gnus-undo
22597 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
22598 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
22599 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
22600 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
22601 command.
22602
22603
22604 @node Predicate Specifiers
22605 @section Predicate Specifiers
22606 @cindex predicate specifiers
22607
22608 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
22609 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
22610 to type all that much.
22611
22612 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
22613
22614 Here's an example:
22615
22616 @lisp
22617 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
22618 gnus-article-unread-p)
22619 @end lisp
22620
22621 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
22622 functions all take one parameter.
22623
22624 @findex gnus-make-predicate
22625 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
22626 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
22627 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
22628 specifier.
22629
22630
22631 @node Moderation
22632 @section Moderation
22633 @cindex moderation
22634
22635 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
22636 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
22637 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
22638 get a copy.
22639
22640 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
22641 buffers. Put
22642
22643 @lisp
22644 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
22645 @end lisp
22646
22647 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22648
22649 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
22650 supposed to work:
22651
22652 @enumerate
22653 @item
22654 You split your incoming mail by matching on
22655 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
22656 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
22657
22658 @item
22659 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
22660 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
22661
22662 @item
22663 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
22664 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
22665 @kbd{c} command.
22666 @end enumerate
22667
22668 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
22669
22670 @lisp
22671 (setq gnus-moderated-list
22672 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
22673 @end lisp
22674
22675
22676 @node Fetching a Group
22677 @section Fetching a Group
22678 @cindex fetching a group
22679
22680 @findex gnus-fetch-group
22681 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
22682 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
22683 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
22684 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
22685 It takes the group name as a parameter.
22686
22687
22688 @node Image Enhancements
22689 @section Image Enhancements
22690
22691 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
22692 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
22693 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
22694
22695 @menu
22696 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
22697 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
22698 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
22699 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
22700 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
22701 @end menu
22702
22703
22704 @node X-Face
22705 @subsection X-Face
22706 @cindex x-face
22707
22708 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
22709 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
22710 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
22711 readers.
22712
22713 @cindex x-face
22714 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
22715 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
22716 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
22717 @iftex
22718 @iflatex
22719 \include{xface}
22720 @end iflatex
22721 @end iftex
22722 @c @anchor{X-Face}
22723
22724 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
22725 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions has), or that you
22726 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
22727 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
22728 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
22729 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
22730 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
22731 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
22732 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
22733 @code{display} program.
22734
22735 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
22736 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
22737 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
22738 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
22739 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
22740 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
22741 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
22742 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
22743
22744 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
22745 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
22746 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
22747 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
22748 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
22749 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
22750
22751 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22752 @code{xface}).
22753
22754 @noindent
22755 Face and variable:
22756
22757 @table @code
22758 @item gnus-x-face
22759 @vindex gnus-x-face
22760 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22761 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22762 default colors are black and white.
22763 @end table
22764
22765 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
22766 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
22767 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
22768 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
22769 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
22770 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
22771
22772 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22773 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22774 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22775 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22776 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22777 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22778 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22779 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22780 header data as a string.
22781
22782 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22783 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22784 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22785 randomly generated data.
22786
22787 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22788 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22789 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22790 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22791 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22792
22793 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22794 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22795
22796 @lisp
22797 (setq message-required-news-headers
22798 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22799 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22800 @end lisp
22801
22802 Using the last function would be something like this:
22803
22804 @lisp
22805 (setq message-required-news-headers
22806 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22807 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22808 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22809 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22810 @end lisp
22811
22812
22813 @node Face
22814 @subsection Face
22815 @cindex face
22816
22817 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
22818
22819 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22820 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22821 represent the author of the message.
22822
22823 @cindex face
22824 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22825 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22826 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22827 specifications.
22828
22829 Viewing an @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
22830 PNG images.
22831 @c Maybe add this:
22832 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
22833 @c (featurep 'png)
22834 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
22835
22836 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22837 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22838
22839 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22840 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22841 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22842
22843 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22844 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22845 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22846 converts the file to Face format by using the
22847 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22848
22849 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22850 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22851
22852 @lisp
22853 (setq message-required-news-headers
22854 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22855 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22856 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22857 @end lisp
22858
22859
22860 @node Smileys
22861 @subsection Smileys
22862 @cindex smileys
22863
22864 @iftex
22865 @iflatex
22866 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22867 \input{smiley}
22868 @end iflatex
22869 @end iftex
22870
22871 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22872 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22873
22874 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22875 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22876
22877 @lisp
22878 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22879 @end lisp
22880
22881 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22882 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22883 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22884 text and maps that to file names.
22885
22886 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22887 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22888 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22889 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22890 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22891 displayed.
22892
22893 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22894 files:
22895
22896 @table @code
22897
22898 @item smiley-data-directory
22899 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22900 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22901
22902 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22903 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22904 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22905
22906 @end table
22907
22908
22909 @node Picons
22910 @subsection Picons
22911
22912 @iftex
22913 @iflatex
22914 \include{picons}
22915 @end iflatex
22916 @end iftex
22917
22918 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22919 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22920 over your shoulder as you read news.
22921
22922 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22923
22924 @iftex
22925 @iflatex
22926 \margindex{}
22927 @end iflatex
22928 @end iftex
22929
22930 @quotation
22931 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
22932 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
22933 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
22934 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
22935 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
22936 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
22937 @code{GIF} formats.
22938 @end quotation
22939
22940 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22941 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
22942 point your Web browser at
22943 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
22944
22945 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
22946 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
22947
22948 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
22949 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
22950 Picons databases.
22951
22952 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
22953
22954 @table @code
22955
22956 @item gnus-picon-databases
22957 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
22958 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
22959 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
22960 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
22961 "/usr/local/faces")}.
22962
22963 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
22964 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
22965 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22966 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
22967
22968 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
22969 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
22970 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
22971 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
22972
22973 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
22974 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
22975 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
22976 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
22977 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
22978
22979 @item gnus-picon-file-types
22980 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
22981 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
22982 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
22983
22984 @end table
22985
22986
22987 @node XVarious
22988 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
22989
22990 @table @code
22991 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22992 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
22993 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
22994 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
22995 unusual directory structure.
22996
22997 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22998 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
22999 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23000 default.
23001
23002 @end table
23003
23004 @subsubsection Toolbar
23005
23006 @table @code
23007
23008 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23009 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23010 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23011 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23012 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23013 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23014 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23015 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23016
23017 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23018 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23019 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23020 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23021 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23022 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23023
23024 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23025 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23026 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23027
23028 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23029 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23030 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23031
23032 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23033 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23034 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23035
23036 @end table
23037
23038 @iftex
23039 @iflatex
23040 \margindex{}
23041 @end iflatex
23042 @end iftex
23043
23044
23045 @node Fuzzy Matching
23046 @section Fuzzy Matching
23047 @cindex fuzzy matching
23048
23049 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23050 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23051
23052 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23053 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23054 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23055
23056 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23057 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23058 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23059 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23060 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23061
23062
23063 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23064 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23065 @cindex email spam
23066 @cindex spam
23067 @cindex UCE
23068 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23069
23070 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23071 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23072 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23073 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23074 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23075 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23076 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23077 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23078 in the end.
23079
23080 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23081 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23082 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23083 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23084 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23085 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23086
23087 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23088
23089 @menu
23090 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23091 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23092 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23093 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23094 @end menu
23095
23096 @node The problem of spam
23097 @subsection The problem of spam
23098 @cindex email spam
23099 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23100 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23101 @cindex UCE
23102 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23103
23104 First, some background on spam.
23105
23106 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23107 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23108 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23109 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23110 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23111 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23112 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23113 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23114 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23115
23116 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23117 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23118 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23119 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23120 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23121 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23122 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23123 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23124 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23125 and processing.
23126
23127 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23128 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23129 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23130 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23131 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23132 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23133 from Bulgarian IPs.
23134
23135 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23136 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23137 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
23138 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23139
23140 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23141 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23142 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23143 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23144
23145 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23146 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23147 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23148 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23149 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23150 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23151 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23152 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23153 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23154
23155 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23156 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23157 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23158 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23159 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23160 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23161 down for some time because of the incident.
23162
23163 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23164 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23165 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23166 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23167 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23168 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23169 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23170 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23171 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23172 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23173 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23174
23175 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23176 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23177 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23178 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23179 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23180 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23181 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23182 spam plague.
23183
23184 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23185 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23186 @cindex email spam
23187 @cindex spam
23188 @cindex UCE
23189 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23190
23191 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23192 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23193
23194 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23195 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23196 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23197 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23198 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23199 part of the mail address.)
23200
23201 @lisp
23202 (setq message-default-news-headers
23203 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23204 @end lisp
23205
23206 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23207 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23208
23209 @lisp
23210 (...
23211 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23212 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23213 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23214 "spam"))
23215 ...)
23216 @end lisp
23217
23218 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23219 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23220 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23221 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23222
23223 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23224 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23225 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23226 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23227 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23228 your fancy split rule in this way:
23229
23230 @lisp
23231 (
23232 ...
23233 (to "larsi" "misc")
23234 "spam")
23235 @end lisp
23236
23237 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23238 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23239 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23240 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23241 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23242
23243 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23244 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23245 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23246 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23247
23248 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23249
23250
23251 @node SpamAssassin
23252 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23253 @cindex SpamAssassin
23254 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23255 @cindex DCC
23256
23257 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23258 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23259 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23260 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23261 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23262 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23263 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23264
23265 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23266 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23267 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23268 recipes.
23269
23270 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23271 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23272 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23273 Specifiers}) follow.
23274
23275 @lisp
23276 (setq mail-sources
23277 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23278 (pop :user "jrl"
23279 :server "pophost"
23280 :postscript
23281 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23282 @end lisp
23283
23284 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
23285 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
23286 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23287
23288 @lisp
23289 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23290 ...))
23291 @end lisp
23292
23293 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23294
23295 @lisp
23296 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
23297 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
23298 ...))
23299 @end lisp
23300
23301 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
23302 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
23303 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
23304 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
23305
23306 @lisp
23307 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
23308 ...))
23309 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
23310 (save-excursion
23311 (save-restriction
23312 (widen)
23313 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
23314 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
23315 "spam"))))
23316 @end lisp
23317
23318 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
23319 downloaded by default. You need to set
23320 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
23321 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
23322
23323 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
23324 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
23325 spam. And here is the nifty function:
23326
23327 @lisp
23328 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
23329 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
23330 (interactive)
23331 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
23332 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
23333 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
23334 @end lisp
23335
23336 @node Hashcash
23337 @subsection Hashcash
23338 @cindex hashcash
23339
23340 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
23341 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
23342 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
23343 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
23344 in smaller communities.
23345
23346 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
23347 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
23348 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
23349 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
23350 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
23351 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
23352 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
23353 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
23354 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
23355 one of them separately.
23356
23357 @cindex X-Hashcash
23358 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
23359 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
23360 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
23361 header. For more details, and for the external application
23362 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
23363 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
23364 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
23365
23366 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
23367 like:
23368
23369 @lisp
23370 (require 'hashcash)
23371 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
23372 @end lisp
23373
23374 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
23375 contrib directory or at
23376 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
23377
23378 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
23379
23380 @table @code
23381
23382 @item hashcash-default-payment
23383 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
23384 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
23385 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
23386 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
23387
23388 @item hashcash-payment-alist
23389 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
23390 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
23391 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
23392 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
23393 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
23394 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
23395 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
23396 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
23397
23398 @item hashcash
23399 @vindex hashcash
23400 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
23401
23402 @end table
23403
23404 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
23405 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
23406 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
23407 a useful contribution, however.
23408
23409 @node Spam Package
23410 @section Spam Package
23411 @cindex spam filtering
23412 @cindex spam
23413
23414 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
23415 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
23416 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
23417 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
23418
23419 @menu
23420 * Spam Package Introduction::
23421 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
23422 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
23423 * Spam and Ham Processors::
23424 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
23425 * Spam Back Ends::
23426 * Extending the Spam package::
23427 * Spam Statistics Package::
23428 @end menu
23429
23430 @node Spam Package Introduction
23431 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
23432 @cindex spam filtering
23433 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
23434 @cindex spam
23435
23436 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
23437 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
23438
23439 @cindex spam-initialize
23440 @vindex spam-use-stat
23441 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
23442 @code{spam-initialize}:
23443
23444 @example
23445 (spam-initialize)
23446 @end example
23447
23448 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
23449 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
23450 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
23451 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
23452 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
23453
23454 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
23455 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
23456
23457 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
23458 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
23459
23460 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
23461 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
23462 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
23463 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
23464 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
23465
23466 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
23467 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
23468 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
23469 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
23470 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
23471 Groups}.
23472
23473 @cindex spam back ends
23474 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
23475 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
23476 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
23477 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
23478 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23479
23480 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
23481 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
23482
23483 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
23484 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
23485 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
23486 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
23487 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
23488 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
23489 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
23490
23491 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
23492 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
23493 point, the Spam package does several things:
23494
23495 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
23496 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
23497 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
23498 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
23499 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
23500 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
23501 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
23502 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
23503 Ham Processors}.
23504
23505 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
23506 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
23507 group:
23508
23509 @table @kbd
23510 @item M-d
23511 @itemx M s x
23512 @itemx S x
23513 @kindex M-d
23514 @kindex S x
23515 @kindex M s x
23516 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
23517 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
23518 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
23519 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
23520 @end table
23521
23522 @noindent
23523 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
23524 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
23525
23526 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
23527 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
23528 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
23529 to be processed as ham by setting
23530 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
23531 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
23532
23533 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23534 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23535 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
23536 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
23537 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
23538 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
23539 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
23540 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
23541 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
23542 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
23543 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
23544 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
23545
23546 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
23547 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
23548 want each article to be processed only once, load the
23549 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
23550 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
23551 Configuration Examples}.
23552
23553 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
23554 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
23555 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
23556 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
23557
23558 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
23559 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
23560
23561 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
23562 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
23563 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
23564
23565 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
23566 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
23567 @cindex spam filtering
23568 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
23569 @cindex spam
23570
23571 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
23572 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
23573 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
23574 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
23575 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
23576
23577 @example
23578 (: spam-split)
23579 @end example
23580
23581 @vindex spam-split-group
23582 @noindent
23583 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
23584 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
23585 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
23586 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
23587 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
23588 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
23589 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
23590 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
23591 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
23592
23593 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
23594
23595 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
23596 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
23597 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
23598 you should also set set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body}
23599 to @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can
23600 ``scan'' the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only
23601 retrieves the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells
23602 it to retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by
23603 default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
23604 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Splitting
23605 in IMAP}.
23606
23607 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
23608 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
23609 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
23610 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
23611 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
23612 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
23613 ends, and the following split rule:
23614
23615 @example
23616 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23617 (any "ding" "ding")
23618 (: spam-split)
23619 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23620 "mail")
23621 @end example
23622
23623 @noindent
23624 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
23625 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
23626 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
23627 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
23628 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
23629 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
23630
23631 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
23632 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
23633 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
23634 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
23635
23636 @example
23637 nnimap-split-fancy
23638 '(|
23639 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
23640 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23641 (any "ding" "ding")
23642 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
23643 (: spam-split)
23644 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23645 "mail")
23646 @end example
23647
23648 @noindent
23649 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
23650 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
23651 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
23652 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
23653 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
23654 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
23655 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
23656
23657 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23658 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23659 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23660 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23661
23662 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
23663 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
23664 @c don't.}
23665
23666 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
23667 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
23668
23669 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
23670 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
23671 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
23672 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
23673
23674 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23675 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23676 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23677 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
23678
23679 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
23680 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
23681 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
23682
23683 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
23684 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
23685 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
23686 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
23687 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
23688 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
23689 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
23690
23691 @node Spam and Ham Processors
23692 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
23693 @cindex spam filtering
23694 @cindex spam filtering variables
23695 @cindex spam variables
23696 @cindex spam
23697
23698 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
23699 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
23700 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
23701 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
23702 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
23703 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
23704 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
23705
23706 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
23707 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
23708 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
23709 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
23710
23711 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23712 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
23713 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
23714 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
23715 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
23716 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
23717 by customizing the corresponding variable
23718 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
23719 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
23720 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
23721 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
23722 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
23723 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
23724 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
23725 default.
23726
23727 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
23728 @cindex $
23729 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
23730 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
23731 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
23732 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
23733 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
23734 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
23735 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
23736 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
23737 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
23738 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
23739 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
23740 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
23741 processor which will study them as spam samples.
23742
23743 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
23744 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
23745 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
23746 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23747 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23748 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23749 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23750 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23751
23752 @defvar ham-marks
23753 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23754 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23755 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23756 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23757 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23758 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23759 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23760 happy for you.
23761 @end defvar
23762
23763 @defvar spam-marks
23764 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23765 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23766 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23767 you really want to.
23768 @end defvar
23769
23770 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23771 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23772 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23773 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23774 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23775 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23776 and nothing else.
23777
23778 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23779 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23780 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23781 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23782 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23783 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23784 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23785 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23786 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23787 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23788 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23789 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23790 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23791 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23792 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23793
23794 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23795 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23796
23797 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23798 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23799 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23800
23801 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23802 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23803
23804 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23805 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23806 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23807 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23808 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23809
23810 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23811 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23812 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23813 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23814 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23815 it there.
23816
23817 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23818 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23819 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23820 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23821 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23822 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23823 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23824 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23825 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23826 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23827 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23828 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23829 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23830
23831 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23832 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23833
23834 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23835 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23836 training} groups.
23837
23838 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23839 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23840 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23841 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23842 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23843 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23844 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23845
23846 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23847 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23848 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23849 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23850
23851 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23852 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23853 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23854 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23855 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23856 from the mail server.
23857
23858 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23859 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23860 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23861 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23862
23863 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
23864 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
23865 @cindex spam filtering
23866 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23867 @cindex spam configuration examples
23868 @cindex spam
23869
23870 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23871
23872 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23873 @example
23874 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23875 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23876 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23877 (spam-initialize)
23878
23879 (setq
23880 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23881 spam-use-BBDB t
23882 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23883 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23884 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23885 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23886 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23887 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23888 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23889 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23890 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23891 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23892 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23893 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23894 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23895 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23896 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23897 (any "ding" "ding")
23898 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23899 (: spam-split)
23900 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23901 "mail"))
23902
23903 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23904
23905 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23906 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23907 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23908 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23909
23910 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23911
23912 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23913 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23914 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23915 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23916 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23917
23918 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23919 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23920
23921 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23922
23923 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23924 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23925
23926 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23927 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23928 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23929
23930 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23931
23932 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
23933 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
23934
23935 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
23936 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
23937 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
23938 (ham-marks
23939 (gnus-ticked-mark))
23940 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
23941 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
23942 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
23943
23944 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
23945 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
23946 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
23947
23948 @end example
23949
23950 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
23951 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
23952
23953 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
23954 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
23955 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
23956 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
23957 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
23958 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
23959 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
23960 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
23961 @samp{training.spam} folders.
23962
23963 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
23964 does most of the job for me:
23965
23966 @lisp
23967 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
23968 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
23969 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
23970 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23971 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
23972 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
23973 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
23974 @end lisp
23975
23976 @itemize
23977
23978 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
23979
23980 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
23981 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
23982 bogofilter or DCC).
23983
23984 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
23985 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
23986 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
23987 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
23988 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
23989 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
23990 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
23991
23992 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
23993 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
23994 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
23995 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
23996 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
23997 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
23998
23999 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24000
24001 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24002 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24003 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24004 @samp{training.ham}.
24005 @end itemize
24006
24007 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24008
24009 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24010
24011 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24012 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24013 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24014
24015 @lisp
24016 ("^gmane\\."
24017 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24018 @end lisp
24019
24020 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24021 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24022 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
24023 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24024 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24025
24026 @node Spam Back Ends
24027 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24028 @cindex spam back ends
24029
24030 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24031 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24032 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24033 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24034 Processors}).
24035
24036 @menu
24037 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24038 * BBDB Whitelists::
24039 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24040 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24041 * Blackholes::
24042 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24043 * Bogofilter::
24044 * ifile spam filtering::
24045 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24046 * SpamOracle::
24047 @end menu
24048
24049 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24050 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24051 @cindex spam filtering
24052 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24053 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24054 @cindex spam
24055
24056 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24057
24058 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24059 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24060 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24061 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24062 be spammers.
24063
24064 @end defvar
24065
24066 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24067
24068 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24069 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24070 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24071 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24072 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24073
24074 @end defvar
24075
24076 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24077
24078 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24079 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24080 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24081
24082 @end defvar
24083
24084 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24085
24086 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24087 customizing the group parameters or the
24088 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24089 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24090 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24091
24092 @emph{WARNING}
24093
24094 Instead of the obsolete
24095 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24096 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24097 the same way, we promise.
24098
24099 @end defvar
24100
24101 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24102
24103 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24104 customizing the group parameters or the
24105 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24106 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24107 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24108 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
24109 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24110
24111 @emph{WARNING}
24112
24113 Instead of the obsolete
24114 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24115 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24116 the same way, we promise.
24117
24118 @end defvar
24119
24120 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24121 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24122 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24123 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24124 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24125
24126 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24127 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24128 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24129 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24130
24131 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24132 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24133 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24134 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24135 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24136 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24137
24138 @node BBDB Whitelists
24139 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24140 @cindex spam filtering
24141 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24142 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24143 @cindex spam
24144
24145 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24146
24147 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24148 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24149 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24150 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24151 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24152 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24153 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24154
24155 @end defvar
24156
24157 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24158
24159 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24160 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24161 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
24162 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24163 classified as spammers.
24164
24165 @end defvar
24166
24167 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24168
24169 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24170 customizing the group parameters or the
24171 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24172 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24173 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24174 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
24175 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24176
24177 @emph{WARNING}
24178
24179 Instead of the obsolete
24180 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24181 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24182 the same way, we promise.
24183
24184 @end defvar
24185
24186 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24187 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24188 @cindex spam reporting
24189 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24190 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24191 @cindex spam
24192
24193 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24194
24195 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24196 customizing the group parameters or the
24197 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24198 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24199 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24200 HTTP request.
24201
24202 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24203
24204 @emph{WARNING}
24205
24206 Instead of the obsolete
24207 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24208 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24209 same way, we promise.
24210
24211 @end defvar
24212
24213 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24214
24215 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24216 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24217 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24218 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24219 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
24220 Gmane provides.
24221
24222 @end defvar
24223
24224 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24225 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24226 @cindex spam filtering
24227 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24228 @cindex spam
24229
24230 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24231
24232 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24233 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24234 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
24235 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
24236 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
24237 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
24238 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
24239 ham.
24240
24241 @end defvar
24242
24243 @node Blackholes
24244 @subsubsection Blackholes
24245 @cindex spam filtering
24246 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24247 @cindex spam
24248
24249 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
24250
24251 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24252 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24253 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24254 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24255 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24256 contains outdated servers.
24257
24258 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
24259 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
24260 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24261 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24262 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24263 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24264
24265 @end defvar
24266
24267 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24268
24269 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24270
24271 @end defvar
24272
24273 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24274
24275 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
24276 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
24277
24278 @end defvar
24279
24280 @defvar spam-use-dig
24281
24282 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
24283 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
24284
24285 @end defvar
24286
24287 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
24288 ham processor for blackholes.
24289
24290 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
24291 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
24292 @cindex spam filtering
24293 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
24294 @cindex spam
24295
24296 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
24297
24298 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
24299 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
24300 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
24301 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
24302 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
24303 message is spam or ham, respectively.
24304
24305 @end defvar
24306
24307 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
24308
24309 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24310 the message, positively identify it as spam.
24311
24312 @end defvar
24313
24314 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
24315
24316 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24317 the message, positively identify it as ham.
24318
24319 @end defvar
24320
24321 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
24322 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
24323
24324 @node Bogofilter
24325 @subsubsection Bogofilter
24326 @cindex spam filtering
24327 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
24328 @cindex spam
24329
24330 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
24331
24332 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
24333 speedy Bogofilter.
24334
24335 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
24336 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
24337 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
24338 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
24339 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
24340 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
24341
24342 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
24343 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
24344 documentation.
24345
24346 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
24347 processing will be turned off.
24348
24349 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
24350
24351 @end defvar
24352
24353 @table @kbd
24354 @item M s t
24355 @itemx S t
24356 @kindex M s t
24357 @kindex S t
24358 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
24359 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
24360 @end table
24361
24362 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
24363
24364 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
24365 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
24366 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
24367 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
24368 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
24369 installation documents for details.
24370
24371 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
24372
24373 @end defvar
24374
24375 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
24376 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24377 customizing the group parameters or the
24378 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24379 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
24380 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
24381
24382 @emph{WARNING}
24383
24384 Instead of the obsolete
24385 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
24386 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
24387 the same way, we promise.
24388 @end defvar
24389
24390 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
24391 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24392 customizing the group parameters or the
24393 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24394 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
24395 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
24396 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
24397 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24398
24399 @emph{WARNING}
24400
24401 Instead of the obsolete
24402 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
24403 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
24404 the same way, we promise.
24405 @end defvar
24406
24407 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
24408
24409 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
24410 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
24411 database directory.
24412
24413 @end defvar
24414
24415 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
24416 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
24417 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
24418 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
24419 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
24420 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
24421
24422 @node ifile spam filtering
24423 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
24424 @cindex spam filtering
24425 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
24426 @cindex spam
24427
24428 @defvar spam-use-ifile
24429
24430 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
24431 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
24432
24433 @end defvar
24434
24435 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
24436
24437 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
24438 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
24439 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
24440
24441 @end defvar
24442
24443 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
24444
24445 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
24446 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
24447 the default value of @samp{spam}.
24448 @end defvar
24449
24450 @defvar spam-ifile-database
24451
24452 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
24453 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
24454
24455 @end defvar
24456
24457 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
24458 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
24459 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
24460 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
24461 functionality.
24462
24463 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
24464 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
24465 @cindex spam filtering
24466 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
24467 @cindex spam-stat
24468 @cindex spam
24469
24470 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
24471 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
24472 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
24473 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
24474 spam-stat dictionary}.
24475
24476 @defvar spam-use-stat
24477
24478 @end defvar
24479
24480 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
24481 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24482 customizing the group parameters or the
24483 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24484 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24485 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
24486
24487 @emph{WARNING}
24488
24489 Instead of the obsolete
24490 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
24491 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
24492 the same way, we promise.
24493 @end defvar
24494
24495 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
24496 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24497 customizing the group parameters or the
24498 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24499 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
24500 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
24501 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
24502 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24503
24504 @emph{WARNING}
24505
24506 Instead of the obsolete
24507 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
24508 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
24509 the same way, we promise.
24510 @end defvar
24511
24512 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
24513 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
24514 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
24515 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
24516 @code{spam-split} are provided.
24517
24518 @node SpamOracle
24519 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
24520 @cindex spam filtering
24521 @cindex SpamOracle
24522 @cindex spam
24523
24524 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
24525 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
24526 installed separately.
24527
24528 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
24529 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
24530 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
24531 mail as a spam mail or not.
24532
24533 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
24534 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
24535 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
24536
24537 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
24538 call SpamOracle.
24539
24540 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
24541 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
24542 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
24543 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
24544 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
24545 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
24546 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
24547 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
24548
24549 @example
24550 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
24551 spam-split-group "Junk"
24552 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
24553 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
24554 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
24555 @end example
24556
24557 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
24558 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
24559 SpamOracle.
24560 @end defvar
24561
24562 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
24563 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
24564 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
24565 can be customized.
24566 @end defvar
24567
24568 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
24569 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
24570 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
24571 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
24572 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
24573 database to live somewhere special, set
24574 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
24575 @end defvar
24576
24577 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
24578 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
24579 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
24580 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
24581 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
24582 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
24583 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
24584 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
24585 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
24586 @xref{Spam Package}.
24587
24588 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
24589 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24590 customizing the group parameter or the
24591 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24592 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
24593 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
24594
24595 @emph{WARNING}
24596
24597 Instead of the obsolete
24598 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24599 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24600 the same way, we promise.
24601 @end defvar
24602
24603 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
24604 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24605 customizing the group parameter or the
24606 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24607 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
24608 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
24609 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
24610 @emph{unclassified} groups.
24611
24612 @emph{WARNING}
24613
24614 Instead of the obsolete
24615 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24616 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24617 the same way, we promise.
24618 @end defvar
24619
24620 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
24621 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
24622 messages.
24623 @example
24624 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
24625 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
24626 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
24627 @end example
24628 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
24629 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
24630 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
24631 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
24632 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
24633 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
24634
24635 @node Extending the Spam package
24636 @subsection Extending the Spam package
24637 @cindex spam filtering
24638 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
24639 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
24640
24641 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
24642 incoming mail, provide the following:
24643
24644 @enumerate
24645
24646 @item
24647 Code
24648
24649 @lisp
24650 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
24651 "True if blackbox should be used.")
24652 @end lisp
24653
24654 Add
24655 @lisp
24656 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
24657 @end lisp
24658 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
24659
24660 Add
24661 @lisp
24662 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
24663 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
24664 @end lisp
24665
24666 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
24667
24668 Add
24669 @lisp
24670 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
24671 nil
24672 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
24673 nil)
24674 @end lisp
24675
24676 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
24677 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
24678 start, or other register/unregister routines more appropriate to
24679 Blackbox.
24680
24681 @item
24682 Functionality
24683
24684 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
24685 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
24686 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
24687 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
24688 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
24689
24690 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
24691 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
24692 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
24693
24694 @end enumerate
24695
24696 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
24697
24698 @enumerate
24699
24700 @item
24701 Code
24702
24703 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
24704 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
24705
24706 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
24707 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
24708 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
24709 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
24710
24711 @lisp
24712 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
24713 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
24714 Only applicable to spam groups.")
24715
24716 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
24717 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
24718 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
24719
24720 @end lisp
24721
24722 @item
24723 Gnus parameters
24724
24725 Add
24726 @lisp
24727 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
24728 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
24729 @end lisp
24730 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
24731 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
24732 variable customization.
24733
24734 Add
24735 @lisp
24736 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
24737 @end lisp
24738 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
24739 @code{gnus.el}.
24740
24741 @end enumerate
24742
24743 @node Spam Statistics Package
24744 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
24745 @cindex Paul Graham
24746 @cindex Graham, Paul
24747 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
24748 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
24749 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
24750
24751 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
24752 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
24753 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
24754 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
24755 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
24756 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
24757 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
24758 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
24759 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
24760 or not.
24761
24762 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
24763 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
24764 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
24765 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
24766 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
24767 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
24768 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
24769 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
24770
24771 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
24772 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
24773 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
24774
24775 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
24776 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
24777 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
24778 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24779 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24780
24781 @menu
24782 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24783 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24784 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24785 @end menu
24786
24787 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24788 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24789
24790 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24791 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24792 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24793 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24794 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24795
24796 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24797 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24798 per mail. Use the following:
24799
24800 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24801 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24802 is treated as one spam mail.
24803 @end defun
24804
24805 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24806 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24807 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24808 @end defun
24809
24810 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24811 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
24812 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24813 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24814 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
24815 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24816
24817 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24818 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24819 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24820 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24821 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24822
24823 @defvar spam-stat
24824 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24825 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24826 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24827 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24828 @end defvar
24829
24830 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24831 reset the dictionary.
24832
24833 @defun spam-stat-reset
24834 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24835 @end defun
24836
24837 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24838 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24839 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24840 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24841 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24842 only non-spam mails.
24843
24844 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24845 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24846 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24847 @end defun
24848
24849 @defun spam-stat-save
24850 Save the dictionary.
24851 @end defun
24852
24853 @defvar spam-stat-file
24854 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24855 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24856 @end defvar
24857
24858 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24859 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24860
24861 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
24862 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
24863
24864 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24865
24866 @lisp
24867 (require 'spam-stat)
24868 (spam-stat-load)
24869 @end lisp
24870
24871 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24872 created.
24873
24874 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24875 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24876 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24877 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24878
24879 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24880 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24881 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24882 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24883
24884 @lisp
24885 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24886 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24887 "mail.misc"))
24888 @end lisp
24889
24890 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24891 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24892 @end defvar
24893
24894 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24895 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24896 expression are considered potential spam.
24897
24898 @lisp
24899 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24900 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24901 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24902 "mail.misc"))
24903 @end lisp
24904
24905 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24906 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24907 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24908 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24909 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24910
24911 @lisp
24912 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24913 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24914 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24915 "mail.misc"))
24916 @end lisp
24917
24918 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24919 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24920 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24921 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24922 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24923 dictionary!
24924
24925 @lisp
24926 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24927 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24928 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24929 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24930 "mail.misc"))
24931 @end lisp
24932
24933
24934 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24935 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
24936
24937 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
24938
24939 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
24940 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
24941 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24942 @end defun
24943
24944 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
24945 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
24946 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
24947 @end defun
24948
24949 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
24950 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
24951 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
24952 already been processed as non-spam.
24953 @end defun
24954
24955 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
24956 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
24957 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
24958 been processed as spam.
24959 @end defun
24960
24961 @defun spam-stat-save
24962 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
24963 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24964 @end defun
24965
24966 @defun spam-stat-load
24967 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
24968 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
24969 @end defun
24970
24971 @defun spam-stat-score-word
24972 Return the spam score for a word.
24973 @end defun
24974
24975 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
24976 Return the spam score for a buffer.
24977 @end defun
24978
24979 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
24980 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
24981 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
24982 @end defun
24983
24984 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
24985 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24986
24987 @lisp
24988 (require 'spam-stat)
24989 (spam-stat-load)
24990 @end lisp
24991
24992 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
24993
24994 @smallexample
24995 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
24996 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
24997 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
24998 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
24999 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25000 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25001 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25002 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25003 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25004 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25005 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25006 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25007 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25008 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25009 @end smallexample
25010
25011 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25012
25013 @smallexample
25014 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25015 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25016 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25017 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25018 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25019 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25020 @end smallexample
25021
25022 @node Other modes
25023 @section Interaction with other modes
25024
25025 @subsection Dired
25026 @cindex dired
25027
25028 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
25029 buffers. It is enabled with
25030 @lisp
25031 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
25032 @end lisp
25033
25034 @table @kbd
25035 @item C-c C-m C-a
25036 @findex gnus-dired-attach
25037 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
25038 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
25039 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
25040
25041 @item C-c C-m C-l
25042 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
25043 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
25044 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
25045 buffer.
25046
25047 @item C-c C-m C-p
25048 @findex gnus-dired-print
25049 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
25050 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
25051 @end table
25052
25053 @node Various Various
25054 @section Various Various
25055 @cindex mode lines
25056 @cindex highlights
25057
25058 @table @code
25059
25060 @item gnus-home-directory
25061 @vindex gnus-home-directory
25062 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
25063 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
25064
25065 @item gnus-directory
25066 @vindex gnus-directory
25067 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
25068 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
25069 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
25070
25071 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
25072 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
25073 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
25074 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
25075
25076 @item gnus-default-directory
25077 @vindex gnus-default-directory
25078 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
25079 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
25080 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
25081 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
25082 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
25083 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
25084
25085 @item gnus-verbose
25086 @vindex gnus-verbose
25087 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
25088 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
25089 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
25090 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
25091 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
25092
25093 @item gnus-verbose-backends
25094 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
25095 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
25096 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
25097
25098 @item nnheader-max-head-length
25099 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
25100 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
25101 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
25102 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
25103 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
25104 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
25105 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
25106 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
25107 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
25108
25109 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
25110 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
25111 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
25112 read when doing the operation described above.
25113
25114 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
25115 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
25116 @cindex file names
25117 @cindex invalid characters in file names
25118 @cindex characters in file names
25119 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
25120 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
25121 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
25122
25123 @lisp
25124 @group
25125 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
25126 '((?: . ?_)))
25127 @end group
25128 @end lisp
25129
25130 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
25131 Windows (phooey) systems.
25132
25133 @item gnus-hidden-properties
25134 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
25135 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
25136 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
25137 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
25138
25139 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
25140 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
25141 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
25142 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
25143 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
25144
25145 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
25146 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
25147 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
25148
25149 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
25150 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
25151
25152 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
25153 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
25154 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
25155 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
25156 group).
25157
25158 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
25159
25160
25161 @end table
25162
25163 @node The End
25164 @chapter The End
25165
25166 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
25167 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
25168
25169 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
25170
25171 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
25172
25173 @quotation
25174 @strong{Te Deum}
25175
25176 @sp 1
25177 Not because of victories @*
25178 I sing,@*
25179 having none,@*
25180 but for the common sunshine,@*
25181 the breeze,@*
25182 the largess of the spring.
25183
25184 @sp 1
25185 Not for victory@*
25186 but for the day's work done@*
25187 as well as I was able;@*
25188 not for a seat upon the dais@*
25189 but at the common table.@*
25190 @end quotation
25191
25192
25193 @node Appendices
25194 @chapter Appendices
25195
25196 @menu
25197 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
25198 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
25199 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
25200 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
25201 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
25202 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
25203 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
25204 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
25205 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
25206 @end menu
25207
25208
25209 @node XEmacs
25210 @section XEmacs
25211 @cindex XEmacs
25212 @cindex installing under XEmacs
25213
25214 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
25215 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
25216 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
25217 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
25218 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
25219 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
25220
25221
25222 @node History
25223 @section History
25224
25225 @cindex history
25226 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
25227 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
25228
25229 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
25230 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
25231 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
25232 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
25233 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
25234
25235 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
25236 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
25237 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
25238 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
25239 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
25240 appropriate name, don't you think?)
25241
25242 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
25243 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
25244 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
25245 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
25246
25247 @menu
25248 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
25249 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
25250 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
25251 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
25252 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
25253 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
25254 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
25255 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
25256 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
25257 @end menu
25258
25259
25260 @node Gnus Versions
25261 @subsection Gnus Versions
25262 @cindex ding Gnus
25263 @cindex September Gnus
25264 @cindex Red Gnus
25265 @cindex Quassia Gnus
25266 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
25267 @cindex Oort Gnus
25268 @cindex No Gnus
25269 @cindex Gnus versions
25270
25271 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
25272 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
25273 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
25274
25275 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
25276 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
25277
25278 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
25279 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
25280
25281 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
25282 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
25283
25284 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
25285 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
25286 1999.
25287
25288 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
25289 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
25290
25291 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
25292
25293 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
25294 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
25295 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
25296 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
25297 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
25298 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
25299
25300
25301 @node Other Gnus Versions
25302 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
25303 @cindex Semi-gnus
25304
25305 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
25306 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
25307 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
25308 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
25309
25310 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
25311 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
25312 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
25313 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
25314 Japanese users.
25315
25316
25317 @node Why?
25318 @subsection Why?
25319
25320 What's the point of Gnus?
25321
25322 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
25323 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
25324 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
25325 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
25326 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
25327 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
25328 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
25329 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
25330 keep track of millions of people who post?
25331
25332 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
25333 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
25334 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
25335 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
25336 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
25337 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
25338 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
25339 every one of you to explore and invent.
25340
25341 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
25342 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
25343
25344
25345 @node Compatibility
25346 @subsection Compatibility
25347
25348 @cindex compatibility
25349 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
25350 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
25351 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
25352
25353 Our motto is:
25354 @quotation
25355 @cartouche
25356 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
25357 @end cartouche
25358 @end quotation
25359
25360 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
25361 their names.
25362
25363 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
25364 Articles}.
25365
25366 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
25367 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
25368 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
25369 important variables have their values copied into their global
25370 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
25371 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
25372
25373 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
25374 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
25375 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
25376 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
25377 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
25378 peculiar results.
25379
25380 @cindex hilit19
25381 @cindex highlighting
25382 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
25383 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
25384 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
25385 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
25386 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
25387 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
25388 Away!
25389
25390 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
25391 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
25392 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
25393 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
25394
25395 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
25396 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
25397 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
25398 to stop doing it the old way.
25399
25400 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
25401
25402 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
25403 @findex gnus-bug
25404 @cindex reporting bugs
25405 @cindex bugs
25406 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
25407 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
25408 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
25409
25410 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
25411 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
25412 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
25413 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
25414 up at you.
25415
25416
25417 @node Conformity
25418 @subsection Conformity
25419
25420 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
25421 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
25422 with, of course.
25423
25424 @table @strong
25425
25426 @item RFC (2)822
25427 @cindex RFC 822
25428 @cindex RFC 2822
25429 There are no known breaches of this standard.
25430
25431 @item RFC 1036
25432 @cindex RFC 1036
25433 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
25434
25435 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
25436 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
25437 We do have some breaches to this one.
25438
25439 @table @emph
25440
25441 @item X-Newsreader
25442 @itemx User-Agent
25443 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
25444 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
25445 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
25446 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
25447 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
25448 @end table
25449
25450 @item USEFOR
25451 @cindex USEFOR
25452 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
25453 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
25454 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
25455 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
25456
25457 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
25458 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
25459 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
25460
25461 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
25462 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
25463
25464 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
25465 @cindex RFC 1991
25466 @cindex RFC 2440
25467 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
25468 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
25469 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
25470 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
25471 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
25472 decryption).
25473
25474 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
25475 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
25476 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
25477 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
25478
25479 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
25480 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
25481
25482 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
25483 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
25484 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
25485 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
25486 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
25487 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
25488 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
25489 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
25490
25491 @end table
25492
25493 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
25494 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
25495 know.
25496
25497
25498 @node Emacsen
25499 @subsection Emacsen
25500 @cindex Emacsen
25501 @cindex XEmacs
25502 @cindex Mule
25503 @cindex Emacs
25504
25505 Gnus should work on:
25506
25507 @itemize @bullet
25508
25509 @item
25510 Emacs 21.1 and up.
25511
25512 @item
25513 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
25514
25515 @end itemize
25516
25517 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
25518 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
25519 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
25520 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
25521
25522 There are some vague differences between Gnus on the various
25523 platforms---XEmacs features more graphics (a logo and a toolbar)---but
25524 other than that, things should look pretty much the same under all
25525 Emacsen.
25526
25527
25528 @node Gnus Development
25529 @subsection Gnus Development
25530
25531 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
25532 discussion on the @samp{ding@@gnus.org} mailing list, where people
25533 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
25534 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
25535 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
25536 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
25537 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
25538 have names like ``Red Gnus'' and ``Quassia Gnus''.
25539
25540 After futzing around for 50-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
25541 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
25542 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.6.32'' instead. Normal people are
25543 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
25544 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup.
25545
25546 @cindex Incoming*
25547 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
25548 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae.
25549 In particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{nil} in
25550 alpha Gnusae and @code{t} in released Gnusae. This is to prevent
25551 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
25552
25553 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
25554 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
25555 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
25556 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
25557 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
25558 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
25559 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
25560 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
25561 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
25562 can't be assumed to do so.
25563
25564
25565
25566 @node Contributors
25567 @subsection Contributors
25568 @cindex contributors
25569
25570 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
25571 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
25572 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
25573 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
25574 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
25575 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
25576 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
25577 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
25578 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
25579 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
25580
25581 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
25582 wrong show.
25583
25584 @itemize @bullet
25585
25586 @item
25587 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
25588
25589 @item
25590 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
25591 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
25592 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
25593 functionality and stuff.
25594
25595 @item
25596 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
25597 well as numerous other things).
25598
25599 @item
25600 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
25601
25602 @item
25603 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
25604
25605 @item
25606 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
25607
25608 @item
25609 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
25610
25611 @item
25612 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
25613 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
25614
25615 @item
25616 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
25617
25618 @item
25619 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
25620 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25621
25622 @item
25623 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
25624
25625 @item
25626 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
25627
25628 @item
25629 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
25630
25631 @item
25632 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
25633
25634 @item
25635 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
25636 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
25637
25638 @item
25639 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
25640
25641 @item
25642 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
25643
25644 @item
25645 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
25646
25647 @item
25648 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
25649 .newsrc files.
25650
25651 @item
25652 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
25653
25654 @item
25655 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
25656
25657 @item
25658 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
25659
25660 @item
25661 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
25662 well as autoconf support.
25663
25664 @end itemize
25665
25666 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
25667 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
25668
25669 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
25670
25671 Christopher Davis,
25672 Andrew Eskilsson,
25673 Kai Grossjohann,
25674 Kevin Greiner,
25675 Jesper Harder,
25676 Paul Jarc,
25677 Simon Josefsson,
25678 David KÃ¥gedal,
25679 Richard Pieri,
25680 Fabrice Popineau,
25681 Daniel Quinlan,
25682 Michael Shields,
25683 Reiner Steib,
25684 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
25685 Jack Vinson,
25686 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
25687 and
25688 Teodor Zlatanov.
25689
25690 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
25691
25692 Jari Aalto,
25693 Adrian Aichner,
25694 Vladimir Alexiev,
25695 Russ Allbery,
25696 Peter Arius,
25697 Matt Armstrong,
25698 Marc Auslander,
25699 Miles Bader,
25700 Alexei V. Barantsev,
25701 Frank Bennett,
25702 Robert Bihlmeyer,
25703 Chris Bone,
25704 Mark Borges,
25705 Mark Boyns,
25706 Lance A. Brown,
25707 Rob Browning,
25708 Kees de Bruin,
25709 Martin Buchholz,
25710 Joe Buehler,
25711 Kevin Buhr,
25712 Alastair Burt,
25713 Joao Cachopo,
25714 Zlatko Calusic,
25715 Massimo Campostrini,
25716 Castor,
25717 David Charlap,
25718 Dan Christensen,
25719 Kevin Christian,
25720 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
25721 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
25722 Laura Conrad,
25723 Michael R. Cook,
25724 Glenn Coombs,
25725 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
25726 Neil Crellin,
25727 Frank D. Cringle,
25728 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
25729 Andre Deparade,
25730 Ulrik Dickow,
25731 Dave Disser,
25732 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
25733 Joev Dubach,
25734 Michael Welsh Duggan,
25735 Dave Edmondson,
25736 Paul Eggert,
25737 Mark W. Eichin,
25738 Karl Eichwalder,
25739 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
25740 Michael Ernst,
25741 Luc Van Eycken,
25742 Sam Falkner,
25743 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
25744 Sigbjorn Finne,
25745 Sven Fischer,
25746 Paul Fisher,
25747 Decklin Foster,
25748 Gary D. Foster,
25749 Paul Franklin,
25750 Guy Geens,
25751 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
25752 David S. Goldberg,
25753 Michelangelo Grigni,
25754 Dale Hagglund,
25755 D. Hall,
25756 Magnus Hammerin,
25757 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
25758 Raja R. Harinath,
25759 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
25760 P. E. Jareth Hein,
25761 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
25762 Scott Hofmann,
25763 Marc Horowitz,
25764 Gunnar Horrigmo,
25765 Richard Hoskins,
25766 Brad Howes,
25767 Miguel de Icaza,
25768 François Felix Ingrand,
25769 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
25770 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
25771 Lee Iverson,
25772 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
25773 Rajappa Iyer,
25774 Andreas Jaeger,
25775 Adam P. Jenkins,
25776 Randell Jesup,
25777 Fred Johansen,
25778 Gareth Jones,
25779 Greg Klanderman,
25780 Karl Kleinpaste,
25781 Michael Klingbeil,
25782 Peter Skov Knudsen,
25783 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
25784 Petr Konecny,
25785 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25786 Thor Kristoffersen,
25787 Jens Lautenbacher,
25788 Martin Larose,
25789 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25790 Joerg Lenneis,
25791 Carsten Leonhardt,
25792 James LewisMoss,
25793 Christian Limpach,
25794 Markus Linnala,
25795 Dave Love,
25796 Mike McEwan,
25797 Tonny Madsen,
25798 Shlomo Mahlab,
25799 Nat Makarevitch,
25800 Istvan Marko,
25801 David Martin,
25802 Jason R. Mastaler,
25803 Gordon Matzigkeit,
25804 Timo Metzemakers,
25805 Richard Mlynarik,
25806 Lantz Moore,
25807 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25808 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25809 Hrvoje Niksic,
25810 Andy Norman,
25811 Fred Oberhauser,
25812 C. R. Oldham,
25813 Alexandre Oliva,
25814 Ken Olstad,
25815 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25816 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
25817 Ettore Perazzoli,
25818 William Perry,
25819 Stephen Peters,
25820 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25821 Ulrich Pfeifer,
25822 Matt Pharr,
25823 Andy Piper,
25824 John McClary Prevost,
25825 Bill Pringlemeir,
25826 Mike Pullen,
25827 Jim Radford,
25828 Colin Rafferty,
25829 Lasse Rasinen,
25830 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25831 Joe Reiss,
25832 Renaud Rioboo,
25833 Roland B. Roberts,
25834 Bart Robinson,
25835 Christian von Roques,
25836 Markus Rost,
25837 Jason Rumney,
25838 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25839 Jay Sachs,
25840 Dewey M. Sasser,
25841 Conrad Sauerwald,
25842 Loren Schall,
25843 Dan Schmidt,
25844 Ralph Schleicher,
25845 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25846 Andreas Schwab,
25847 Randal L. Schwartz,
25848 Danny Siu,
25849 Matt Simmons,
25850 Paul D. Smith,
25851 Jeff Sparkes,
25852 Toby Speight,
25853 Michael Sperber,
25854 Darren Stalder,
25855 Richard Stallman,
25856 Greg Stark,
25857 Sam Steingold,
25858 Paul Stevenson,
25859 Jonas Steverud,
25860 Paul Stodghill,
25861 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25862 Kurt Swanson,
25863 Samuel Tardieu,
25864 Teddy,
25865 Chuck Thompson,
25866 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25867 Philippe Troin,
25868 James Troup,
25869 Trung Tran-Duc,
25870 Jack Twilley,
25871 Aaron M. Ucko,
25872 Aki Vehtari,
25873 Didier Verna,
25874 Vladimir Volovich,
25875 Jan Vroonhof,
25876 Stefan Waldherr,
25877 Pete Ware,
25878 Barry A. Warsaw,
25879 Christoph Wedler,
25880 Joe Wells,
25881 Lee Willis,
25882 and
25883 Lloyd Zusman.
25884
25885
25886 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25887 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25888 (550kB and counting).
25889
25890 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25891 sure.
25892
25893 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25894 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25895
25896
25897 @node New Features
25898 @subsection New Features
25899 @cindex new features
25900
25901 @menu
25902 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25903 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25904 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25905 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25906 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25907 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25908 @end menu
25909
25910 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25911 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25912 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25913
25914 @node ding Gnus
25915 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25916
25917 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25918
25919 @itemize @bullet
25920
25921 @item
25922 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25923 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25924
25925 @item
25926 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25927 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25928
25929 @item
25930 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25931
25932 @item
25933 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
25934 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
25935 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
25936
25937 @item
25938 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
25939 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
25940 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
25941 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
25942
25943 @item
25944 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
25945 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25946
25947 @item
25948 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
25949 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
25950 (@pxref{The Active File}).
25951
25952 @item
25953 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
25954 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
25955
25956 @item
25957 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
25958 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
25959 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
25960
25961 @item
25962 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
25963 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
25964 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
25965
25966 @item
25967 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
25968 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
25969
25970 @item
25971 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
25972 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
25973
25974 @item
25975 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
25976 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
25977
25978 @item
25979 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
25980 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
25981
25982 @item
25983 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
25984 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
25985
25986 @item
25987 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
25988 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
25989
25990 @item
25991 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
25992
25993 @item
25994 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
25995 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
25996
25997 @item
25998 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
25999 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
26000
26001 @item
26002 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
26003 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
26004
26005 @item
26006 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
26007
26008 @item
26009 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
26010 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
26011
26012 @item
26013 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
26014 Articles}).
26015
26016 @item
26017 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
26018 Buttons}).
26019
26020 @item
26021 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
26022 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
26023
26024 @item
26025 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
26026 (@pxref{Buttons}).
26027
26028 @end itemize
26029
26030
26031 @node September Gnus
26032 @subsubsection September Gnus
26033
26034 @iftex
26035 @iflatex
26036 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
26037 @end iflatex
26038 @end iftex
26039
26040 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
26041
26042 @itemize @bullet
26043
26044 @item
26045 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
26046 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
26047 now obsolete.
26048
26049 @item
26050 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
26051 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
26052 Threading}).
26053
26054 @lisp
26055 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
26056 @end lisp
26057
26058 @item
26059 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
26060 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
26061
26062 @item
26063 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
26064 referred.
26065
26066 @item
26067 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
26068
26069 @item
26070 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
26071
26072 @item
26073 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
26074
26075 @lisp
26076 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
26077 @end lisp
26078
26079 @item
26080 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
26081 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
26082
26083 @lisp
26084 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
26085 @end lisp
26086
26087 @item
26088 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
26089 Groups}).
26090
26091 @item
26092 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
26093 Topics}).
26094
26095 @lisp
26096 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
26097 @end lisp
26098
26099 @item
26100 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
26101
26102 @item
26103 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
26104 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
26105
26106 @lisp
26107 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
26108 @end lisp
26109
26110 @item
26111 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
26112 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
26113
26114 @item
26115 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
26116
26117 @item
26118 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
26119 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
26120 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
26121
26122 @item
26123 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
26124 (@pxref{SOUP}).
26125
26126 @item
26127 The Gnus cache is much faster.
26128
26129 @item
26130 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
26131 Groups}).
26132
26133 @item
26134 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
26135 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
26136
26137 @item
26138 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
26139 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
26140
26141 @item
26142 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
26143 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
26144
26145 @item
26146 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
26147 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
26148 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
26149
26150 @item
26151 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
26152 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
26153
26154 @item
26155 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
26156
26157 @item
26158 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
26159
26160 @item
26161 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
26162
26163 @item
26164 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
26165
26166 @item
26167 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
26168 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
26169
26170 @item
26171 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
26172 Layout}).
26173
26174 @item
26175 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
26176 @iftex
26177 @iflatex
26178 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
26179 @end iflatex
26180 @end iftex
26181
26182 @item
26183 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
26184
26185 @lisp
26186 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
26187 @end lisp
26188
26189 @item
26190 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
26191
26192 @lisp
26193 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
26194 @end lisp
26195
26196 @item
26197 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
26198
26199 @item
26200 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
26201
26202 @item
26203 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
26204 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
26205
26206 @lisp
26207 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
26208 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
26209 @end lisp
26210
26211 @item
26212 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
26213 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
26214
26215 @lisp
26216 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
26217 @end lisp
26218
26219 @item
26220 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
26221 buffer to allow easier treatment.
26222
26223 @item
26224 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
26225
26226 @item
26227 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
26228 Articles}).
26229
26230 @lisp
26231 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
26232 @end lisp
26233
26234 @item
26235 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
26236 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
26237
26238 @lisp
26239 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
26240 @end lisp
26241
26242 @item
26243 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
26244 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
26245
26246 @item
26247 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
26248 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
26249
26250 @lisp
26251 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
26252 @end lisp
26253
26254 @item
26255 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
26256
26257 @item
26258 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
26259
26260 @item
26261 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
26262
26263 @end itemize
26264
26265
26266 @node Red Gnus
26267 @subsubsection Red Gnus
26268
26269 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
26270
26271 @iftex
26272 @iflatex
26273 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
26274 @end iflatex
26275 @end iftex
26276
26277 @itemize @bullet
26278
26279 @item
26280 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
26281
26282 @item
26283 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
26284 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
26285
26286 @item
26287 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
26288 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
26289 Scoring}).
26290
26291 @item
26292 Article washing status can be displayed in the
26293 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
26294
26295 @item
26296 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
26297
26298 @item
26299 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
26300 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
26301
26302 @lisp
26303 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
26304 @end lisp
26305
26306 @item
26307 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
26308 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
26309 been added.
26310
26311 @item
26312 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
26313 Server Internals}).
26314
26315 @item
26316 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
26317 Parameters}).
26318
26319 @item
26320 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
26321
26322 @item
26323 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
26324 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
26325
26326 @item
26327 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
26328 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
26329 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
26330
26331 @item
26332 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
26333 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
26334
26335 @item
26336 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
26337 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
26338
26339 @item
26340 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
26341 (@pxref{Undo}).
26342
26343 @item
26344 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
26345 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
26346
26347 @item
26348 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
26349 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
26350
26351 @lisp
26352 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
26353 @end lisp
26354
26355 @item
26356 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
26357
26358 @lisp
26359 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
26360 @end lisp
26361
26362 @item
26363 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
26364 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
26365
26366 @item
26367 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
26368 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
26369
26370 @item
26371 A new command for reading collections of documents
26372 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
26373 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
26374
26375 @item
26376 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
26377 Marks}).
26378
26379 @item
26380 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
26381 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
26382
26383 @item
26384 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
26385 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
26386 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
26387
26388 @item
26389 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
26390 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
26391 Sorting}).
26392
26393 @item
26394 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
26395 Groups}).
26396
26397 @item
26398 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
26399 Commands}).
26400 @iftex
26401 @iflatex
26402 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
26403 @end iflatex
26404 @end iftex
26405
26406 @item
26407 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
26408 Variables}).
26409
26410 @item
26411 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
26412 Mail}).
26413
26414 @item
26415 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
26416 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
26417
26418 @item
26419 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
26420
26421 @end itemize
26422
26423
26424 @node Quassia Gnus
26425 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
26426
26427 New features in Gnus 5.6:
26428
26429 @itemize @bullet
26430
26431 @item
26432 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
26433 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
26434 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
26435
26436 @item
26437 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
26438 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
26439 group, which is created automatically.
26440
26441 @item
26442 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
26443 values.
26444
26445 @item
26446 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
26447
26448 @item
26449 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
26450 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
26451
26452 @item
26453 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
26454 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
26455
26456 @item
26457 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
26458
26459 @item
26460 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
26461 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
26462
26463 @item
26464 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
26465
26466 @item
26467 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
26468 details.
26469
26470 @item
26471 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
26472 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
26473
26474 @item
26475 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
26476 control over simplification.
26477
26478 @item
26479 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
26480
26481 @item
26482 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
26483 limit.
26484
26485 @item
26486 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
26487
26488 @item
26489 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
26490
26491 @item
26492 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
26493 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
26494 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
26495
26496 @item
26497 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
26498 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
26499
26500 @item
26501 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
26502 text---@kbd{W d}.
26503
26504 @item
26505 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
26506 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
26507
26508 @item
26509 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
26510 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
26511
26512 @item
26513 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
26514 has been added.
26515
26516 @item
26517 A history of where mails have been split is available.
26518
26519 @item
26520 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
26521
26522 @item
26523 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
26524 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
26525
26526 @item
26527 A new function for citing in Message has been
26528 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
26529
26530 @item
26531 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
26532
26533 @item
26534 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
26535 been added.
26536
26537 @item
26538 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
26539 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
26540
26541 @item
26542 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
26543 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
26544
26545 @item
26546 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
26547
26548 @item
26549 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
26550
26551 @end itemize
26552
26553 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
26554 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
26555
26556 New features in Gnus 5.8:
26557
26558 @itemize @bullet
26559
26560 @item
26561 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
26562 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
26563
26564 If you used procmail like in
26565
26566 @lisp
26567 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
26568 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
26569 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
26570 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
26571 @end lisp
26572
26573 this now has changed to
26574
26575 @lisp
26576 (setq mail-sources
26577 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
26578 :suffix ".in")))
26579 @end lisp
26580
26581 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
26582
26583 @item
26584 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
26585 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
26586
26587 @item
26588 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
26589 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
26590
26591 @item
26592 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
26593 called to position point.
26594
26595 @item
26596 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
26597 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
26598
26599 @item
26600 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
26601 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
26602
26603 @item
26604 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
26605 subtly different manner.
26606
26607 @item
26608 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
26609 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
26610 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
26611
26612 @item
26613 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
26614
26615 @end itemize
26616
26617 @node Oort Gnus
26618 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
26619 @cindex Oort Gnus
26620
26621 New features in Gnus 5.10:
26622
26623 @itemize @bullet
26624
26625 @item Installation changes
26626 @c ***********************
26627
26628 @itemize @bullet
26629 @item
26630 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
26631
26632 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
26633 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
26634 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
26635 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
26636 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
26637 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
26638 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
26639 isn't save in general.
26640
26641 @item
26642 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
26643 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
26644 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
26645 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
26646 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
26647 remove-installed-shadows}.
26648
26649 @item
26650 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
26651
26652 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
26653 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
26654 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, iff you want
26655 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
26656 the second parameter.
26657
26658 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
26659 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
26660 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
26661 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
26662 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
26663 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
26664 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
26665 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
26666 cycle used under Unix systems.
26667
26668 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
26669 superfluous, so they have been removed.
26670
26671 @item
26672 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26673
26674 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26675 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26676 hierarchy.
26677
26678 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
26679 @c CVS. We should find a better place for this item.
26680 @item
26681 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26682
26683 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26684 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26685 lisp directory into load-path.
26686
26687 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26688 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26689
26690 @end itemize
26691
26692 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
26693 @c *****************************************
26694
26695 @itemize @bullet
26696
26697 @item
26698 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
26699 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
26700
26701 @item
26702 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
26703
26704 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
26705 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
26706 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
26707 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
26708
26709 @item
26710 Improved anti-spam features.
26711
26712 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26713 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26714 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26715 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26716 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26717 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
26718
26719 @item
26720 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26721
26722 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26723 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26724 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26725 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26726 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26727
26728 @end itemize
26729
26730 @item Changes in group mode
26731 @c ************************
26732
26733 @itemize @bullet
26734
26735 @item
26736 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
26737 using @kbd{G M}.
26738
26739 @item
26740 Retrieval of charters and control messages
26741
26742 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
26743 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
26744
26745 @item
26746 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26747
26748 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26749 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26750 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26751 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26752 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26753 parameters, a'la:
26754 @lisp
26755 (setq gnus-parameters
26756 '(("mail\\..*"
26757 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26758 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26759 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26760 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26761 @end lisp
26762
26763 @item
26764 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26765
26766 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26767 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26768 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26769 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26770 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26771 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26772 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26773 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26774 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26775
26776 @item
26777 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26778
26779 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26780 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26781 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26782
26783 @item
26784 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26785 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26786
26787 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26788 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26789 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26790 @lisp
26791 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26792 @end lisp
26793
26794 @end itemize
26795
26796 @item Changes in summary and article mode
26797 @c **************************************
26798
26799 @itemize @bullet
26800
26801 @item
26802 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
26803 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
26804 region if the region is active.
26805
26806 @item
26807 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
26808 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
26809
26810 @item
26811 Article Buttons
26812
26813 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
26814 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
26815 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
26816 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
26817
26818 @item
26819 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
26820
26821 @item
26822 Picons
26823
26824 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
26825 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
26826
26827 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
26828 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
26829 @xref{Picons}.
26830
26831 @item
26832 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
26833 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
26834
26835 @item
26836 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
26837
26838 @item
26839 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
26840 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
26841
26842 @item
26843 Warn about email replies to news
26844
26845 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
26846 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
26847 you.
26848
26849 @item
26850 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
26851 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
26852 built.
26853
26854 @item
26855 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
26856 opposed to old but unread messages).
26857
26858 @item
26859 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
26860 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
26861
26862 @item
26863 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
26864 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
26865
26866 @item
26867 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
26868 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
26869
26870 @item
26871 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26872
26873 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26874 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26875 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26876 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26877 citations.
26878
26879 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
26880 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
26881 Outlook (Express) articles.
26882
26883 @item
26884 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26885
26886 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26887 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26888 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26889 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26890
26891 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26892 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26893 message cited below.
26894
26895 @item
26896 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
26897 Emacs too.
26898
26899 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26900 disable it.
26901
26902 @item
26903 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
26904
26905 @item
26906 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26907 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26908
26909 @item
26910 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26911
26912 @item
26913 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26914
26915 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26916 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26917 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26918 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26919 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26920 groups.
26921
26922 @item
26923 Deleting of attachments.
26924
26925 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26926 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
26927 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
26928 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
26929 that support editing.
26930
26931 @item
26932 @code{gnus-default-charset}
26933
26934 The default value is determined from the
26935 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
26936 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
26937 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
26938
26939 @item
26940 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
26941
26942 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
26943 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
26944 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
26945
26946 @item
26947 Extended format specs.
26948
26949 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
26950 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
26951 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
26952 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
26953 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
26954 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
26955
26956 @item
26957 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
26958 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
26959
26960 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
26961 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
26962 out other articles.
26963
26964 @item
26965 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
26966
26967 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
26968 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
26969 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
26970 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
26971
26972 @item
26973 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
26974
26975 @end itemize
26976
26977 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
26978 @c ****************************************************
26979
26980 @itemize @bullet
26981
26982 @item
26983 Delayed articles
26984
26985 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
26986 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
26987 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
26988
26989 @item
26990 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
26991 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
26992
26993 @item
26994 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
26995 Gcc articles as read.
26996
26997 @item
26998 Externalizing of attachments
26999
27000 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
27001 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
27002 local files as external parts.
27003
27004 @item
27005 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
27006 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
27007
27008 @item
27009 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
27010
27011 Earlier it was generated iff the user configurable email address was
27012 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
27013 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
27014 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
27015 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
27016 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
27017 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
27018 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
27019 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
27020
27021 @item
27022 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
27023
27024 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
27025 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
27026 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
27027 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
27028 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
27029 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
27030
27031 @item
27032 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
27033 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
27034 @code{nil}.
27035
27036 @item
27037 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
27038
27039 @item
27040 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
27041
27042 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
27043 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
27044 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
27045 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
27046 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
27047 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
27048 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
27049 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
27050 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
27051 was inserted directly.
27052
27053 @item
27054 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
27055
27056 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
27057 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
27058 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
27059 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
27060
27061 @item
27062 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
27063
27064 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
27065 @lisp
27066 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
27067 'bbdb-complete-name)
27068 @end lisp
27069
27070 @item
27071 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
27072
27073 Add a new format of match like
27074 @lisp
27075 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
27076 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
27077 @end lisp
27078 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
27079 @lisp
27080 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
27081 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
27082 @end lisp
27083
27084 @item
27085 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
27086
27087 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
27088 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
27089 need add those two headers too.
27090
27091 @item
27092 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
27093 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
27094 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
27095 versions.
27096
27097 @item
27098 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
27099 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
27100 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
27101 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
27102 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
27103
27104 @item
27105 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
27106
27107 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
27108
27109 @item
27110 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
27111
27112 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
27113 the valid values.
27114
27115 @item
27116 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
27117
27118 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
27119 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
27120 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
27121 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
27122 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
27123 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
27124 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
27125 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
27126
27127 @item
27128 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
27129 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
27130
27131 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
27132 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
27133 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
27134 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
27135
27136 @item
27137 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
27138 C-m}.
27139
27140 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
27141 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
27142
27143 @item
27144 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
27145 @code{best}.
27146
27147 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
27148 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
27149 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
27150 invalidate the digital signature.
27151
27152 @item
27153 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
27154 decompressed when activated.
27155 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
27156
27157 @item
27158 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
27159
27160 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
27161 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
27162 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
27163 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
27164 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
27165 controls this.
27166
27167 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
27168 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
27169 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
27170 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11
27171
27172 @end itemize
27173
27174 @item Changes in back ends
27175 @c ***********************
27176
27177 @itemize @bullet
27178 @item
27179 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
27180
27181 @item
27182 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
27183
27184 @item
27185 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
27186
27187 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
27188
27189 @item
27190 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
27191
27192 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
27193 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
27194 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
27195 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
27196 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
27197 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
27198 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
27199 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
27200 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
27201 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
27202 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
27203
27204 @end itemize
27205
27206 @item Appearance
27207 @c *************
27208
27209 @itemize @bullet
27210
27211 @item
27212 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
27213 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
27214
27215 @item
27216 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
27217 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
27218 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
27219 message, Message Manual}).
27220
27221 @item
27222 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
27223 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars. This is a new
27224 feature in Gnus 5.10.9. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
27225
27226 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
27227 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
27228 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
27229 in Gnus 5.10.9.
27230 @end itemize
27231
27232
27233 @item Miscellaneous changes
27234 @c ************************
27235
27236 @itemize @bullet
27237
27238 @item
27239 @code{gnus-agent}
27240
27241 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
27242 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
27243 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
27244 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
27245 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
27246 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
27247 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
27248 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
27249 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
27250 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
27251 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
27252 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
27253 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
27254 is not needed any more.
27255
27256 @item
27257 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
27258
27259 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
27260 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
27261 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
27262
27263 @item
27264 Dired integration
27265
27266 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
27267 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
27268 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
27269 entry.
27270
27271 @item
27272 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
27273
27274 @item
27275 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
27276
27277 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
27278
27279 @end itemize
27280
27281 @end itemize
27282
27283 @iftex
27284
27285 @page
27286 @node The Manual
27287 @section The Manual
27288 @cindex colophon
27289 @cindex manual
27290
27291 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
27292 either @code{texi2dvi}
27293 @iflatex
27294 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
27295 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
27296 @end iflatex
27297 to get what you hold in your hands now.
27298
27299 The following conventions have been used:
27300
27301 @enumerate
27302
27303 @item
27304 This is a @samp{string}
27305
27306 @item
27307 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
27308
27309 @item
27310 This is a @file{file}
27311
27312 @item
27313 This is a @code{symbol}
27314
27315 @end enumerate
27316
27317 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
27318 mean:
27319
27320 @lisp
27321 (setq flargnoze "yes")
27322 @end lisp
27323
27324 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
27325
27326 @lisp
27327 (setq flumphel 'yes)
27328 @end lisp
27329
27330 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
27331 ever get them confused.
27332
27333 @iflatex
27334 @c @head
27335 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
27336 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
27337 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
27338 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
27339 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
27340 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
27341 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
27342 @end iflatex
27343
27344 @end iftex
27345
27346
27347 @node On Writing Manuals
27348 @section On Writing Manuals
27349
27350 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
27351 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
27352 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
27353 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
27354 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
27355 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code goes
27356 hand in hand.
27357
27358 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
27359 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
27360 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
27361 started with Gnus.
27362
27363 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
27364 reference manual as source material. It would look quite differently.
27365
27366
27367 @page
27368 @node Terminology
27369 @section Terminology
27370
27371 @cindex terminology
27372 @table @dfn
27373
27374 @item news
27375 @cindex news
27376 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
27377 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
27378 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
27379 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
27380 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
27381
27382 @item mail
27383 @cindex mail
27384 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
27385 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
27386 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
27387 not posting, and replying is not following up.
27388
27389 @item reply
27390 @cindex reply
27391 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
27392
27393 @item follow up
27394 @cindex follow up
27395 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
27396 are reading.
27397
27398 @item back end
27399 @cindex back end
27400 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
27401 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
27402 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
27403 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
27404 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
27405 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
27406 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
27407 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
27408 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
27409 number 4711''.
27410
27411 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
27412 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
27413 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
27414 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
27415 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
27416 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
27417
27418 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
27419 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
27420 access the articles.
27421
27422 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
27423 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
27424 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
27425 confusing.
27426
27427 @item native
27428 @cindex native
27429 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
27430 default, way of getting news.
27431
27432 @item foreign
27433 @cindex foreign
27434 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
27435 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
27436 news.
27437
27438 @item secondary
27439 @cindex secondary
27440 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
27441 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
27442
27443 @item article
27444 @cindex article
27445 A message that has been posted as news.
27446
27447 @item mail message
27448 @cindex mail message
27449 A message that has been mailed.
27450
27451 @item message
27452 @cindex message
27453 A mail message or news article
27454
27455 @item head
27456 @cindex head
27457 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
27458 put.
27459
27460 @item body
27461 @cindex body
27462 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
27463 body.
27464
27465 @item header
27466 @cindex header
27467 A line from the head of an article.
27468
27469 @item headers
27470 @cindex headers
27471 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
27472 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
27473
27474 @item @acronym{NOV}
27475 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
27476 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
27477 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
27478 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
27479 normal @sc{head} format.
27480
27481 @item level
27482 @cindex levels
27483 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
27484 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
27485 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
27486 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
27487 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
27488 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
27489
27490 @item killed groups
27491 @cindex killed groups
27492 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
27493 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
27494
27495 @item zombie groups
27496 @cindex zombie groups
27497 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
27498
27499 @item active file
27500 @cindex active file
27501 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
27502 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
27503 is rather large, as you might surmise.
27504
27505 @item bogus groups
27506 @cindex bogus groups
27507 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
27508 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
27509 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
27510
27511 @item activating
27512 @cindex activating groups
27513 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
27514 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
27515 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
27516
27517 @item spool
27518 @cindex spool
27519 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
27520 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
27521 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
27522
27523 @item server
27524 @cindex server
27525 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
27526
27527 @item select method
27528 @cindex select method
27529 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
27530 server settings.
27531
27532 @item virtual server
27533 @cindex virtual server
27534 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
27535 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
27536 whole is a virtual server.
27537
27538 @item washing
27539 @cindex washing
27540 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
27541 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
27542 original.
27543
27544 @item ephemeral groups
27545 @cindex ephemeral groups
27546 @cindex temporary groups
27547 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
27548 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
27549 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
27550
27551 @item solid groups
27552 @cindex solid groups
27553 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
27554 group buffer are solid groups.
27555
27556 @item sparse articles
27557 @cindex sparse articles
27558 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
27559 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
27560
27561 @item threading
27562 @cindex threading
27563 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
27564 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
27565
27566 @item root
27567 @cindex root
27568 @cindex thread root
27569 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
27570 articles in the thread.
27571
27572 @item parent
27573 @cindex parent
27574 An article that has responses.
27575
27576 @item child
27577 @cindex child
27578 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
27579
27580 @item digest
27581 @cindex digest
27582 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
27583 specified by RFC 1153.
27584
27585 @item splitting
27586 @cindex splitting, terminology
27587 @cindex mail sorting
27588 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
27589 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
27590 incorrectly called mail filtering.
27591
27592 @end table
27593
27594
27595 @page
27596 @node Customization
27597 @section Customization
27598 @cindex general customization
27599
27600 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
27601 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
27602 for some quite common situations.
27603
27604 @menu
27605 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
27606 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
27607 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
27608 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
27609 @end menu
27610
27611
27612 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
27613 @subsection Slow/Expensive NNTP Connection
27614
27615 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
27616 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
27617 Gnus has to get from the @acronym{NNTP} server.
27618
27619 @table @code
27620
27621 @item gnus-read-active-file
27622 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
27623 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
27624 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27625 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
27626 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
27627
27628 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
27629 This one has to be @code{nil}. If not, grabbing article headers from
27630 the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast. Not all @acronym{NNTP} servers
27631 support @sc{xover}; Gnus will detect this by itself.
27632 @end table
27633
27634
27635 @node Slow Terminal Connection
27636 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
27637
27638 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
27639 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
27640 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
27641
27642 @table @code
27643
27644 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
27645 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
27646 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
27647 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
27648 horizontal and vertical recentering.
27649
27650 @item gnus-visible-headers
27651 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
27652 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
27653 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
27654 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
27655
27656 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
27657 @lisp
27658 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
27659 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
27660 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
27661 @end lisp
27662
27663 @item gnus-use-full-window
27664 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
27665 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
27666 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
27667 want to read them anyway.
27668
27669 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
27670 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
27671 hidden initially.
27672
27673
27674 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
27675 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
27676 lines, which might save some time.
27677 @end table
27678
27679
27680 @node Little Disk Space
27681 @subsection Little Disk Space
27682 @cindex disk space
27683
27684 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
27685 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
27686
27687 @table @code
27688
27689 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
27690 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
27691 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27692 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27693 default.
27694
27695 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
27696 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
27697 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27698 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27699 default.
27700
27701 @item gnus-save-killed-list
27702 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
27703 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
27704 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
27705 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
27706
27707 @end table
27708
27709
27710 @node Slow Machine
27711 @subsection Slow Machine
27712 @cindex slow machine
27713
27714 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
27715 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
27716
27717 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27718 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
27719
27720 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
27721 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
27722 summary buffer faster.
27723
27724
27725 @page
27726 @node Troubleshooting
27727 @section Troubleshooting
27728 @cindex troubleshooting
27729
27730 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
27731 problems, really.
27732
27733 Ahem.
27734
27735 @enumerate
27736
27737 @item
27738 Make sure your computer is switched on.
27739
27740 @item
27741 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
27742 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
27743 Gnus will work.
27744
27745 @item
27746 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
27747 like @samp{Gnus v5.10.6} you have the right files loaded. Otherwise
27748 you have some old @file{.el} files lying around. Delete these.
27749
27750 @item
27751 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
27752 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
27753
27754 @item
27755 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
27756 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
27757 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
27758 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
27759 something like that.
27760 @end enumerate
27761
27762 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
27763
27764 @cindex bugs
27765 @cindex reporting bugs
27766
27767 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
27768 @findex gnus-bug
27769 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
27770 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
27771 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
27772 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
27773
27774 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
27775 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
27776 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
27777 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
27778 time.
27779
27780 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
27781 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
27782 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
27783 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
27784 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
27785 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
27786
27787 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
27788 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
27789 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
27790 the bug report.
27791
27792 @cindex patches
27793 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
27794 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
27795
27796 @cindex edebug
27797 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
27798 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
27799 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
27800 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
27801 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
27802 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
27803 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
27804 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
27805 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
27806 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
27807 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
27808 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
27809 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
27810 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
27811
27812 @cindex elp
27813 @cindex profile
27814 @cindex slow
27815 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
27816 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
27817 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
27818 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
27819 helps isolating the real problem areas).
27820
27821 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
27822 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
27823 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
27824 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
27825 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
27826 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
27827 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
27828 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
27829 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
27830 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
27831 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
27832 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
27833 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
27834 work perfectly.
27835
27836 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
27837 @cindex ding mailing list
27838 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
27839 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
27840 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
27841 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
27842
27843
27844 @page
27845 @node Gnus Reference Guide
27846 @section Gnus Reference Guide
27847
27848 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
27849 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
27850 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
27851 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
27852 it.
27853
27854 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
27855 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
27856 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
27857 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
27858 and general methods of operation.
27859
27860 @menu
27861 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
27862 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
27863 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
27864 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
27865 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
27866 * Group Info:: The group info format.
27867 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
27868 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
27869 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
27870 @end menu
27871
27872
27873 @node Gnus Utility Functions
27874 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
27875 @cindex Gnus utility functions
27876 @cindex utility functions
27877 @cindex functions
27878 @cindex internal variables
27879
27880 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
27881 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
27882 Below is a list of the most common ones.
27883
27884 @table @code
27885
27886 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
27887 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
27888 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
27889
27890 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
27891 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
27892 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
27893
27894 @item gnus-group-real-name
27895 @findex gnus-group-real-name
27896 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
27897 name.
27898
27899 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
27900 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
27901 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
27902 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
27903
27904 @item gnus-get-info
27905 @findex gnus-get-info
27906 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
27907
27908 @item gnus-group-unread
27909 @findex gnus-group-unread
27910 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
27911 unknown.
27912
27913 @item gnus-active
27914 @findex gnus-active
27915 The active entry for @var{group}.
27916
27917 @item gnus-set-active
27918 @findex gnus-set-active
27919 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
27920
27921 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27922 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
27923 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
27924 exit.
27925
27926 @item gnus-continuum-version
27927 @findex gnus-continuum-version
27928 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
27929 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
27930 versions.
27931
27932 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
27933 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
27934 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
27935
27936 @item gnus-news-group-p
27937 @findex gnus-news-group-p
27938 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
27939
27940 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27941 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
27942 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
27943
27944 @item gnus-server-to-method
27945 @findex gnus-server-to-method
27946 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
27947
27948 @item gnus-server-equal
27949 @findex gnus-server-equal
27950 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
27951
27952 @item gnus-group-native-p
27953 @findex gnus-group-native-p
27954 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
27955
27956 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
27957 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
27958 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
27959
27960 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
27961 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
27962 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
27963
27964 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
27965 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
27966 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
27967 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
27968
27969 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
27970 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
27971 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
27972
27973 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
27974 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
27975 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
27976
27977 @item gnus-check-backend-function
27978 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
27979 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
27980 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
27981
27982 @lisp
27983 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
27984 @result{} t
27985 @end lisp
27986
27987 @item gnus-read-method
27988 @findex gnus-read-method
27989 Prompts the user for a select method.
27990
27991 @end table
27992
27993
27994 @node Back End Interface
27995 @subsection Back End Interface
27996
27997 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
27998 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
27999 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
28000 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
28001 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
28002 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
28003
28004 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
28005 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
28006 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
28007 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
28008 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
28009 been opened, the function should fail.
28010
28011 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
28012 name. Take this example:
28013
28014 @lisp
28015 (nntp "odd-one"
28016 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
28017 (nntp-port-number 4324))
28018 @end lisp
28019
28020 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
28021 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
28022
28023 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
28024 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
28025 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
28026
28027 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
28028 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
28029 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
28030
28031 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
28032 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
28033 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
28034 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
28035 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
28036 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
28037 return value.
28038
28039 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
28040 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
28041 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
28042 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
28043 more.
28044
28045 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
28046 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
28047 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
28048 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
28049 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
28050 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
28051 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
28052 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
28053 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
28054 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
28055
28056 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
28057 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
28058 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
28059 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
28060 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
28061 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
28062 of numbers as long as possible.
28063
28064 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
28065 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
28066 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
28067
28068 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
28069 @code{nnchoke}.
28070
28071 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
28072
28073 @menu
28074 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
28075 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
28076 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
28077 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
28078 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
28079 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
28080 @end menu
28081
28082
28083 @node Required Back End Functions
28084 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
28085
28086 @table @code
28087
28088 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
28089
28090 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
28091 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
28092 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
28093 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
28094
28095 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
28096 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
28097 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
28098 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
28099
28100 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
28101 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
28102 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
28103 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
28104 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
28105 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
28106 number, do maximum fetches.
28107
28108 Here's an example HEAD:
28109
28110 @example
28111 221 1056 Article retrieved.
28112 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
28113 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
28114 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
28115 Subject: Re: Something very droll
28116 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
28117 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
28118 Lines: 26
28119 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
28120 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
28121 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
28122 .
28123 @end example
28124
28125 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
28126 these in the data buffer.
28127
28128 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
28129
28130 @example
28131 headers = *head
28132 head = error / valid-head
28133 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
28134 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
28135 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
28136 header = <text> eol
28137 @end example
28138
28139 @cindex BNF
28140 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
28141
28142 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
28143 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
28144 separated by tabs.
28145
28146 @example
28147 nov-buffer = *nov-line
28148 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
28149 field = <text except TAB>
28150 @end example
28151
28152 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
28153 @pxref{Headers}.
28154
28155
28156 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
28157
28158 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
28159 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
28160
28161 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
28162 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
28163 server. In fact, it should do so.
28164
28165 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
28166 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
28167
28168
28169 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
28170
28171 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
28172 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
28173 reason.
28174
28175 There should be no data returned.
28176
28177
28178 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
28179
28180 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
28181 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
28182 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
28183 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
28184
28185 There should be no data returned.
28186
28187
28188 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
28189
28190 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
28191 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
28192 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
28193 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
28194
28195 There should be no data returned.
28196
28197
28198 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
28199
28200 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
28201
28202 There should be no data returned.
28203
28204
28205 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
28206
28207 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
28208 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
28209 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
28210 it would be nice if that were possible.
28211
28212 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
28213 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
28214 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
28215 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
28216 into its article buffer.
28217
28218 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
28219 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
28220 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
28221 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
28222 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
28223 on successful article retrieval.
28224
28225
28226 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
28227
28228 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
28229 making @var{group} the current group.
28230
28231 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
28232 the current group.
28233
28234 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
28235
28236 @example
28237 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
28238 @end example
28239
28240 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
28241 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
28242 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
28243 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
28244 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
28245 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
28246 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
28247 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
28248 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
28249 highest as 0.
28250
28251 @example
28252 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
28253 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
28254 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
28255 @end example
28256
28257
28258 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
28259
28260 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
28261 a no-op on most back ends.
28262
28263 There should be no data returned.
28264
28265
28266 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
28267
28268 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
28269 @emph{all}.
28270
28271 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
28272
28273 @example
28274 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
28275 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
28276 @end example
28277
28278 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
28279 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
28280 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
28281 and the highest as 0.
28282
28283 @example
28284 active-file = *active-line
28285 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
28286 name = <string>
28287 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
28288 @end example
28289
28290 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
28291 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
28292 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
28293
28294
28295 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
28296
28297 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
28298 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
28299 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
28300 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
28301 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
28302 clear if the posting could not be completed.
28303
28304 There should be no result data from this function.
28305
28306 @end table
28307
28308
28309 @node Optional Back End Functions
28310 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
28311
28312 @table @code
28313
28314 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
28315
28316 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
28317 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
28318 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
28319
28320 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
28321 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
28322 former is in the same format as the data from
28323 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
28324 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
28325
28326 @example
28327 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
28328 @end example
28329
28330
28331 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
28332
28333 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
28334 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
28335 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
28336 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
28337 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
28338
28339 There should be no result data from this function.
28340
28341
28342 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
28343
28344 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
28345 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
28346 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
28347 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
28348 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
28349 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
28350 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
28351 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
28352
28353 There should be no result data from this function.
28354
28355
28356 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
28357
28358 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
28359 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
28360 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
28361 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
28362 propagate the mark information to the server.
28363
28364 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
28365
28366 @example
28367 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
28368 @end example
28369
28370 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
28371 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
28372 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
28373 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
28374 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
28375 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
28376 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
28377 possible, not limit itself to these.
28378
28379 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
28380 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
28381 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
28382 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
28383
28384 An example action list:
28385
28386 @example
28387 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
28388 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
28389 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
28390 @end example
28391
28392 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
28393 mark on (currently not used for anything).
28394
28395 There should be no result data from this function.
28396
28397 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
28398
28399 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
28400 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
28401 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
28402 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
28403 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
28404
28405 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
28406 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
28407 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
28408 expirable.
28409
28410 There should be no result data from this function.
28411
28412
28413 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
28414
28415 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
28416 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
28417 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
28418 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
28419 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
28420 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
28421 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
28422 local if that's practical.
28423
28424 There should be no result data from this function.
28425
28426
28427 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
28428
28429 The result data from this function should be a description of
28430 @var{group}.
28431
28432 @example
28433 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
28434 name = <string>
28435 description = <text>
28436 @end example
28437
28438 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
28439
28440 The result data from this function should be the description of all
28441 groups available on the server.
28442
28443 @example
28444 description-buffer = *description-line
28445 @end example
28446
28447
28448 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
28449
28450 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
28451 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
28452 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
28453 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
28454 in the active buffer format.
28455
28456 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
28457 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
28458 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
28459 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
28460 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
28461 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
28462 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
28463
28464
28465 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
28466
28467 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
28468
28469 There should be no return data.
28470
28471
28472 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
28473
28474 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
28475 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
28476 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
28477 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
28478 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
28479 they are.
28480
28481 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
28482 able to delete.
28483
28484 There should be no result data returned.
28485
28486
28487 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
28488
28489 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
28490 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
28491
28492 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
28493 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
28494 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
28495 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
28496 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
28497 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
28498
28499 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
28500 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
28501 optimizations.
28502
28503 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
28504 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
28505
28506 There should be no data returned.
28507
28508
28509 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
28510
28511 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
28512 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
28513 this function in short order.
28514
28515 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
28516 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
28517
28518 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
28519 article for that group.
28520
28521 There should be no data returned.
28522
28523
28524 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
28525
28526 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
28527 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
28528
28529 There should be no data returned.
28530
28531
28532 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
28533
28534 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
28535 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
28536 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
28537
28538 There should be no data returned.
28539
28540
28541 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
28542
28543 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
28544 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
28545
28546 There should be no data returned.
28547
28548 @end table
28549
28550
28551 @node Error Messaging
28552 @subsubsection Error Messaging
28553
28554 @findex nnheader-report
28555 @findex nnheader-get-report
28556 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
28557 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
28558 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
28559 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
28560 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
28561 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
28562
28563 @lisp
28564 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
28565
28566 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
28567 @end lisp
28568
28569 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
28570 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
28571 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
28572 takes one argument---the server symbol.
28573
28574 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
28575 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
28576 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
28577
28578
28579 @node Writing New Back Ends
28580 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
28581
28582 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
28583 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
28584 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
28585 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
28586 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
28587 editing articles.
28588
28589 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
28590 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
28591 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
28592
28593 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
28594 package called @code{nnoo}.
28595
28596 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
28597 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
28598 following macros:
28599
28600 @table @code
28601
28602 @item nnoo-declare
28603 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
28604 parameters. For instance:
28605
28606 @lisp
28607 (nnoo-declare nndir
28608 nnml nnmh)
28609 @end lisp
28610
28611 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
28612 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
28613
28614 @item defvoo
28615 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
28616 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
28617 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
28618
28619 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
28620 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
28621 a function in those back ends.
28622
28623 @lisp
28624 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28625 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28626 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28627 @end lisp
28628
28629 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
28630 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
28631 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
28632
28633 @item nnoo-define-basics
28634 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
28635 have.
28636
28637 @lisp
28638 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28639 @end lisp
28640
28641 @item deffoo
28642 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
28643 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
28644 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
28645
28646 @item nnoo-map-functions
28647 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
28648 functions from the parent back ends.
28649
28650 @lisp
28651 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28652 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28653 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
28654 @end lisp
28655
28656 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
28657 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
28658 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
28659 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
28660
28661 @item nnoo-import
28662 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
28663 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
28664 haven't already been defined.
28665
28666 @lisp
28667 (nnoo-import nndir
28668 (nnmh
28669 nnmh-request-list
28670 nnmh-request-newgroups)
28671 (nnml))
28672 @end lisp
28673
28674 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
28675 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
28676 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
28677 defined now.
28678
28679 @end table
28680
28681 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
28682
28683 @lisp
28684 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
28685 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
28686
28687 ;;; @r{Code:}
28688
28689 (require 'nnheader)
28690 (require 'nnmh)
28691 (require 'nnml)
28692 (require 'nnoo)
28693 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
28694
28695 (nnoo-declare nndir
28696 nnml nnmh)
28697
28698 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28699 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28700 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28701
28702 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
28703 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
28704 nnml-nov-is-evil)
28705
28706 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
28707 nil
28708 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
28709 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
28710 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
28711
28712 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
28713 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
28714
28715 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
28716
28717 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28718
28719 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
28720 (setq nndir-directory
28721 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
28722 server))
28723 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
28724 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
28725 (push `(nndir-current-group
28726 ,(file-name-nondirectory
28727 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28728 defs)
28729 (push `(nndir-top-directory
28730 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28731 defs)
28732 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
28733
28734 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28735 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28736 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28737 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
28738 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
28739
28740 (nnoo-import nndir
28741 (nnmh
28742 nnmh-status-message
28743 nnmh-request-list
28744 nnmh-request-newgroups))
28745
28746 (provide 'nndir)
28747 @end lisp
28748
28749
28750 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28751 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28752
28753 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
28754 @findex gnus-declare-backend
28755 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
28756 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
28757 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
28758
28759 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
28760 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
28761
28762 Here's an example:
28763
28764 @lisp
28765 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
28766 @end lisp
28767
28768 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
28769
28770 The abilities can be:
28771
28772 @table @code
28773 @item mail
28774 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
28775 @item post
28776 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
28777 @item post-mail
28778 This back end supports both mail and news.
28779 @item none
28780 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
28781 different.
28782 @item respool
28783 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
28784 articles and groups.
28785 @item address
28786 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
28787 true for almost all back ends.
28788 @item prompt-address
28789 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
28790 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
28791 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
28792 @end table
28793
28794
28795 @node Mail-like Back Ends
28796 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
28797
28798 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
28799 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
28800 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
28801 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
28802
28803 @lisp
28804 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
28805 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
28806 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
28807 @end lisp
28808
28809 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
28810 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
28811 mail.
28812
28813 This function takes four parameters.
28814
28815 @table @var
28816 @item method
28817 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
28818 the call.
28819
28820 @item exit-function
28821 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
28822
28823 @item temp-directory
28824 Where the temporary files should be stored.
28825
28826 @item group
28827 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
28828 performed for one group only.
28829 @end table
28830
28831 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
28832 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
28833 find the article number assigned to this article.
28834
28835 The function also uses the following variables:
28836 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
28837 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
28838 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
28839 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
28840 this:
28841
28842 @example
28843 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
28844 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
28845 @end example
28846
28847
28848 @node Score File Syntax
28849 @subsection Score File Syntax
28850
28851 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
28852 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
28853 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
28854
28855 Here's a typical score file:
28856
28857 @lisp
28858 (("summary"
28859 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
28860 ("Gnus"))
28861 ("from"
28862 ("Lars" -1000))
28863 (mark -100))
28864 @end lisp
28865
28866 BNF definition of a score file:
28867
28868 @example
28869 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
28870 element = rule / atom
28871 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
28872 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
28873 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
28874 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
28875 quote = <ascii 34>
28876 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
28877 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
28878 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28879 date-header = "date"
28880 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28881 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28882 score = "nil" / <integer>
28883 date = "nil" / <natural number>
28884 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
28885 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
28886 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
28887 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
28888 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28889 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
28890 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
28891 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
28892 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
28893 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
28894 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
28895 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
28896 exclude-files / read-only / touched
28897 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
28898 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
28899 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
28900 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
28901 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
28902 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
28903 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
28904 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
28905 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
28906 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
28907 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
28908 eval = "eval" space <form>
28909 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
28910 @end example
28911
28912 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
28913 discarded.
28914
28915 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
28916 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
28917 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
28918 one looong line, then that's ok.
28919
28920 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
28921 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
28922
28923
28924 @node Headers
28925 @subsection Headers
28926
28927 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
28928 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
28929 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
28930 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
28931
28932 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
28933 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
28934 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
28935 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
28936 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
28937 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
28938 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
28939
28940 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
28941 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
28942 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
28943 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
28944 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
28945
28946 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
28947 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
28948
28949
28950 @node Ranges
28951 @subsection Ranges
28952
28953 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
28954 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
28955
28956 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
28957 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
28958 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
28959 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
28960
28961 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
28962 sequence.
28963
28964 @example
28965 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
28966 @end example
28967
28968 is transformed into
28969
28970 @example
28971 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
28972 @end example
28973
28974 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
28975 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
28976
28977 @example
28978 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
28979 @end example
28980
28981 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
28982 is slightly tricky:
28983
28984 @example
28985 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
28986 @end example
28987
28988 and
28989
28990 @example
28991 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
28992 @end example
28993
28994 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
28995
28996 @example
28997 (1 2 3 4 5)
28998 @end example
28999
29000 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
29001 also valid:
29002
29003 @example
29004 (1 . 5)
29005 @end example
29006
29007 and is equal to the previous range.
29008
29009 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
29010 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
29011 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
29012 range handling.)
29013
29014 @example
29015 range = simple-range / normal-range
29016 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
29017 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
29018 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
29019 number *[ " " contents ]
29020 @end example
29021
29022 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
29023 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
29024 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
29025 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
29026 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
29027 sequences.)
29028
29029
29030 @node Group Info
29031 @subsection Group Info
29032
29033 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
29034 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
29035 describes the group.
29036
29037 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
29038 second is a more complex one:
29039
29040 @example
29041 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
29042
29043 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
29044 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
29045 (nnml "")
29046 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
29047 @end example
29048
29049 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
29050 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
29051 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
29052 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
29053 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
29054 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
29055 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
29056 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
29057 this section is about.
29058
29059 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
29060 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
29061 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
29062
29063 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
29064
29065 @example
29066 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
29067 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
29068 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
29069 group = quote <string> quote
29070 ralevel = rank / level
29071 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
29072 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
29073 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
29074 read = range
29075 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
29076 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
29077 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
29078 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
29079 @end example
29080
29081 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
29082 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
29083 in pseudo-BNF.
29084
29085 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
29086 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
29087
29088 @table @code
29089 @item gnus-info-group
29090 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
29091 @findex gnus-info-group
29092 @findex gnus-info-set-group
29093 Get/set the group name.
29094
29095 @item gnus-info-rank
29096 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
29097 @findex gnus-info-rank
29098 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
29099 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
29100
29101 @item gnus-info-level
29102 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
29103 @findex gnus-info-level
29104 @findex gnus-info-set-level
29105 Get/set the group level.
29106
29107 @item gnus-info-score
29108 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
29109 @findex gnus-info-score
29110 @findex gnus-info-set-score
29111 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
29112
29113 @item gnus-info-read
29114 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
29115 @findex gnus-info-read
29116 @findex gnus-info-set-read
29117 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
29118
29119 @item gnus-info-marks
29120 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
29121 @findex gnus-info-marks
29122 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
29123 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
29124
29125 @item gnus-info-method
29126 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
29127 @findex gnus-info-method
29128 @findex gnus-info-set-method
29129 Get/set the group select method.
29130
29131 @item gnus-info-params
29132 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
29133 @findex gnus-info-params
29134 @findex gnus-info-set-params
29135 Get/set the group parameters.
29136 @end table
29137
29138 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
29139 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
29140
29141 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
29142 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
29143 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
29144 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
29145
29146
29147 @node Extended Interactive
29148 @subsection Extended Interactive
29149 @cindex interactive
29150 @findex gnus-interactive
29151
29152 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
29153 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
29154 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
29155
29156 @lisp
29157 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
29158 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
29159 ...
29160 )
29161 @end lisp
29162
29163 The best thing to do would have been to implement
29164 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
29165 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
29166 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
29167 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
29168 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
29169 @code{interactive}.
29170
29171 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
29172 adds a few more.
29173
29174 @table @samp
29175 @item y
29176 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
29177 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
29178 variable.
29179
29180 @item Y
29181 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
29182 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
29183 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
29184
29185 @item A
29186 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
29187 function.
29188
29189 @item H
29190 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
29191 function.
29192
29193 @item g
29194 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
29195 function.
29196
29197 @end table
29198
29199
29200 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
29201 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
29202 @cindex XEmacs
29203 @cindex Emacsen
29204
29205 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
29206 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
29207 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
29208
29209 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
29210 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
29211 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
29212 Gnus, that's very useful.
29213
29214 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
29215 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
29216 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
29217 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
29218 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
29219 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
29220 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
29221 following function:
29222
29223 @lisp
29224 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
29225 (start-itimer
29226 "gnus-run-at-time"
29227 `(lambda ()
29228 (,function ,@@args))
29229 time repeat))
29230 @end lisp
29231
29232 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
29233 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
29234 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
29235 all over.
29236
29237 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
29238 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
29239 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
29240
29241 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
29242 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
29243 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
29244
29245
29246 @node Various File Formats
29247 @subsection Various File Formats
29248
29249 @menu
29250 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
29251 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
29252 @end menu
29253
29254
29255 @node Active File Format
29256 @subsubsection Active File Format
29257
29258 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
29259 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
29260 in each group.
29261
29262 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
29263
29264 @example
29265 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
29266 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
29267 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
29268 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
29269 no.general 1000 900 y
29270 @end example
29271
29272 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
29273
29274 @example
29275 active = *group-line
29276 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
29277 group = <non-white-space string>
29278 spc = " "
29279 high-number = <non-negative integer>
29280 low-number = <positive integer>
29281 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
29282 @end example
29283
29284 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
29285 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
29286
29287
29288 @node Newsgroups File Format
29289 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
29290
29291 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
29292 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
29293 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
29294 the user.
29295
29296 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
29297 Here's the definition:
29298
29299 @example
29300 newsgroups = *line
29301 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
29302 group = <non-white-space string>
29303 tab = <TAB>
29304 description = <string>
29305 @end example
29306
29307
29308 @page
29309 @node Emacs for Heathens
29310 @section Emacs for Heathens
29311
29312 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
29313 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
29314 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
29315 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
29316 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
29317 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
29318 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
29319 cat instead.
29320
29321 @menu
29322 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
29323 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
29324 @end menu
29325
29326
29327 @node Keystrokes
29328 @subsection Keystrokes
29329
29330 @itemize @bullet
29331 @item
29332 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
29333
29334 @item
29335 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
29336 @end itemize
29337
29338 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
29339 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
29340 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
29341 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
29342 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
29343 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
29344
29345 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
29346 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
29347 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
29348 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
29349 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
29350 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
29351 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
29352
29353 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
29354 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
29355 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
29356 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
29357 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
29358 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
29359 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
29360
29361 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
29362 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
29363 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
29364 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
29365 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
29366 it.
29367
29368
29369
29370 @node Emacs Lisp
29371 @subsection Emacs Lisp
29372
29373 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
29374 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
29375 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
29376 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
29377
29378 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
29379 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
29380 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
29381 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
29382 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
29383 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
29384 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
29385 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
29386 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
29387 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
29388
29389 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
29390 write the following:
29391
29392 @lisp
29393 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
29394 @end lisp
29395
29396 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
29397 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
29398 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
29399 change how Gnus works.
29400
29401 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
29402 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
29403 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
29404 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
29405 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
29406
29407 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
29408 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
29409 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
29410
29411 Some pitfalls:
29412
29413 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
29414 that means:
29415
29416 @lisp
29417 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
29418 @end lisp
29419
29420 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
29421 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
29422
29423 @lisp
29424 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
29425 @end lisp
29426
29427 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
29428 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
29429
29430 @page
29431 @include gnus-faq.texi
29432
29433 @node GNU Free Documentation License
29434 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
29435 @include doclicense.texi
29436
29437 @node Index
29438 @chapter Index
29439 @printindex cp
29440
29441 @node Key Index
29442 @chapter Key Index
29443 @printindex ky
29444
29445 @summarycontents
29446 @contents
29447 @bye
29448
29449 @iftex
29450 @iflatex
29451 \end{document}
29452 @end iflatex
29453 @end iftex
29454
29455 @c Local Variables:
29456 @c mode: texinfo
29457 @c coding: iso-8859-1
29458 @c End:
29459
29460 @ignore
29461 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
29462 @end ignore